- '^4 V :'' % \U V 0^ X/ >,. ^ %<# FIRST AID IN ILLNESS AND INJURY COMPRISED IN A SERIES OF CHAPTERS ON THE HUMAN MACHINE ITS STRUCTURE, ITS IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR, AND THE ACCIDENTS AND EMERGENCIES TO WHICH IT IS LIABLE BY JAMES EVELYN PILCHER, M.D., L.H.D. MAJOR AND BRIGADE SURGEON OF UNITED STATES VOLUNTEERS; CAPTAIN IN THE MEDICAL DEPARTMENT OF THE UNITED STATES ARMY; SECRE- TARY AND EDITOR OF THE ASSOCIATION OF MILITARY SURGEONS OF THE UNITED STATES NINTH EDITION, REVISED WITH 208 ILLUSTRATIONS NEW YORK CHARLES SCRIBNER'S SONS 1905 LIBRARY of OONGResS Two Copies rtwwvtv JUN 26 1905 'CLASS s Surgeon's Hand- book, and the U. S. Army Manual of Drill for the Hospital Corps, which is reprinted entire, with original illustrations, in connection with carrying the disabled — the author gladly takes this opportunity of acknowledging in general his indebt- edness to his many co-workers in teaching early aid in illness and injury, whose writings have been both suggestive and inspiring to him. CONTENTS Part I. —THE CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE Chapter I. The Covering — the Skin PAGE Its functions ; its composition ; its appendages . . ' 3 Chapter II. The Padding — the Fat Its functions ; its varieties ; its appearance in the body 5 Chapter III. The Framework — the Bones Their function ; their composition ; their structure ; the skeleton ; their varieties ; the skull ; the teeth ; the spinal column ; the thorax ; the shoulder ; the arm ; the hand ; the pelvis ; the leg ; the foot 6 Chapter IV. The Hinges — the Joints Their function ; their varieties ; their composition ; ligaments ; synovial membrane ; cartilage 25 Chapter V. The Moving Apparatus — the Muscles Their function ; their composition ; their action ; the motions pro- duced; voluntary muscles; involuntary muscles; their forms; their attachments ; tendons ; the individual muscles 29 ix CONTENTS Chapter VI. The Central Power — the Brain and Nerves PAGE Its functions ; its divisions ; cranial nerves ; spinal nerves ; motor nerves; sensory nerves; nerve and brain substance; the parts of the brain ; its delicacy ; the spinal cord ; the sympathetic nerves 36 Chapter VII. The Repair Apparatus — the Blood and its Circulation The function of the blood ; its composition ; the heart ; its compo- sition; the blood-vessels; the arteries; the capillaries; the veins ; the circulation ; the pulse ; the location of the indi- vidual arteries; the situation of the individual veins; blood glands 46 Chapter VIII. The Speaking and Breathing Apparatus — the Larynx and the Lungs Its composition ; the pharynx ; the epiglottis ; Adam's apple ; the vocal cords ; the windpipe ; the bronchial tubes ; the lungs ; breathing ; the effect of breathing on life 64 Chapter IX. The Digestive Apparatus — the Stomach and Bowels Its function; the forms in which food is absorbed; chewing; saliva ; the gullet ; the stomach ; the gastric juice ; the bowels ; the liver ; the pancreas or sweetbread ; the process of digestion 70 Chapter X. The Waste Removers — the Ex- cretory Apparatus Their function ; the skin ; the lungs ; the rectum or lower bowel ; the kidneys ; the bladder 76 CONTENTS XI Chapter XI. The Perceptive Apparatus — the Senses PAGE Touch; taste; the tongue; smell; the nose; hearing; the ear; sight ; the eye 79 Part II.— THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR Chapter XII. Germs, their Action and its Control Micro-organisms ; their agency in producing disease and contami- nating wounds ; germicides; antiseptics; cleanliness; individ- ual antiseptic agents 87 Chapter XIII. Knots and Bandages The granny; the reef knot; the surgeon's knot; the clove hitch; bandages ; the triangular bandage ; the narrow arm-sling ; the broad arm-sling ; the large arm-sling ; the triangular bandage as applied to various parts ; the square bandage ; the four- tailed bandage ; the roller bandage — sizes and rules for its application ; individual uses of the roller ; the double-headed roller 90 Chapter XIV. Dressings and Applications The compress ; antiseptic gauze ; other materials ; protective applications; the first dressing-packet; fixative applications; plasters ; emollient applications ; poultices ; moist fomenta- tions ; dry fomentations ; counter-irritants ; mustard-plaster ; spice-plaster 107 Part III. — ACCIDENTS AND EMERGENCIES Chapter XV. How to Act at First Keep cool ; be prompt and quiet ; summon a doctor ; keep crowds back, and give patient air; observe situation and surround- ings; place patient in comfortable position; remove tight clothing; be careful about stimulants; method of examina- tion; indications of diseases; feigning , ... 119 Xii CONTENTS Chapter XVI. Bruises, Burns, and Freezing PAGE Bruises; definition; causes; symptoms; treatment; burns; defi- nition ; causes ; varieties ; symptoms ; treatment ; sunburn ; burning clothing ; freezing ; definition ; causes ; varieties ; symptoms; treatment; chilblains 125 Chapter XVII. Wounds Definition ; varieties ; causes ; symptoms ; treatment ; possibilities of surgery; cleanliness; drawing edges together; dressing; torn wounds; punctured wounds; splinters; fish-hooks and arrows ; gunshot wounds ; wounds of the chest ; wounds of the abdomen ; dangers of improper treatment ; process of healing ; poisoned wounds 133 Chapter XVIII. Bleeding Definition ; varieties ; causes ; symptoms ; treatment ; clotting; blood-pressure; bleeding from arteries; twisting; tying; po- sition; pressure; ligature of limbs; tourniquets; treatment of bleeding from individual arteries in detail ; bleeding from veins ; direct pressure in the wound ; pressure below wound ; eleva- tion; bleeding from capillaries ; hot water; pressure; styptics; spitting of blood; from the nose; from the mouth; from the throat ; from the lungs ; nose-bleed ; internal bleeding in gen- eral; secondary bleeding; special susceptibility to bleeding . 145 Chapter XIX. Sprains and Dislocations Sprains ; definition ; causes ; symptoms ; treatment ; bones out of joint; definition; causes; symptoms; treatment; the fingers; the lower jaw ; the shoulder 168- Chapter XX. Broken Bones Definition ; varieties ; causes ; symptoms ; treatment ; splints ; slings ; fractures of the skull ; fractures of the upper extremity ; fractures of the chest and spine ; fractures of the lower extremity 172 Chapter XXI. Foreign Bodies In the eye; in the ear; in the nose; in the throat — choking . . 192 CONTENTS Xlll Chapter XXII. Fainting PAGE Unconsciousness in general ; fainting ; shock ; stunning ; compres- sion of the brain ; apoplexy ; drunkenness ; sunstroke ; insen- sibility from poisoning ; insensibility from freezing 196 Chapter XXIII. Fits Epileptic fits ; hysterics ; convulsions from kidney disease ; chil- dren's fits o . . . . 211 Chapter XXIV. Smothering Definition; causes; restoring the breathing — artificial respiration ; Sylvester's method ; Marshall Hall's method ; Howard's meth- od ; drowning ; definition ; causes ; symptoms ; treatment ; Satterthwaite's method ; rescuing the drowning ; breaking through the ice; smothering by gases; smothering by press- ure on the chest ; smothering by strangling or hanging ; smothering by electric shock 214 Chapter XXV. Poisons Definition ; varieties ; symptoms ; treatment ; emetics ; poison ivy, oak, sumach ; poisoned wounds ; dog bites ; snake bites ; in- sect stings 226 Chapter XXVI. Death Definition ; causes ; proofs 234 Chapter XXVII. The Emergencies of the Battle-field Provisions for treatment; medical officers ; company bearers ; hos- pital corps ; hospital stewards ; acting hospital stewards ; uni- forms ; equipment; organization for national- guard ; articles of Geneva Convention ; work on the line of battle ; at the first dressing stations ; at the ambulance station ; the field hospital ; permanent hospitals 236 XIV CONTENTS Chapter XXVIII. Carrying the Disabled PAGE The U. S. Army litter ; necessity for definite system ; U. S. Army system : definitions ; military general principles ; signals ; school of the soldier ; setting-up exercises ; steps and march- ings ; equipment ; manual of the saber ; school of the de- tachment ; litter drill ; the empty litter ; marchings with the litter ; the loaded litter ; passing obstacles ; carrying litter over stairs ; improvising litters ; carrying wounded without a litter by one and by two bearers ; carrying disabled on horse- back ; the travois ; the ambulance ; ambulance drill; carry- ing the disabled on ordinary wagons ; hospital corps inspec- tion and muster ; tent drill ; hospital tents ; conical wall tents ; shelter tents ; the field hospital ; hospital corps bugle call ; position of the medical department on the march and in camp ; scheme for packing pouches ........ 244 Part IV.— THE CARE OF THE HUMAN MACHINE Chapter XXIX. Sanitary Suggestions Dwellings ; ventilation ; disinfection ; heat ; corrosive sublimate ; chloride of lime ; sulphur ; deodorization ; cleanliness ; cloth- ing ; chafing ; foot-soreness ; food ; infection 337 INDEX 347 Part I THE CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE Part I THE CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE The body of man is a machine of most complicated structure, containing thousands of distinct pieces and many different varieties of materials. For practical pur- poses it may be considered in eleven groups, it being understood that it is designed not to give a complete account of them, but merely to convey such a general idea of the various parts as may be requisite for under- standing the means of staying danger from the emergen- cies of illness and injury. The eleven groups are : i. The Covering — the skin. 2. The Padding — the fat. 3. The Framework — the bones. 4. The Hinges — the joints. 5. The Moving Apparatus — the muscles. 6. The Central Power — the brain and nerves. 7. The Repair Apparatus — the blood-vessels. 8. The Speaking and Breathing Apparatus — the larynx and lungs. 9. The Digestive Apparatus — the stomach and bow- els. to. The Waste Removers — the excretory apparatus 11. The Perceptive Apparatus — the senses. CHAPTER I THE COVERING -THE SKIN The first structure forms a covering for all the others. It may be compared with the sacking of which a bag is com- posed, which covers and protects the articles stored within it. As a rip or tear in the sacking exposes the contents of the bag to damage, so a cut or laceration of the skin subjects the structures underlying it to injury. In it terminate many of the nerves of sensation, and it is therefore a very important organ of touch. It is, moreover, a very efficient organ of excretion of fluid and gaseous waste products, throwing off under ordinary circumstances as much as two and a half pounds of fluid during a day. Those of its functions then which come under our observation are (i) enclosure of con- tained parts, (2) protection of subjacent organs, (3) the loca- tion of the sense of touch, and (4) excretion of certain waste products. The skin, simple though it seems to be, is a very complicated struc- ture, and not only contains many forms of the elements composing it but presents in its substance a number of organs of great importance to the maintenance of life and health. It is ordinarily considered in three layers, (1) the epidermis or cuticle, (2) the dermis or cutis, and (3) the subcutaneous cellular tissue. The epidermis or "scarf-skin" consists of successive layers of scaly particles, which are flattened and dried cells. These cells are techni- cally known as epithelium. They cover all surfaces of the body, both external and internal, lining alike the skin, mucous membrane, and se- rous membrane, and are of varying shapes. At some points, but a single layer of epithelial cells is found, while others present many. The number of cells may also be abnormally increased as in the callous spots on the hands of men engaged in heavy manual labor, or in warts which are local overgrowths of the epithelium forming the epidermis. The epidermis is well shown in a blister where it is elevated by a watery effusion. 3 CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE The dermis or " true skin " is a tissue composed of closely interwoven strong fibres with an admixture of elastic fibres, containing in its meshes many vessels, nerves, and minute glands. Blood-vessels are very abun- dant here, and hemorrhage results from the slightest incision. Here also lie the ends of the nerves from which is derived the sense of touch. The subcutaneous cellular tissue, from its close relation to the skin, may properly be considered as a part of it; its composition is practically the same, the apparent difference being caused by the loose manner in which the fibrous material is interwoven into a more open fabric. Enclosed in its meshes and spaces are found the origins of many of the appendages of the skin, together with numerous masses of fat. The appendages of the skin are of two kinds, — modifications of the epidermis, and excretory f"~ K¥;V llr $ Wl^lkP^I&i" glands. The hair and nails are, Ip^BW^^l^y' like warts and callosities, a local H^ ffilr^ overgrowth of the epidermic epi- fl x-f$9 thelium, differing from them, how- H \|P? ever, in not being abnormal and ■■ i/«r». t u»~y performing certain functions. Mm The sweat and sebaceous glands are organs of excretion located in the subcutaneous cellular tissue, and opening externally by mi- croscopic twisted ducts passing through both the dermis and the epidermis. The former are the source of perspiration, while the latter produce a yellow unctuous matter somewhat resembling suet, the func- tion of which is the lubrication of the surface of the body. When this sebaceous matter collects and hardens in the unclosed ducts, forming a sort of plug, the external end of which is black, we have the " black heads," " worms," or " grubs," very commonly seen in the skin of the face. These plugs of sebaceous matter, which assume, when squeezed out, a worm-like form, with a head formed by the outer end blackened probably by dust — are not infrequently supposed by the ignorant to be actual worms. If, however, the external orifice of the duct be closed by any acck dent, the sebaceous matter continues to collect behind the obstruction, distending the duct in all directions until a tumor known as a wen sometimes of considerable size, is formed. They are quite frequently Fig. I. — Section of skin, showing its layers and the origin of its appen- dages. THE PADDING THE FAT 5 found in the scalp, where they produce a peculiar knobby appear- ance. The excretion of waste products, particularly by the sweat glands, is essential to life, and its diminution produces poisoning of the system, as is seen in the dry skin of fevers, while its entire cessation would produce early death. CHAPTER II THE PADDING — THE FAT In packing into the same receptacle articles of various shapes and sizes, some tender like ripe fruit, and others hard and stiff like blocks of wood, some sort of padding or filling is necessary to prevent mutual injury. This function is per- formed in the bodies of man and animals by the fat which fills in the interstices between the various parts. In addition to this, the fat serves as a reserve of nourish- ment upon which the system may draw in case of lack of ordinary means of nutrition. This function is familiar in cases of illness ; when the appetite is poor and but little food is absorbed into the system, the sick one grows thin because the small quantity of food taken is not sufficient to sustain him, and he is compelled to draw upon the reserve of fat stored up in the interstices of his system. Perhaps the most important function of the fat, however, is the maintenance and retention of the animal heat. Every one has observed that a stout person requires less clothing than a thin one, and this is due to the greater amount of fat underlying his skin. While this constituent has its advantages, it may also be the source of no little inconvenience in certain cases : it may choke up certain organs so as to interfere with their action, and, by mingling with the tissues of other organs, render them weak and inefficient ; it may also obscure adjacent tis- sues, as is seen in the case of a wounded artery in a stout person, where the fat renders it difficult to find the bleeding 6 CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE vessel above the wound and interferes with proper compres- sion when it is found. There are three principal fats in the body, — stearin, palmitin, and olein. These all consist of glycerine, which is an alcohol, in combina- tion with a fatty acid, stearic, palmitic, or oleic, as the case may be. In the manufacture of soap, these acids set free the glycerine and combine instead with an alkali. Fat is ordinarily seen in the form of adi- pose tissue, which is formed by masses of minute vesicles consisting of an exceedingly delicate membrane filled with fatty matter and having an average diameter of ? £ikx j- «*«•« <*S Fig. 44. — The Principal Arteries in their Relation to Other Structur THE VEINS. Fig. 45. —The Veins of the Body,, 62 CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE liteal, plunges through the leg between the two bones and passes down to the ankle, whence it passes on to the back of the foot, where it becomes the dorsalis pedis artery, which is distributed to the back of the foot. The posterior tibial artery, the other terminal branch of the popliteal, makes its way down through the calf of the leg to the inner side of the ankle, where it curves forward about the internal maleolus into the sole of the foot and ends in the plantar arteries, which supply the sole of the foot. This artery lies very superficially at the ankle and can be readily felt or compressed there. The peroneal artery is given off by the posterior tibial soon after its origin, and extends down the outer side of the leg to the ankle. The Veins. — All veins carrying impure blood from the body back to the right side of the heart are called systemic, in contradistinction to the pulmonary veins, which carry pure blood from the lungs to the left side of the heart. There are four pulmonary veins, two to each lung. It being the duty of the systemic veins to carry back to the heart the blood which has been brought into the system by the arteries, it is natural that the veins should return back to the heart along the same lines as the arteries took in passing out. It is found then to be the case that one or more veins run parallel to every artery. Veins are, however, especially near the surface found unaccompanied by arteries. The systemic veins appear in two classes, the veins accompanying arteries and penetrating deeply into the tissues, and the superficial veins which run in or directly beneath the skin, where they can fre- quently and readily be seen. Accompanying each of the arteries of the foot, ankle, and leg are veins known by the same name as their accompanying artery, or as the vena coma of the artery. The anterior and posterior tibial veins unite in the bend of the knee to form the popliteal vein which, passing through the muscles to the front of the thigh, becomes the femoral vein, which in turn, passing up on the inner side of the femoral artery into the ab- domen, becomes the external iliac. The external iliac unites with the internal iliac to form the common iliac on each side, and these unite in turn to form the inferior vena cava, which delivers the blood into the right auricle. Into the vena cava in the abdomen also empty the hepatic vein from the liver, and the renal veins from the kidneys, the latter having removed from the blood passing through it the waste matter properly excreted there. The hepatic vein carries the blood from the liver, into which enters the portal vein formed by the union of the mesenteric, splenic, and gastric veins, collecting the blood from the organs concerned in digestion. This vessel subdivides in the liver substance to capillaries in which the blood, containing matter from the digestive organs, under- THE VEINS 63 goes certain changes before passing out into the general circulation through the hepatic vein. It will be observed that the liver contains two systems of veins, one the nutritive veins of the gland itself, and the other the digestive vessels. Of the superficial veins of the lower extremity, two are particularly prominent. The internal saphenous vein collects the blood from the superficial parts on the inner side of the back of the foot, and passes up the inner side of the lower limb, receiving, on its way, contributions from numerous tributary veins. Arrived at a point just below the fold of the groin, it dips down through a special opening in the fascia of the thigh, to enter the femoral vein. The external saphenous vein, from a similar origin on the outer side of the foot, passes up the middle of the back of the leg and empties into the popliteal vein just below the bend of the knee. The small veins of the hand unite into the deep radial and ulnar, which in turn unite just below the elbow to form the brachials, and these become successively the axillary and the subclavian, each of them following the course of the arteries of the same name. The superficial veins of the palmar face of the forearm are very con- spicuous and curious in their arrangement. The median vein passes up the middle of the forearm, and just below the bend of the elbow it divides into two branches, the median basilic and the median cephalic, which form a V in front of the elbow. These veins are joined just above the bend of the elbow by the radial and ulnar veins on either side, which changes the V in front of the elbow to an M. The ulnar and the median basilic unite to form the basilic, which a short distance above the elbow enters into the brachial. The radial and the median cephalic unite to form the cephalic, which passes up the outer side of the arm to the shoulder, where it dips down between the shoulder and the pectoral muscles to enter the axillary. In the days of bloodletting, these veins were the favorite sites for that operation. The median basilic is the larger, but on account of its crossing the brachial artery, which is liable to be wounded, the median cephalic was often chosen. These veins can readily be shown by tightly bandaging the arm above the elbow, when, the progress of the blood to the heart being checked, the veins below the bandage will swell and become prominent under the skin. The external jugular vein collects the blood from each side of the face and the superficial portions of the head and neck, and passes down the side of the neck to empty into the subclavian vein. These large veins can often be seen prominently projecting in the neck. They are the vessels usually cut by suicides in " cutting the throat." The internal jugular veins collect the blood from either side of the brain, and passing down by the side of the carotid artery, receiving by the way veins from the neck and head, join with the subclavian to form the common trunk, the innominate. 64 CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE At the junction of the left subclavian and internal jugular veins, the thoracic duct, containing the food digested in the alimentary canal, empties its contents into the blood. At the same point on the right side the right lymphatic duct enters the veins. The innominate veins, on either side, formed by the junction of the subclavian and internal jugular veins, unite on the left side of the spine just below the first costal cartilage to form the superior vena cava, which carries the blood into the right auricle. Vascular Glands. — The spleen is an oval glandular organ, five inches long by three wide and two thick, situated on the left side of the abdomen, presenting no duct, having no secretion, and connected with other organs only by the arteries which enter and the veins which pass out of it. Just what its functions may be is unknown. Its removal does not seem to affect the system in any evident way. It is thought by some to be the organ in which red blood-corpuscles are manufactured from the white, and that it also presides over the disintegration of the red corpuscles when they are worn out. By others it is considered to be a safety valve for the blood supplying the digestive organs. During the act of digestion these organs demand a much greater blood supply than when at rest, and it is thought that the surplus blood in the latter case is stored up in the spleen. In chronic malarial affections the spleen often becomes greatly enlarged, and is then vulgarly known as " ague cake." In the neck, just below the chin and in front and on either side of the upper part of the windpipe, is another gland possessing no duct, producing no secretion, and connected with other parts only by its blood- vessels, — this is the thyroid gland or " throat sweetbread." This, too, is thought to have something to do with the formation and destruction of the blood corpuscles, but its function is not known positively. It is this gland, become greatly enlarged, which forms the tumor in fr^nt of the neck in " goitre." CHAPTER VIII THE SPEAKING AND BREATHING APPARATUS —THE LARYNX AND THE LUNGS From the posterior portion of the cavities of the mouth and nose is suspended a combination of two organs which greatly resembles an inverted hollow tree. The trunk of the tree is formed by the larynx or organ of speech and the trachea or windpipe ; the trachea divides into two branches THE SPEAKING AND BREATHING APPARATUS. 65 called bronchi or bronchial tubes, and these in turn divide — the process of division keeping on until it finally terminates in very minute tubes or pouches, called the pulmonary vesi- cles, and these vesicles taken together form the lungs or, as the butchers call them, the "lights." Looking into the mouth, an arch will be seen at its back part, and this arch marks the end of the mouth proper. A similar condition exists at the posterior part of the nose. And the cavity into which both the nose and the mouth open is called the pharynx. In its lower portion are two apertures, that of the larynx in front and that of the oesophagus or " gullet " behind. The larynx, the enlarged upper part of the trachea or windpipe, is a short, irregularly shaped tube, in which is located the organ of speech. At its upper limit is a cover composed of cartilage, which closes the air passage when food is swallowed. At the moment of swallowing, the larynx is drawn up against this cover, the epiglottis, and the cavity is completely closed, so that, although the food passes directly over it, none can enter. The accidental lifting of the epiglottis during the act of swallowing, as sometimes occurs during laughter, allows food to enter the larynx, and the effort to expel it produces the choking and coughing always seen at that time. The larynx can be felt from the outside in front of the neck, where it appears as a hard lump just under the chin, known as " Adam's apple," from an old story that it was a por- tion of the forbidden fruit swallowed by the common ancestor of humanity, but which "stuck in his throat." It is composed of a number of cartilages bound together by ligaments, and moved upon one another by mus- cles. It is about an inch and a half long and an inch in diameter. Inside of the larynx are two nar- row fibrous bands extending across it from front to back : these are called the vocal cords, and they are relaxed or tightened by the laryngeal- muscles moving the cartilages. The vibration of the vocal cords, caused by the air passing over them from the lungs, produces the voice. Fig. 46. — Diagram of human larynx, trachea, bronchi, and lungs, show- ingthe ramification of the bronchi, and the division of the lungs into lobules. 66 CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE The larynx is constructed on the principle of a reed organ. It con- tains but one pipe, but that one is susceptible of such adjustment that no others are necessary. The vocal cords are the reeds. The larynx is continuous below with the trachea or windpipe, a tube composed of rings of cartilage, incomplete behind, and of elastic fibrous membrane. These rings keep the tube constantly open, and prevent interference with the passage of air by the collapse of the windpipe. The trachea is from three-quarters of an inch to an inch in diameter, and extends down the middle of the neck for four or four and a half inches into the chest, where, opposite the third dorsal vertebra, it divides into the right and left bronchi, one for each lung. The bronchi, constructed in exactly the same manner as the trachea, continue branching by dividing and subdividing to the terminal lobules of the lung. The rings, as the bronchi decrease in size, become scarcer and more irregular until they are but mere flakes of cartilage, and when the tubes are reduced to a diameter of one-fortieth of an inch, they disappear entirely. The tubes, however, still continue branching until the walls consist of but a thin elastic membrane, which expands into a little sac or lobule (Fig. 48), the walls of which are pouched out irregu- larly into little pockets called air vesicles or cells. The air passages are lined with mucous membrane, presenting upon its surface epithelial cells covered with cilia or hair-like processes, which by a continual waving motion carry off mucous and other secretions. The lungs or "lights" thus formed are two in number, one in each side of the chest. The fact of their substance consisting of air cells, with elastic walls, gives them a light, spongy appearance and feeling. They are covered externally by a smooth serous membrane, the pleura, which also lines the inner walls of the chest, providing smooth surfaces to avoid friction in the movements of the lungs in breathing. Although these two pleural surfaces are ordinarily in so close contact as to leave no vacancy between them, the cavity which may be formed is called the. pleural cavity. When these membranes become inflamed, we have pleurisy, and the dropsical secretion which is then thrown out makes the cavity between the two pleural surfaces apparent. Between the lungs lie the heart in the pericardium, the oesophagus or "gullet," the large bronchi, and the great vessels. Below the lungs lies the dome-like diaphragm or midriff, a most important factor in breathing. The pulmonary veins and arteries penetrate to the substance of the lungs with the bronchi, dividing and subdividing with them until, in the walls of the ultimate divisions, the air cells are found in the capillaries of the lungs. Between the blood in the capillaries and the air in the air vesicles, nothing intervenes except the thin walls of the vessels and the vesicles, so that it is possible for the blood readily to cast off its carbonic acid and other impurities into the air of the BREATHING OR RESPIRATION. 67 Fig. 47. — Lobule of lung. an. Exterior of lobules. bb. Vesicles of lung. cc. Smallest bronchi. lungs, and absorb from it the supply of oxygen needed for the nutrition of the system. The enormous extent of the wails of the air cells is evident when it is considered that the capilia ies contained in them must be able to contain a quantity cf blood equal to that contained in the capillaries of all the rest of the body taken together. It has been estimated that the surface afforded by them is equal to more than ten thousand square inches. How vast the number of these ceJ's is, may be inferred from this fact. Breathing or respiration consists of the alternate enlargement and contrac- tion of the chest, by means of which air is drawn into or forced out of the lungs. Breathing air into the lungs is called Aspiration, and expelling it from the lungs is called ^.rpiration. The chief agent in breathing is the diaphragm or midriff, the great dome-like muscular floor of the chest, which, when its fibres contract, flattens down the dome, increasing the amount of space in the chest, and at the same time causing the abdomen beneath it to swell out. In addition to this, the capacity of the chest is further in- creased by the muscles which draw the ribs upward and outward. These acts create a vacancy in the chest, which is filled by the air rushing through the windpipe into the air cells of the lungs. This is inspiration. Expiration, or breathing out, is a much more simple act, and consists simply in the relaxation of the muscles causing inspiration, — the diaphragm resumes its dome-like projection into the chest, the ribs drop to their original position, and the elastic lungs contract to adapt themselves to the reduced capacity of the chest. These movements occur from fifteen to eighteen times 5 minute in health. Fig. 48. — Section of a single lobule of human lung. a. Ultimate bronchial tube. b. Cavity of lobule. c,c, c. Pulmonary cells or vesicles. 68 CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE In case of an obstruction in the windpipe, or any other interference with the free entrance and exit of air, the breathing is much more diffi- cult, and in this case most of the muscles of the chest, neck, and shoulders, and some on the back, join with the muscles named in the effort to expand the chest — the act then being called forced respiration. There are a number ot common acts closely allied to breathing which it may be interesting to consider here. Sighing consists of a pro- longed and almost noiseless inspiration, followed by a sud- den noisy expiration, due to the elastic recoil of the lungs and chest walls. In hiccup the inspiration is sudden, from the spasmod- ic action of the diaphragm, causing the air to rush sud- denly through the larynx and produce the peculiar sound. Coughing consists first of an inspiration and then, when the lungs have been filled, the air is not immediately let out through the larynx, which is momentarily closed so that the abdominal muscles strongly act in pushing the viscera up against the dia- phragm, and increase the pressure on the air in the lungs, until the tension is sufficient to overcome the spasmodic closure which opposes its passage. This makes it possible to drive a stream of air with con- siderable force upon any mass of mucus or other obstructing matter and expel it. Sneezing is similar to coughing, except that the force of the expi- ratory act is spent on the nostrils. Speaking has already been referred to ; it should be observed that the vocal cords produce the sounds only, and that the words ar° formed by the tongue, teeth, lips, and palate. Singing is a modification of speaking, the key being altered by vari- ations in the tension of the vocal cords. Fig., 49. — The changes in the chest during breathing. In A, the ribs are seen to be lifted up and the diaphragm pressed down to in- crease the capacity of the chest in inspiration. In B, the ribs are seen to be drawn down, and the diaphragm is lifted up, diminishing the capacity of the chest in expiration. BREATHING AND THE BREATH 69 Sobbing, laughing, and yawning are still other modifications of the act of breathing. In each respiratory act, during ordinary breathing, from twenty-five to thirty cubic inches of air are drawn in and expelled from the lungs. This quantity of air, constantly flowing in and out, is known as the tidal air. But much more than this quantity can be drawn into the chest. After an ordinary inspiration, about a hundred cubic inches of air can be drawn into the lungs in addition to that already there ; this is the com- plemental air. On the contrary, after an ordinary expiration, about a hundred cubic inches of air can be expelled from the lungs by a forcible expiration, and this is the reserve air. But after every effort has been made to empty the air cells, there still remains a quantity of air equal to about a hundred cubic inches; this is the residual air. The amount of air which can be forcibly expired after taking the deepest possible inspiration, is the vital capacity, and, including the tidal, comple- mental, and reserve air, amounts to about 225 cubic inches. The complemental and reserve air are drawn upon in running, row- ing, or other violent exercise, at which time the full vital capacity of the lungs is often employed. The air which we inspire contains seventy-nine parts of nitrogen and twenty-one parts of oxygen, with a mere trace of carbonic acid and other matters of animal or vegetable origin. When, however, it is returned to the atmosphere by ^jrpiration, its composition has been changed. None of the nitrogen has been lost — indeed, it rather gains in amount ; but five parts of the oxygen have been lost, while the car- bonic acid has increased by four and a half parts. Light as are these two gases, a man ordinarily throws out in the breath more than two pounds of carbonic acid a day, and consumes in the lungs a trifle less of oxygen. A large quantity of water and some animal matter are also thrown out from the lungs. The blood coming into the lungs from the body is laden with carbonic acid to be expelled there. This gas, when breathed in large quantities, is fatal to life. Oxygen in the air that is breathed is an absolute necessity, and its absence for but a short period will cause rapid death. In a tightly closed room the oxygen of the air may be used up by repeatedly breathing it until, unless there is some means of renewing the supply, smothering will close life just as surely as if a pillow were pressed tightly over the face. The chinks about the doors and windows often allow the yO CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE passage of sufficient fresh air into a room to prevent death, while at the same time not admitting enough to fully supplv the demands of the system for oxygen ; headache, languor, and unaccountable weakness result from this partial smother- ing. It must be admitted, however, that the disagreeable sensations are probably due also to some extent to breathing again the decaying animal matters thrown out in small quan- tities in each breath. The continual breathing of impure air with an insufficient supply of oxygen has a deleterious effect upon the health, and many deaths have been hastened if not directly produced by it. This is the reason why ventilation or the supply of ample quantities of fresh air has been so strongly dwelt upon by physicians and sanitarians ; and why the medical man insists so earnestly upon the desirability of providing sleeping and living rooms with suitable ventilators, and with ample means for keeping them open. CHAPTER IX THE DIGESTIVE APPARATUS — THE ALIMENTARY CANAL AND ITS APPENDAGES The digestive apparatus is that portion of the human ma- chine in which material destined to repair the wear and tear is worked up into a condition suitable for its purpose. The process by which the oxygen of the air has been conveyed into the system through the lungs has been described, and it remains to refer briefly to the manner in which other materi- als are adapted to the nutritive process. The forms in which foods are absorbed are four in number : (i) Nitrogenous matter, of which the egg is a perfect exam- ple. (2) Fats. (3) Sugar; and (4) metals. All these are present at the same time in some articles of food, such as milk, while others may contain but one or two. The object of digestion, then, is to convert these four varieties of food THE DIGESTIVE APPARATUS J \ into a form suitable for introduction into the blood, and carriage to the system by it. The first step in the process of digestion occurs in the mouth. Here the food is chewed by the teeth into a mass of fine particles, each of which can readily be reached by the digestive juices. The teeth have been fully described in connection with the anatomy of the jaws. They are assisted in their work by the tongue, a large, free, muscular organ, which keeps the food between the teeth during the act of chewing, and forms it into a mass of a shape suitable for swallowing. Opening into the mouth are three pairs of glands like minute bunches of grapes, which also contribute to digestion. They secrete the saliva or " spittle." The parotid glands lie just below the temples on either side ; their location will be remembered by every one when it is re- called that it is the inflammation and swelling of these glands which causes the " mumps." Under the lower jaw and at the root of the tongue are other salivary glands, the submaxillary and sublingual glands. Chewing the food mixes it with saliva, which not only lubri- cates the mass and makes it easy to swallow, but changes a portion of the starches it contains into sugar. Bread, beans, corn, or wheat can- not be absorbed without change ; the starch, of which they chiefly con- sist, must first be transformed into sugar. Up to this point the food has been under the control of the will, but now it is pushed by the tongue back into the pharynx, over the epi- glottis, where it is seized by the pharyngeal muscles and passed into the oesophagus or "gullet," and the will can control it no longer. A knowl- edge of this fact is sometimes useful in administering pills to children or animals ; if the mouth be opened and the pill be pushed back to the root of the tongue, it passes beyond the child's control and into the stomach. A mouthful of water swallowed immediately after will help to carry it into the stomach. The alimentary canal is a musculo-membranous tube from twenty to thirty feet in length, with a diameter varying at different points, re- ceiving ducts connecting it with certain accessory organs, and bearing different names in its different parts. The oesophagus or gullet, the first division of the alimentary canal, runs behind the windpipe and the heart, in front of the spine and be- tween the lungs, through the neck and chest, perforates the diaphragm or midriff, and ends in an expansion of the canal, called the stomach. It is about ten or eleven inches long from the pharynx opposite the fifth cervical vertebra to the stomach opposite the ninth dorsal vertebra. Its muscular coat is composed of involuntary fibres so arranged as to carry the food downwards. When not dilated by food, it is collapsed. The stomach (Fig. 50) is the most dilated portion of the alimentary canal, and it is the principal organ of digestion. It appears in the form 72 CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE of an irregularly conical bag with tubes opening into either end, and lies chiefly on the left side of the abdomen, under the diaphragm, and protected by the lower ribs. Its size is subject to greater variations than any other organ in the body, according as it is full or empty, and according to individuals ; but it averages twelve inches long and tour in diameter, with an average capacity of about four pints. The oesoph- agus enters at the larger extremity, and its opening is called the cardiac orifice, from its proximity to the heart ; its other opening, connecting it with the small intestine, is called the pyloric orifice, and is guarded by a sort of valve, the pylorus or "gate keeper." Fig. 50. — A section of the stomach and upper bowel, showing the internal arrange- ment, the location of the hepatic and pancreatic ducts from the liver and pan- creas respectively, and the valvulae conniventes. The walls of the stomach are formed (a) by an external smooth serous coat, derived from the peritoneum, the general lining of the abdomen; (b) two muscular coats extending horizontally and perpendicularly, and by their contractions producing the peculiar movements of the organ ; (c) an internal lining of mucous membrane continuous with that of the intestine below and, through the oesophagus, with that of the mouth above. In the mucous membrane are found a multitude of glands which, when food comes into the stomach, pour forth the gastric juice, a sour liquid which acts upon the food in the stomach and con- tinues the process of digestion. So long as any food remains in the stomach, the muscles keep up a churning movement which thoroughly mixes the contents with the gastric juice, and greatly aids the digestion. THE STOMACH AND BOWELS 73 A small part of the food is completely digested here and absorbed into the blood in the capillaries of the stomach ; the remainder is converted into a thick, whitish fluid called chyme, which passes on into the small intestine, where it is acted upon by other agents. f-'ig. 51. — The contents of the abdomen. The liver is shown at the top, drawn up so as to show the gall bladder underneath. The stomach is seen on the right with the duodenum passing out from it. Crossing the abdomen just below the stomach is the large intestine, which may be traced up the right side of the body, across, and down the left side. In the centre is seen the small intestine gathered into a twisted mass. At the pyloric end of the stomach, and under the left end of the hver, the alimentary canal contracts again into a slender tube called the small 74 CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE intestine, bowel, or gut. About one inch in diameter and twenty feet long, it is attached to the lumbar portion of the spine by a membrane called the mesentery, which is disposed in numerous folds to adapt itself to the turns of the intestine, which is rolled into a mass suitable to lie in the cavity of the abdomen. The small intestine is divided by anatomists into three parts : the first eight or ten inches is known as the duodenum ; the two fifths following is called the jejunum, from the Latin word meaning empty, because it is usually found empty after death ; the remaining three fifths is known as the ileum, from the Greek word meaning to twist, because of the numerous folds into which it is thrown. The small intestine presents a serous, a muscular, and a mu- cous coat. The mucous coat presents numerous folds called valvulae conniventes (Fig. 50), which greatly increase the amount of surface coming into contact with the food. It also presents an immense num- ber of little projections called villi, which give it a velvety appearance : through the villi the digested food passes into the blood. A number of glands are also found producing a fluid, the " succus entericus," which promotes digestion. Into the small intestine open ducts from the liver and pancreas (Fig. 50), giving passage to fluids fulfilling a most important function in digestion. There are two important glands which pour into the small intestine fluids essential to digestion : these are the liver and pancreas. The liver is the largest gland, and indeed the largest single organ, in the body, weighing three or four pounds, and meas- uring ten or twelve inches in breadth, six or seven in thickness, and two or three in depth. It lies on the right side of the abdomen, and is slung by its ligaments high up against the diaphragm and under the lower ribs. It is a large, reddish brown organ, marked by a number of fissures di- viding it into lobes, in one of which lies a membranous bag, the gall bladder, in which is held in reserve a quantity of the secretion of the liver. It is connected with the small intestine by the portal vein, which collects the blood from the bowels, and by the gall duct, which carries its secretion into them. The liver has two chief functions : (1) It produces the bile, a yellowish brown fluid of an intensely bitter taste, which (a) assists in converting the contents of the small intestine into a form suitable for absorption Fig. 52. — The liver seen from below. THE PANCREAS AND LARGE INTESTINE 75 into the blood, and {b) acts as a stimulant to the muscles of the bowel, thus producing some cathartic action. (2) It completes the digestion of certain portions of the food already absorbed into the blood, and produces sugar, the burning of which aids in maintaining the heat of the body. The pancreas, which derives its name from the Greek words meaning " all-flesh," is known to butchers as the " belly sweetbread," in distinc- tion from the thyroid gland or " throat sweetbread," and the thymus gland or " breast sweetbread." It is a tongue-like mass lying across the back of the abdomen with its smaller extremity or " tail " on the left, is six or eight inches long, and from a half an inch to an inch thick. From its larger end passes out the pancreatic duct, which joins with the bile duct from the liver and enters the small _ jr-f^^y^, - ILgi!| „ atic juice completes the mU'jfy?^ S ^^^ ' ' 'X') l ^^Tj^^ ^ ^' tion is the division of Fig. 53. — The pancreas, fats and oils into parti- cles sufficiently minute to permit of absorption into the blood. The digested food is now a milky fluid called chyle. The process of digestion, then, begun by finely dividing the food and converting a part of the starch into sugar in the mouth, is con- tinued by the churning movement and the mixture with the gastric juice in the stomach, converting the food into chyme. The chyme, in the small intestine, mixes with the bile and the pancreatic and intestinal juices, which convert it into chyle. Certain portions of the digested food are absorbed into the circulation by the veins of the stomach, and others pass through the veins of the. mesentery and the portal vein into the liver, while still others are absorbed by a set of vessels called lacteal from their milky white appearance when full of chyle, and which pass from the villi of the intestine into the mesentery and through small glands also in the substance of the mesentery, into the thoracic duct, which empties them into the left innominate vein, whence they pass into the general circulation. The small intestine, just above the right groin, runs into the large intestine (Fig. 51), which, about five feet in length and thrice the size of the lesser bowel, passes up to about the level of the " navel," arches across the abdomen, and descends on the other side, where, passing to the middle line, it descends and opens on the external surface of the body. A valve — the ileo-caecal valve — at the junction of the small with the large intestine prevents the return of matter which has passed j6 CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE into the latter. A dilated pocket at the beginning of the large intestine is called the caecum, and from it passes a worm-like process called the appendix vermiformis, the function of which is unknown, but which is of great surgical interest from its liability to become inflamed and produce an abscess which is exceedingly dangerous to life. The re- mainder of the large intestine, except the last six or eight inches, is called the colon. The last portion is called the rectum, and terminates externally in the anus or fundament. But little if any digestive action goes on in the large intestine, the principal work of which is absorption. As its contents approach its lower extremity, they become more and more solid and free from nourishment, until finally only the waste matter is left, in the form of excrement, which is thrown off. CHAPTER X THE APPARATUS FOR THE DISPOSAL OF WASTE — THE EXCRETORY APPARATUS A considerable amount of matter is introduced into the alimentary canal which cannot be utilized for the nourish- ment of the system, and the various operations of the human machine cause parts to be worn away which, in the process of repair, are replaced by new ones and thrown off. This process of casting off useless, worn, or waste matters from the body is called excretion. Excretion is accomplished through the skin, the lungs, the rectum, and the kidneys with the bladder. In the skin, which has been described in the chapter devoted to it, are millions of glands through which water is extracted from the blood and thrown off — the sweat glands, producing the perspiration. The evaporation of the perspiration is an important provision for keeping the surface of the body cool, and is the original utilization of the prin- ciple which the soldier adopts when he wets the canvas cover of his canteen in hot weather to cool its contents. Perspiring is constantly going on, although it is imperceptible except during unusual physical exercise or great heat, when the sweat is poured out faster than it can be removed by evaporation, and it stands out in drops upon the skin. When perspiration is unusually abundant, the amount of water excreted by the kidneys is diminished. In addition to the water, the perspiration THE EXCRETORY APPARATUS 77 carries out of the system salt, — which can readily be appreciated by the taste, — carbonic acid, a poisonous exhalation called urea, and other noxious substances. In case of extensive injuries, such as burns, where a considerable extent of the skin is injured so that its excretory functions cannot be exercised, and the blood relieved of the impurities collecting there, serious and often fatal results may follow. The lungs, which have been considered in the chapter on the breath- ing and speaking apparatus, throw off more than two pounds of carbonic acid a day, a little less than a pint of water, and about three grains of decaying animal matter and ammonia. Reference to the rectum has been made in the preceding chapter in connection with the large intestine. As the food taken through the lips passes down the alimentary canal, it comes in contact with various juices which prepare the nourishing parts of it for absorption, and these portions are gradually passed into the blood at points throughout the stomach and bowels until, when it arrives in the lower bowel, only the refuse matter which cannot be utilized is left. This takes the form of excrement and is cast off. The kidneys are two glandular or- gans situated in the loins on the pos- terior wall of the abdomen on either side of the spinal column. They are shaped like large beans, and are about four inches long, two and a half broad, and an inch and a half thick; they weigh about a quarter of a pound each. They are composed chiefly of arteries, veins, and urinary tubes, and these are combined in such a way as to produce a cortex or bark-like sub- stance and a medullary or central sub- stance. The arteries are larger than the veins, so that a greater bulk of blood is brought into the kidneys than is carried away from them; the bulk is reduced by the passage of a portion of the water with certain waste products, notably urea, into the urinary tubules. The extremity of each urinary tubule is expanded into a sac (Fig. 55), into which a small arterial twig runs and is subdivided and turned and twisted upon itself, until it passes into a minute venous tube of a somewhat smaller size ; the blood then being pushed through into the vein, the water is forced out Fig. 54. — A kidney divided length- wise. I. The cortex. 2. Pyra- mids of urinary tubes. 3, 3. Apex of pyramids. 4. Pelvis of the kidney. 5. Ureter. 6. Renal ar- tery. 7. Renal vein. 8. Small vessels in the kidney. ^8 CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE through the walls of the small vessels into the enclosing sac and carried off by the urinary tubule. The sacs with the intertwined vessels are called malpighian tufts. These tufts form the principal portion of the cortical substance of the kidney.. Besides the water removed from the blood in the kidneys, a considerable number of chemical salts are excreted with it, and some waste animal com- pounds, particularly urea, a noxious substance referred to in connection with the perspiration. The fluid thus formed of water, salts, and anima! compounds is a yellowish liquid known as urine. The urinary tubes pass down to a cavity at what corresponds to the hilus of the bean, and is called the pelvis of the kidney, from which passes out a tube about the size of a goose quill, and runs down along the back to the bladder: this is the ureter, and its function is to carry the urine from the kidneys to the bladder. A little more than three pints of urine is formed during a day. The urinary bladder is a bag formed of involuntary muscle and membranes, lying in the cavity of the pelvis. Its function is to store the fluid continu- ally secreted by the kidneys until such time as is convenient to discharge it. When moderately distended, it con- tains about a pint, and is oval in form, measuring about five inches in height and three in breadth. In the bladder chemical salts may settle and form a hard deposit, which in- creases in size until it resembles a veritable stone : this is " stone in the bladder." The act of discharging the contents of the bladder is under the control of the will, and occurs several times a day. Fig. 55. — Greatly enlarged diagram, showing the arrangement of the parts of the kidney. I. Uri- nary tubules. 2. Malpighian tuft. 3. Artery. 4. Artery entering the tuft. 5, 6. Malpighian tuft, with the sac removed. 7, 7, Veins emerging from the tufts. 8, 8. Veins. THE SENSES TOUCH AND TASTE 79 CHAPTER XI THE PERCEPTIVE APPARATUS — THE SENSES The senses are the portals of the intelligence ; for through them all perceptions find their way to the seat of the intelli- gence in the brain. They comprise touch, taste, smell, hear- ing, and sight. The sense of touch and its relation with the brain through the sensory nerve filaments distributed throughout the body has been described in connection with the nerves. In the sense of touch is also included the appreciation of heat and cold. In connection with the bones reference has been made to the wonderful mechanism of the hand. A great portion of the usefulness of that member is due to the sense of touch, which is most highly developed on the palmar face, and in particular at the tips of the fingers. The sense of taste, situated in the cavity of the mouth, consists in the perception of the flavor of articles, particularly in their relation to food. A sweet, a sour, a bitter, or a saltish taste is understood by every one. Dependent upon taste is the appetite. The study of the gratification of the taste has been the life work of not a few, and the art of cookery — the preparation of food in such a manner as to gratify the taste — is a vocation well worthy the attention of a higher grade of mind than is wont to be devoted to it. The adaptation of food to the taste has a hygienic value ; for experi- ence has shown that, as a general rule, the most savory food is the most easily digested. There seems to be a correlation between the sense of taste and that of sight as referred to the perception of colors, although the former has not been developed to the same extent as the latter. There should be considered, in cooking, a harmony of savors, in order to attain full palatability, just as in painting a harmonious combination of colors is needed to please the eye. The sense of taste is most highly developed in the tongue, and the full advantage of the sense is obtained only after the food has been passed back over the tongue to the pharynx. The object to be tasted 8o CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE must be moistened in order to make its impression upon the nerves of this sense. The perception of taste is carried to the brain by a branch of the trifacial and by the glosso-pharyngeal, both cranial nerves, the latter supplying the back of the tongue, and the former the tip. Upon the top of the tongue toward the back are seen eight or ten minute prominences arranged in the form of a V : these are the circum- vallate papillae, and contain the terminations of the filaments of the glosso-pharyngeal nerves. Along the sides and tip are a number of smaller prominences called the fungiform papillae, containing the ter- minations of the lingual branch of the trifacial nerve. A third set, called the filiform papillae, are distributed over the tongue, but are probably not involved at all in the sense of taste. The back portion of the tongue perceives taste the best, although the tip more quickly appre- ciates sweet and pungent savors, the bitter and savory flavors being best perceived at the back. The sense of smell consists in the perception of odors. This sense is located in the upper chamber of the nose, and is due to the filaments of the olfactory, the first cranial nerve, which form a network on the mucous membrane of that cav- ity (Fig. 56). Odors are minute particles given off by the substances from which they emanate. And it is necessary for the action of the sense of smell that air, bearing the odor, should be breathed through the nose, when the particles come, in contact with the mucous membrane where the sense is located. Fig. 56. — The nose divided down the middle line to show the distribution of the olfactory nerve. The roof of the mouth is seen below. The sense of hearing consists in the appreciation of sonorous or sound-producing vibrations. That these vibrations are better transmitted by solid bodies even the savage knows, when he puts his ear to the ground to hear the approaching footsteps of his enemy. In the same way sound can be transmitted to the auditory nerve through the bones of the head as well as through the orifice of the ear, as can be shown by taking a watch between the teeth and stopping the ears with the fingers. SENSES OF HEARING AND SEEING It is rarely possible, however, for the ear to be connected with the source of sound vibrations by solids, and they are usually transmitted by the air and through the ear. The ear, or organ of hearing, is composed of the pinna, the auditory meatus, the tympanic membrane, the middle ear, and the internal ear. The pinna is the external portion, the object of which is to collect the vibrations into the orifice of the auditory meatus. This portion is not of much importance in man, but in the rabbit or the donkey its importance is very great. The vi- brations collected by the pinna then pass into the auditory meatus, which is a short tube closed at its • inner end by a thin, strong mem- brane stretched tightly across it, the tympanic membrane. On the other side of the tympanic mem- brane is another cavity, the middle ear, closed at its inner end by bone, in which, however, are apertures also closed with membrane ; through the middle ear and connecting the tym- panic with the other membrane is a chain of very small bones called the ossicles of the ear. Beyond the middle ear is the internal ear, a cavity filled with fluid, in which reside the terminations of the auditory nerve, the cranial nerve which carries perception of sound to the brain. In order to reach the intelli- gence, then, the vibrations have to pass through the air, the tympanic membrane, the ossicles, the membrane of the internal ear, the fluid of the internal ear, and the auditory nerve. The sense of sight is the perception of form, size, color, light, or shade. It is the most important of the senses, and gives origin to the greatest number of perceptions. If a room be darkened, and light be admitted only through a small aperture, an image of the external objects opposite to the aperture may be seen on the wall where the rays of light strike. Were the rays of light further concentrated by a lens, the image would be still more distinct. The photog- rapher's camera is but a reproduction of this room on a small Fig. 57. — The ear, the temporal bone being divided to show the internal structures. I, I, I. The pinna. 2. The auditory meatus. 2'. The mem- brana tympana. 3. The middle ear. 6. The internal ear, showing the cochlea and semicircular canals. 82 CONSTRUCTION OF THE HUMAN MACHINE scale, and the eye is the original embodiment of .both, h is a dark cavity, upon the posterior wall of which the filaments of the optic nerve are spread, so that when the light passes into the cavity through the pupil, an image of the objects opposite to it is formed on the posterior wall and transmitted by the optic nerve to the intelligence in the brain. The eye is a ball surrounded by three coats, the internal of which — the retina — is an expansion of the optic nerve, and destined to receive the impressions of sight ; the external in front is called the cornea, and is a transparent membrane ; behind, it is a strong, whitish opaque membrane, called the sclerotic. The middle coat is incomplete in front, where it is called the iris, and the opening in the centre is called the pupil ; the iris may be blue, gray, brown, or black, and from it the Fig. 58. — A section of the eye. I. The sclerotic coat. 2. The cornea, connecting with the sclerotic coat by a bevelled edge. 3. The choroid coat. 6, 6. The iris. 7. The pupil. 8. The retina. 10, II, II. Chambers or cavities of the eye, con- taining the aqueous humor. 12. The crystalline lens. 13. The vitreous humor. 15. The optic nerve. 14, 16. Arteries of the eye. eye derives its color; the middle coat behind is a dark-brown mem- brane, profusely supplied with blood-vessels, and called the choroid coat. Set in front of the eye, just back of the iris, is a lens, the crys- talline lens, and before and behind the lens the cavities are filled with transparent matter called respectively the aqueous and vitreous humors. The eyeball is set into the orbit of the skull, and protected by the overarching brows and by the curtain-like eyelids, and the visible portion pf the eyeball, except the cornea, is covered by the conjunctiva^ THE EYE 83 a membrane very abundantly supplied with blood-vessels and very sub- ject to inflammation. The inflammation of the conjunctiva is the ordi- nary "sore eyes," and is technically known' as conjunctivitis. In using a burning-glass, it will be noticed that the glass has to be at a certain distance from the object to be burned in order to affect it. This is the distance at which the rays of light are concentrated by the lens, and is called its focus. Glasses of varying degrees of convexity have different foqi. The crystalline lens of the eye has certain muscles which cause it to adapt itself to varying foci ; this is the " power of accommodation." In some persons the lens is so altered that it cannot adapt itself to all circumstances. If the person can see better at dis- tances, the lens is not convex enough, and the focus for near objects passes behind the retina; such a person is hypermetropic or "far- sighted," and needs convex glasses. If the person can see only at short distances, the lens is too convex, and the focus strikes in front of the retina, and the person is myopic or " near-sighted." Old people are often afflicted with far-sightedness, because, as age advances, the crys- talline lens becomes harder and the muscles of accommodation cannot make it convex as before : this is called presbyopia or " old eyes." Sometimes the lens is not symmetrical, and the focus is not clearly thrown upon the retina: this is astigmatism, and a person affected with it would want a glass formed of a segment of a cylinder. It not infrequently happens that the eye cannot distinguish colors. This is called " color-blindness." In some cases the power of discrimi- nating between colors is entirely lost ; in others the recognition of certain colors only is absent. A man may be green blind or red blind, for example. This defect is of vital importance, particularly in railway or steamship management, where signals are made by different colored flags or lights, as well as in many other avocations where the percep- tion of colors is necessary. Part II THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR CHAPTER XII GERMS, THEIR ACTION AND ITS CONTROL When a ray of sunlight shines into a room, the sunbeam will be seen to be full of minute particles or motes floating in the air. These are not observed by the naked eye except under an extremely bright light, and from this we recognize the fact that the atmosphere is filled with floating particles. Some of these are large enough to be seen under a bright light, as we have remarked, but by far the larger number are invisible except with the aid of a microscope. The character and composition of these vary greatly. They may be merely floating bits of metal "or of vegetable origin ; they may be particles emanating from an animal ; they may be decaying emanations from the breath ; or they may be independent living organisms. The discovery of the latter class, called ?nicro-organisms, or microbes, has within a few years thrown a flood of light upon the practice of medicine and revolutionized the art of surgery. Many diseases are now acknowledged to be due to these micro-organisms. In consumption, for example, the tubercle bacillus — the micro-organism of consumption — finds its way into the system through the food or the breath, and wanders about until it finds a weak spot where circumstances are favorable for its growth. In the more common class of cases, this is found in the lungs, and here it establishes its home and increases and multiplies until the subject is carried off by the disease which it has planted in his system. The micro- organism of cholera and of some other diseases have been recognized. There is another class of micro-organisms which require a break in the skin in order to exercise their power. These are the microbes which in former days rendered surgical opera- 87 88 THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR tions so dangerous. An instance of the terrible power of some of them was of almost daily occurrence. How often has death resulted from the prick of a pen-knife or even the scratch of a pin ! And in how many other cases has death been averted only by the amputation of a limb which has received some apparently insignificant wound. Micro-organisms may be introduced into a wound either by the instrument making the wound, they may be floated to it in the air, or they may be derived from other substances coming in contact with it. Finding in a wound a suitable soil for its growth, the micro-organism multiplies with incred- ible rapidity, and by its presence produces processes of decay which result in the formation of poisonous substances called "toxins." The products of the decay set up in a wound by micro-organisms are not only irritating to the wound itself, producing inflammation and pus, but when absorbed into the body cause disease of the entire system. The agency of micro-organisms, them in the production of disease, and the contamination of wounds being known, it becomes evident that the development of such troubles can be avoided (i) by preventing the entrance of micro-organ- isms, and (2) by their destruction in case they should be present. Upon these premises is founded the modern treat- ment of consumption, cholera, and other affections. The physician of the present day aims at the destruction of the infecting microbe in these cases by flooding the saliva in the first case and the excrement in the latter with a solution which shall have the power to annihilate the microbes. Such a solution is called a germicidal solution, and the agent giving it its power is a germicide or u germ-killer." Materials from which germs are absent are said to be " ster- ile 1 ' ; anything which has been rendered sterile is said to have been "sterilized." Heat is the most efficient sterilizing agent, and may be applied by means of boiling in a solution, or by the application of steam brought to a high temperature. Where an operation is performed upon a part not previously infected, infection by micro-organisms is avoided by prevent- ing contact with the wound of any dressings or instruments GERMS, THEIR ACTION AND ITS CONTROL 89 which have not been carefully sterilized. The surgeon fur- ther contributes to the sterilization of the operation by the most careful cleansing of his own hands and of the parts to be operated upon previous to his work, and by scrupulously preserving cleanliness during the operation. In case of a wound which might have become infected, such as would be the case with any one received out of the limits of a properly equipped surgical operating-room, or with any instrument not previously purified, all possible infection should be avoided by bathing it with a germicidal solution which would either kill the microbes, or an antiseptic solution which would paralyze and render them harmless. To prevent infection from the atmosphere, some surgeons keep a germicidal solution constantly flowing over the parts during an entire operation. When the time comes for a wound to be dressed, the future contact of micro-organisms is prevented by the application of a dressing that has itself been made antiseptic. Such dress- ings are prepared by filling a clean dressing with a germicide in a certain proportion. Cheese-cloth or tarlatan are the fabrics most frequently used for this purpose, and when so treated are called " antiseptic gauze." Where a bit of anti- septic gauze is available in case of a wound, it is a good plan to apply it at once in the absence of a medical man and retain it in place until removed by a surgeon. In military life, such a dressing is made constantly avail- able by the provision of the first aid dressing-packet issued to soldiers. The essential portion of this packet, which is fully described in the chapter on dressings and applications, is an antiseptic compress which is designed to be applied immediately after the wound has been received. It must not be inferred that the use of antiseptic agents as a protection against micro-organisms insures a good result in every case of injury, for such is not the case. Antiseptics merely greatly increase the probability of a happy issue, and their effect upon microbes may be counteracted by other causes. As has been remarked, where absolute cleanliness in dress- 90 THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR ings and handling of the wound can be had in a fresh wound in a healthy person, antiseptics are not necessary. But this means surgical cleanli7iess, which does not mean the same as ordinary cleanliness, for the daintily white fabric from my lady's linen closet may be a nest of unseen carriers of putre- faction. Surgical cleanliness signifies the absence of germ life. Surgical cleanliness by means of sterilized applications, however, is not always obtainable, in which case ordinarily clean dressings and clean water may be used, since they are apt to be surgically clean also. It is sometimes of advantage, when in localities which do not appear to be clean, to add also some one of the germicidal agents. The most available for this purpose are the following : Carbolic acid, a dangerous corrosive poison when taken internally, was the first antiseptic agent to be used in sur- gery. It should be in small transparent crystals, and used in the proportion of two teaspoonfuls to the pint of water. Corrosive sublimate, when obtainable, is the most efficient germicide we have. It is, however, a most powerful poison, and must be greatly diluted when used. In the proportion of four grains to the pint of water, however, wounds may be bathed by it with perfect security. Corrosive sublimate does not dissolve rapidly in cold water, but a solution is quickly made by heating the water. The destruction of germs by the disinfection of clothing, furniture, and houses, and its application to the prevention of the spread of disease, is again considered in the chapter on hygiene. CHAPTER XIII KNOTS AND BANDAGES In the application, particularly of extemporized dressings, the knowledge of the proper method of tying a knot is of the greatest importance. If a bandage be fastened with an inse- KNOTS AND BANDAGES 91 cure knot, it may slip and cause irreparable damage. Conse- quently the consideration of the subjects of knots should not be overlooked. The False Knot or "Granny." — This knot is described only for the purpose of showing what should not be used. It is formed — the ends of the cord or handkerchief being held in the two hands — - by winding the end held in the right Fig. 59. — The false knot in cord. Fig. 60. — The false knot in hand- kerchief. hand over that held in the left, and then, changing hands, winding that now held in the right hand over that held in the left. In other words, the " granny " knot is tied by simply repeating the same movements in making the second turn that were made in the first, and for that reason it is the knot most commonly tied by those who have not been instructed. The Square or Reef Knot. — This knot is very secure when tied, so that it may be trusted to hold any kind of appliance in place. It is also very easy to untie, a matter of no little consequence in removing dressings. This knot should always be employed. It is formed — the ends of the cord or hand- kerchief being held in the two hands — by winding the end held Fig. 61. — The reef knot in cord. Fig. 62. — The reef knot in handkerchief. in the right hand over that held in the left, — in this respect being exactly the same as the " granny " ; then winding the end now held in the left hand over that held in the right. In 9 2 THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR other words, the same end of the handkerchief is wound over the other in both instances, the first turn. it having changed hands after Other knots which it is useful to know are the surgeon's knot and the clove hitch. The surgeon's knot is used by surgeons particularly in drawing tissue together, to prevent slipping of the first turn of the knot. It is tied simply by turning the right- hand end of the cord twice about the left in the first turn, and then completing the knot as in the ordinary reef knot. It should not be used in tying bandages. The clove hitch is used when it is de- sired to get a firm hold of a limb in order to pull hard upon it, as in setting a dislo- cated joint. Its advantage over the ordinary loop is that it will not slip and bind the limb so as to stop the current of blood. Its con- struction can readily be understood from Fig. 64. The loops thus formed being slipped on to a limb, are drawn snugly but not so tightly as to constrict it, and then any amount of pulling on the two ends will not tighten it. Fig. 63. — The surgeon's knot. Fig. 64. —The clove hitch. The triangular bandage presently to be de- scribed is always fastened either by the reef knot or by pins ; and, in the latter case, the safety pin (Fig. 65), used by Esmarch him- self, is much the more suitable. Bandages are used to support various parts of the body when injured; to bind on and keep in place dressings for wounds and splints for broken bones ; to overcome excessive muscular action; to prevent disturbance of parts by the patient himself; as tempo- rary appliances to check Fig 65. — The safety pin. bleeding; and for the pro- tection of wounds from ex- posure to the elements, from insects, and from dirt. Unbleached muslin, of a moderately heavy quality, is the material usually employed for bandages, although the bleached variety, linen, cheese-cloth, cambric, and other similar fabrics may be used with full as much satisfaction. Flannel is often used where warmth with elasticity is desired. THE TRIANGULAR BANDAGE 93 While bandages should be fitted snugly, care should be taken not to draw them so tightly as to constrict the limb. A tightly drawn bandage may readily cut off the blood supply of the parts beyond it, and cause gangrene or death of the part. Bandages are chiefly of two shapes, the triangular and the ribbon-like, or roller bandage. The triangular bandage, recommended by Mayor of Lau- sanne early in the present century, was introduced to popular use by Surgeon-General Esmarch of the Prussian service, who, in 1869, caused them to be furnished to the army under his supervision, with pictures printed upon them (Fig. 66) showing the principal methods of application. END LOWER BORDER Fig. 66. — Esmarch's triangular bandage. Triangular bandages are made by dividing a piece of muslin a yard square into halves by a diagonal cut joining two opposite corners. This bandage is pre-eminently adapted for use on the battle-field and for any emergency. These bandages, as issued under the direction of Esmarch, are like that shown in the cut, which is a photographic 94 THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR reproduction of one issued by the medical department of the United States Army. 1 The St. John Ambulance Associations of England, and the St. Andrew's Ambulance Associations of Scotland, each issue a pictorial triangular bandage. The Scotch bandage is really a remarkable affair, with no less than fifty illustrations, covering almost the entire field of fiist aid to the injured in a most clear and minute manner, and accompanied by a little book of instructions on its use. In the illustration may be seen the creases made by folding the bandage. To fold it, the two ends are folded down to the point, and the square thus formed is folded in five. The shape and size of the triangular bandage may be. modified in various ways to adapt it to different purposes. If smaller triangles are desired, one, half the size of the large Fig. 67. — Diagram, showing the points at which the triangular bandage is folded for use. AB, CD. Folds for broad cravat. AB, ivx, yz. Folds for narrow cravat. one, can be formed by folding the two ends together, and two may be made by cutting it along the line of the fold. Or it may be made into a cravat of varying width by folding 1 Illustrated triangular bandages can be obtained in this country from any dealer in surgical instruments, either direct or through a druggist. 2 These bandages can be had post free for sixpence each on application to the Honorable Director of Stores, St. John's Gate, Clerkenwell, London, E.C., England. 3 The illustrated triangular bandage of the St. Andrew's Ambulance Associa- tion can be obtained post free for eight and one-half pence each, from the Secre< tary at the Head Office, 93 West Regent Street, Glasgow, Scotland. THE TRIANGULAR BANDAGE AS A SLING 95 it in lines parallel to the lower border. A broad cravat is made by folding the point down to the middle of the lower border, and then folding this again in the same way; the first fold would then be along the line AB (Fig. 67), and the second along the line CD. To form a narrow cravat, the first fold would be the same, AB, but there would be two secondary folds, wx and yz, instead of one. A twisted cord, formed by twisting the narrow cravat, may be used as an improvised tourniquet for checking bleeding. The triangular bandage is of especial value because of the facility with which its uses can be learned and the rapidity with which it can be applied, while at the same time it makes as good a temporary dressing as may be desired. For this reason its use is first to be learned, and unless a high degree of proficiency is desired, a familiarity with its applications is a sufficient knowledge of bandaging. The Triangular Bandage as a Sling. — There are three forms in which the triangular bandage may be utilized as a sling to support an injured arm. 1. The Narrow Arm Sling (Fig. 74) is made from either the broad or narrow cravat, as desired, and is applied by (1) placing one end over the shoulder of the injured side and (2) allowing the other end to hang down in front, while (3) the injured arm is bent up to the desired height in front of it ; (4) the end hanging down is then drawn up in front of the arm and over the shoulder of the uninjured side ; (5) the ends are drawn up over the shoulders so as to hold the arm in the most comfortable position and (6) tied with a reef knot behind the neck or over one shoulder. 2. The Broad Arm Sling is formed by folding the triangle but once — along the line AB (Fig. 67) — and applied in the same manner as the narrow arm sling. 3. The Large Arm Sling may be applied in three different ways, according to the extent and character of the injury. a. (1) Placing one end (Fig. 68) of an unfolded tri- angular bandage over the uninjured shoulder, (2) let it hang down in front of the body with the point toward the injured side ; (3) draw the point over well beyond the elbow of that 96 THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR side, (4) raise the forearm to the desired level, and (5) lift the loose end of the bandage so as to support the arm in that position, and (6) pass it over the shoulder of the injured side, where (7) it is tied behind the neck or over the shoulder with a reef knot ; (8) then the point is brought over in front and secured with a safety pin so as to form a rest for the elbow. b. A second form (Fig. 69) of the large sling is formed by passing the loose end of the triangular bandage around under the arm of the injured side to the back, and tying the two ends there, the sling thus passing over the sound shoul- der only. This variety is used where the shoulder of the injured side is so tender as not to be able to bear any weight. Fig. 68. — Large arm sling, where the shoulder of the injured side is unhurt. c. A third form (Fig. 70) of the Fig- 69 - — Large arm sling, 1 , „, ri • where the shoulder of large arm sung is x . . . . .. . . . a ° the injured side is hurt the same as the a iso. second form, except that the sling passes over the shoulder Fig. 70. — Large arm sling, of the injured side only, so that the where it is desired not to . r c place it over the shoul- sound arm can remain free for any pur- der of the sound side pose that may be required. The Triangular Bandage for Wounds. — The mode of application varies according to the location and character of the injury, and each variety will be considered individually. The Top of the Head. — If possible, the patient should be seated in a chair. Standing behind him, (1) fold the lower border of the bandage under, as if making a hem about two inches broad; (2) place the bandage (Fig. 71) with the THE TRIANGULAR BANDAGE FOR WOUNDS 97 middle of the hem just over the nose, and the point of the bandage hanging over the back of the head to the neck ; (3) bring the two ends back around the head above the ears ; (4) cross them ; (5) bring them around to the front again, and (6) tie them in a reef knot ; then (7) pull the point downward to make it fit closely over the head, and (8) turn it up on to the top of the head (Fig. J3) and pin it there. The Chin, Ears, or Side of the Face. — Using the narrow cravat, (1) place the middle under the chin, (2) draw the ends upward, and (3) tie them in a reef knot on top of the head. The Eyes, or Front of the Face. —*• The narrow cravat is folded about the head, with the middle at the middle line of the face, and the ends tied behind in a reef knot. The Neck. — The narrow or broad cravat may be used here, as circumstances may indicate, en- circling the neck, and having the ends tied on the side opposite to the injury. Fig. 71. — Triangular band- age applied to the head, from in front. Fig. 72. — Triangular bandage for the chest, front view. The Chest and Back. — (1) Apply the triangle (Figs. 72 and 72,) with its centre at the middle of the chest and the point ower the shoulder of the affected side ; (2) carry the two ends about the body, and (3) tie them in a reef knot r. 73. — Triangular bandage for chest, — back view, — shoulder, hand, and amputation-stump of arm. 9 8 THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR at the back, (4) leaving one end considerably 'longer than the other ; (5) then draw the point over the shoulder, and (6) tie it to the longer end left from the preceding knot. In case of injury to the back, reverse the procedure, The Ribs. — In case of injury to the ribs, use two broad cravats. (1) Place the middle of the upper one over the site of injury, if it affect the upper ribs, and well up under the armpits ; (2) pass it about the body, and (3) tie in a reef knot on the opposite side. (4) Place the other one similarly directly below the upper one, and apply it in the same manner. The Shoulder. — (1) Lay the triangle (Figs. 73 and 74) on the shoulder so that the lower border will come down to the middle of the upper arm and the point will extend well up on the neck ; (2) carry the two ends about the arm, (3) cross them on its inner face, and tie them in a reef knot on the outside ; (4) make a narrow or broad arm sling, and (5) draw the point under the sling where it passes over the affected shoulder. In case the shoulder is injured so as not to be able to sustain the sling, a small cravat bandage passed about the neck may be used in its place. The Upper Ar?n. — Using the broad cravat, (1) place the middle of the bandage in front of the limb ; (2) pass the ends about it, (3) cross- ing them behind, and (4) tie them in a reef knot in front (Fig. 74) . Support the arm in a sling. The Elbow. — Two plans may be adopted : a. (1) Place the middle of a narrow cravat on the back of the upper arm, near the elbow ; (2) draw the ends to the front ; (3) cross them ; (4) pass them back, crossing them at the tip 0/ the elbow ; (5) cross them in front of the upper portion of the forearm, and (6) pass them around it, (7) tying the ends in a reef knot at the back. Fig. 74. — Triangular bandage for shoulder, hand, and fore- arm, and as a narrow arm sling. THE TRIANGULAR BANDAGE FOR WOUNDS 99 Fig. 75. — Triangular bandage, as a figure of eight, for the hand. b. Or pass a broad cravat about the elbow in the same manner as in the upper arm (Fig. 74) . The Forearm and Wrist. — Apply a broad cravat as in the upper arm (Fig. 74), and use a large arm sling. The Hand. — There are two ways : a. Where it is desired to cover the whole hand (Fig. 74), (1) spread a triangle out, (2) lay the hand upon it with the wrist on the lower border and the fingers toward the point ; (3) fold the point back over the fingers, carrying it above the wrist ; (4) pass the ends about the wrist, binding down the point ; (5) cross them ; (6) bring them back, and (7) tie them in a reef knot over the point. This method may be used with advantage in dressing stumps after amputation, as has been done on the right arm of Fig- 73- b. In case of an injury (Fig. 75) to the back of the hand, (1) place the middle of a narrow cravat across the back of the hand, just below the thumb ; (2) bring the ends around the hand, crossing them on the palm ; (3) bring the ends over the back, (4) crossing them over the back; (5) pass them back about the wrist, (6) cross them and (7) bring them back, (8) tying them in a reef knot on the back of the wrist. If the palm is wounded, the pro- cedure is simply reversed. This is called a figure of eight handker- chief bandage for the hand, and the part should be supported in the large arm sling. The Hip. — (1) Pass a narrow cravat about the body like a belt, (2) tying it in a reef knot on the side opposite to the injury. (3) Lay a triangle upon the hip with its lower border well down on Fig. 76. — Triangular bandage for the hip. IOO THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR Fig. 77. — Triangular bandage for the knee. the thigh, and the point upward. (4) Pass the ends about the thigh, (5) crossing them and (6) tying them in a reef knot, or pinning them on the outside ; (7) slip the point under the belt, bring it over, and secure it with a pin (Fig. 76). The Thigh, Knee, and Leg. — The cravat is used (Fig. 7y) in the same manner as in the upper arm. The Foot. — (1) Spread a triangle out, and (2) place the foot in its centre, with the toes directed toward the point ; (3) draw the point back over the toes and instep ; (4) take the ends and pass them about the ankle over the tip, (5) crossing them on the instep ; (6) again in the sole of the foot, and (7) bringing them back, (8) tie them in a reef knot over the instep (Fig. 78) . The Square Bandage. — A handkerchief a yard square makes a covering for the entire head and neck, excepting the face, and makes a very efficient protection. The handkerchief is so folded that the under layer projects about four inches beyond the upper. The long rectangle thus produced is laid upon the head so that its middle rests upon the middle line of the cranium, while the margin of the longer flap falls down to the tip of the nose, and that of the upper to the eyebrows, the short borders hanging upon the shoulders. Of the four corners hang- ing down upon the chest in front, the two outer ones are first tied firmly tinder the chin. The border Fig. 80. — Large square of the under fold is then turned upward against handkerchief applied. Fig. 78. — Triangulai bandage for the foot. Fig. 79. — Large square hand- kerchief for the head. Pre- liminary stage. THE ROLLER BANDAGE IOI the forehead, and the two inner corners belonging to it are pulled for- ward from under the upper borders and carried to the back of the head, where they are tied in a reef knot. The Four^tailed Cap. — A handkerchief three-quarters of a yard long and a quarter of a yard wide, and slit up for a considerable distance at the narrow ends, forms a most excellent cover- ing for the head, and support for surgical dressings there. If it is desired to apply it to the top of the head, it is placed thereon, and : the two front tails tied ... _. T , , . ., . c . Qn _, , .... Fig. 81. — The four- tailed Fig. 82. — The four- tailed at the back of the head, cap for the top of the cap for the back of the and the back tails un- head. head. der the chin. If the back of the head is to be covered, the front corners are tied under the chin, and the two back ones over the forehead. The Four-tailed Bandage. — A bandage three inches wide and thirty to seventy inches long, is slit from both its ends, leaving a space three inches long in the centre, producing four tails of equal length. A little slit is also made in the middle of the centre piece. If the bandage is short, the centre piece is applied to the chin, and the upper tails are carried behind the neck and tied in a reef knot, while the lower tails are similarly carried up and tied on the top of the head. The Roller Bandage. — The roller bandage is a ribbon-like strip of varying material, prepared for binding about disabled parts of the body, and when not in use is rolled up into a cylinder. The proper application of the roller bandage requires con- siderable practice and experience in order not only to apply it so as to appear smooth and even, but also to avoid unequal pressure, by some folds being drawn tighter than others, the entire bandage being drawn tight enough to prevent slipping, and loose enough not to strangle the part, from which great harm — extending even to the death and decay of the limb — may result. For this reason these bandages are better adapted to the trained hand of the physician and nurse. The triangu- lar bandage is better adapted to the non-professional hand, and for that reason greater prominence has been given it in this work. 102 THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR Roller bandages may be elastic, semi-elastic, or inelastic, according to the material composing them. India rubber is the chief constituent of the elastic bandages, which are used to check the flow of blood — when drawn tightly enough to cut off the circulation in a part, and, when so applied as to exert gentle pressure, are of value in the treatment of en'.arged veins and the ulcers resulting from them. Semi-elastic band- ages are made of flannel, silk net, or other materials possessing a certain amount of elasticity. They are easier to apply than the inelastic, for they can be simply rolled on without reversing. Inelastic roller bandages, like triangular bandages, are usually made from a medium-weight unbleached muslin, although cheese cloth, bleached muslin, linen, cambric, and other similar fabrics may be used when necessary. Tarlatan and mosquito netting are used where the bandage is to be impregnated with a stiffening material. The inelastic bandage is the most generally useful, and is far less expensive than the other varieties. Bandages should not be cut, but torn, where the texture is of sufficient firmness to permit. And in any case the selvage should be torn from the edge, since it renders the margin less yielding than the remainder of the bandage, and is liable to produce unequal pressure. The sizes most convenient for use vary both in width and length, according to the locality in which they are to be employed. The follow- ing table will indicate that of the more commonly used : — Bandage for the Head, 2 to 25 inches wide and 5 to 7 yards long. " Finger, \ " " " 1 to 2 " " " Hand, 1 inch " " 4 to 5 " '.' " Arm, i\ to 2\ " " " 8 to 12 " " " Shoulder, 2 | " " " 8 to 12 « " " Chest, 3 to 4 " " " 6 to 8 " " " Leg, 2k " " " 10 to 12 " «* " Foot, *\ " " « 4 " " The roller bandage can only be conveniently applied after the strip has been rolled into a close, compact cylinder. The simplest and quickest way to form a strip into the cylinder is (1) to turn in one end of the bandage sufficiently to start a roll ; (2) to place the bandage upon the thigh, with the partial roll near the groin, and the strip extending down on the thigh to the knee; (3) beginning with the tips of the fingers, roll the cylinder, already begun, between the hand and the thigh until the roll reaches the wrist; (4) draw the bandage up the thigh with the partly completed roll just below the groin, and repeat the manoeuvre until the entire bandage is rolled. A bandage may be rolled by turning the roll between the thumb at one end and the fingers at the other end, but the method is so slow as to be much less desirable than that given above. THE ROLLER BANDAGE I03 Points to be observed in applying Roller Bandages in general: — 1. Begin at the lower end of a limb. 2. Avoid binding the limb too tightly or leaving the bandage too loose. 3. Leave the tips of the fingers or toes uncovered, so that they can be easily examined to see whether the bandage is too tight or not. If they are cold and blue, it should be loos- ened at once. 4. Apply the bandage smoothly, leaving no wrinkles. 5. Avoid unequal pressure, taking care that the turns of the bandage are applied with equal force, and that one edge is not tighter than the other. 6. Avoid reversing a bandage over a sharp bone ; make reverses on the fleshy side of a limb. 7. Bandage a limb in the position in which it is to be retained ; bandag- ing a limb straight, and then bending JS it, will bind it too tightly; and if a lBE9 limb be bandaged, bent, and then Fig. 83. — Rolling a roller bandage. straightened, the bandage will be too loose. 8. A bandage should not be applied wet, for it will shrink upon drying, and bind the limb too tightly. The Roller Bandage Arm Sling.— (1) Raise the forearm to the height desired; (2) pass a three or four inch bandage about the forearm, just below the elbow; (3) then pass both ends around the neck ; (4) bring the long end down under the wrist or hand, and (5) pass it up to the neck and tie it to the Fig. 84. — Roller bandage arm sling. 104 THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR Fig. 85. — The circular and rapid spiral turns. short end. The arm is now swung in a double sling, being supported at the forearm and at the hand or wrist. The Circular Turn. — In this turn the bandage passes directly about a limb, all the turns being upon the same level. A soldier's belt is a circular bandage of the abdomen. The Spiral Turn. — In these turns the bandage is placed at an angle so that they encircle a limb in a spiral direction. There are two varieties of the spiral turn. (a) The rapidly ascending spiral (Fig. 85) passes up the limb without its edges overlapping, and is used for holding dressings in place. {b) The slowly ascending spiral (Fig. 86) passes up a limb, with the lower edge of each turn overlapping the upper edge of the preced- ing. This turn is applicable only where a limb is of uniform thickness, as often occurs in the upper arm. The Reversing Spiral Turn. — This is a modi- fication adapted to limbs which increase or di- minish in size, and is designed to avoid the gaping of the turns which would occur with a simple spiral. Its application, clearly shown in Fig. 87, consists in simply turning the bandage over forward so that its upper margin will be below when the point of separation of two turns is reached, — repeating the manoeuvre whenever necessary to prevent gaping. The Figure of Eight Turn (Figs. 75 and 88). — This turn owes its name to the fact that it brings the bandage into the form of the numeral 8. In the hand it is formed (1) by placing Fig. 86. — The slow spiral turn. Fig. 87. — The three steps taken in applying the reversing spiral turn THE ROLLER BANDAGE I05 — Figure-of-eight turn applied to the hand. the end of the bandage at the palmar face of the wrist ; (2) bringing it across the back of the hand and below the thumb, and (3) across the palm at the root of the fingers ; then (4) up and across the back to the wrist ; (5) across the pal- mar face of the wrist; then (6) up and across the back, over the first turn ; (7) repeating these manoeuvres as many times as it may be de- sired to fold the band- age about the hand, and (8) finally securing it with a circular turn about the wrist. The figure-of-eight turn is employed especially where the bandage needs to pass over a joint. The Spica Turn (Fig. 89) . — This is a figure of eight with one loop very much larger than the other, and is employed at the junction of a limb with the body, as at the shoulder and the hip. Its mode of applica- tion is exactly similar to the figure of eight. To bandage the Whole Upper Ex- tremity (Fig. 89). — To secure technical correctness, every digit and the entire hand should be bandaged with a narrow roller, as shown in Fig. 89. As a matter of fact this is rarely done, on account of the length of time required for it. The more common method is, (1) placing layers of cotton between the fingers and a larger mass Rg 90 __ Ro |, er bandage in the palm ; (2) to begin with the arm bandage of the wn ^ 3 jower ex _ at the tips of the fingers, and carry it up to the tremity. wrist by figure-of-eight turns, leaving the thumb out; (3) the forearm is then bandaged by a reversing spiral, (4) the elbow by a figure of eight, (5) the arm by an ascending spiral, and (6} the shoulder by a spica. Fig. 89. — Roller bandage of the whole upper extremity. io6 THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR Fig. 91.— The knotted turn. To bandage the Whole Lower Extremity (Fig. 90). — (1) Catch the bandage by a turn or two about the toes, then (2) cover the foot by a narrow figure-of-eight turn ; (3) bandage the leg with a reversing spiral, (4) the knee by a figure of eight, (5) the hip by a spica, (6) which is completed by a few circular turns about the belly. The Double-headed Roller. — This is the roller bandage rolled from both ends to the middle. It is used for amputation stumps, and for drawing together the edges of wounds, but is especially employed for the head. The Knotted Turn (Fig. 91), used especially to control bleeding from the temples, is formed by a double head, where turns — one perpendicular under the chin, and the other horizontal about the brow — are crossed at right angles upon the wound, and tightly drawn, as in tying up a parcel. A compress is thus held upon the wound under the knot. The Capelline Turn (Fig. 92) is formed by a double-headed roller, one end of which passes around the head horizontally just above the ears, and fixes the turns of the other, which is carried alternately over the right and left side of the scalp, each turn overlapping the preceding one, so as to form a skull cap when complete. There are a number of other special turns of the roller bandage used to protect and support various parts of the body, and of the head in particular, but it is believed that those enumerated here will suffice to meet any emergency. To secure the Ends of Bandages. — Roller bandages are best secured with needle and thread : in default of that, with a safety pin ; and in the absence of both, with an ordinary pin. Where neither pins nor needles are avail- able, the end of the bandage should be split by a tear long enough to encircle the limb ; tie the two ends at the end of the slit with the first motion of a knot, then pass them about the limb in opposite directions, drawing the bandage firmly, and tie them in a reef knot. Bandages filled with Hardening Material are often applied where it is desired to render a limb immovable. These bandages are made of light, open-meshed material, such as gauze, tarlatan, crinoline, and mosquito netting. Plaster of Paris is the most common material used for filling these bandages ; but starch and water-glass are also used for the purpose. Fig. 92. — The capelline turn. DRESSINGS AND APPLICATIONS IO7 CHAPTER XIV DRESSINGS AND APPLICATIONS A dressing is a material applied to a wound both to pro- tect it and to assist the healing process. It absorbs dis- charges and stands guard against dirt and micro-organisms seeking admission. There are certain features of the dressings of wounds which are common to all varieties and which should consequently be considered before entering upon the discussion of indi- vidual injuries. Special dressings suited for particular injuries will be considered in connection with wounds, bleeding, and broken bones. A wound having been prepared for dressing, it is customary to place upon it a mass of soft substance called a compress. Compresses may be' made of various substances, the condi- tions demanded being that they are soft and unirritating, and are both generally and surgically clean — free from both dirt and germs. The materials most commonly used for this purpose by surgeons are cheese-cloth and tarlatan, and from these is prepared the modern surgical dressing, antiseptic gauze, made by impregnating these materials with a germi- cide. In this case, the fabric is folded into many layers, so that a sheet of the gauze has considerable thickness. Rolls of antiseptic gauze already prepared and put up in tin boxes, so as to avoid contact with the deteriorating action of the atmosphere, may be purchased in the apothecary shops, and should be present in every first-aid dressing-case. In using this material, the compress should be cut from the sheet, using the entire thickness. Other materials useful for compresses are absorbent cotton, prepared from ordinary cotton by removing its oily constitu- ents ; absorbent cotton may be made antiseptic like gauze, and is often thus used in antiseptic surgery. Lint, prepared by scraping clean old linen, and charpie, prepared by ravelling 108 THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR old linen and cutting up the resulting mass, have been very popular as wound dressings, although they are now practically disused. Oakum, formed by separating the strands of tarred rope, has been prominently in vogue, on account of the slight antiseptic quality imparted to it by the tar. It is rather harsh for a direct application to a wound, but the finer quality of oakum, called marine lint, is comparatively free from this objection. Linen worn soft and thin is an excellent wound dressing, provided that it is clean, both practically and sur- gically. Clean tissue paper makes an excellent application, and is often available in the form of toilet paper ; it is much preferable as a dressing to handkerchiefs that have been used, and to bits of clothing that have been worn, for it is likely to be entirely free from germs. Clean printed paper crumpled into a mass and softened by clean water is not at all objec- tionable, and is vastly superior to soiled clothing. The iron in the ink rather adds to than detracts from its usefulness. The shape and size of a compress varies according to the size, shape, and location of the wound it is to cover. It should never fail to be from a quarter of an inch to an inch in thickness — better too thick than too thin. It should overlap the wound in every direction by at least an inch, and, as before, it had better be too much than not enough. Sur- gical dressings are either wet or dry. Dry dressings are used where the direct application to the wound is a powder, but the wet dressings are much the more common and had better be used while awaiting a medical man. Where sugar, salt, vinegar, or, better, corrosive sublimate is present, anti- septic solutions, as described on page 90, can always be manu- factured for wetting dressings, and should always be used. In the rare cases where none of these can be obtained, or where antiseptic gauze is available, clean water may be used. Protective applications are used to cover and protect injured parts on one hand, and to protect the clothing from being soiled on the other. Sir Joseph Lister, the father of anti- septic surgery, was accustomed to apply a bit of gutta-percha tissue directly over his wounds to protect them from the irritating effects of his dressings. Where wet dressings are DRESSING FOR WOUNDS IO9 used, it is well to cover them with oiled silk or oiled muslin, which not only avoids soiling the clothing, but also prevents the evaporation of moisture. The First-Dressing Packet. — There are many occupa- tions in which men are daily exposed to injuries. In times of peace, accidents are of frequent occurrence in large manu- factories, sailors of the navy and more particularly in the merchant marine, workers in mines, railroad operatives, and many others are continually incurring considerable risk of injuries ; in war times, perhaps, soldiers are in even greater danger ; and, such is the perversity of inanimate things, accidents are most likely to occur when it is particu- larly difficult to obtain suitable dressing materials. This is Fig. 93.— First-Dressing "Packets used in Great Britain, Spain, and the United f States. V especially true in the military service, where, if an engage- ment be not fought in an inaccessible locality, the number of injuries is so great as to make it exceedingly difficult to provide proper dressings for all. For this reason, an attempt has been made by the military authorities to guard against such emergencies by having IIO THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR every soldier carrying with him the dressing materials for his own possible injury. This is the first dressing packet, several forms of which are used in the United States Army. Two of these are shown in Fig. 93, together with those issued by the British Army and Spanish Navy. The American packets are flat, flexible packages 1 by 2\ by 3I or 4I inches, containing the necessary materials for an emergency dressing, encased in an impermeable covering of composition or metal. Upon the cover is printed a list of the contents and some brief directions for its use, viz. : First Help for Wounds CONTENTS OF PACKAGE 2 Antiseptic compresses of sublimated gauze in oiled paper 1 Antiseptic bandage of sublimated gauze, with safety pin 1 Triangular bandage, sublimated, with safety pin ; mode of application illustrated on same. DIRECTIONS Place one of the compresses on the wound, removing the oiled paper. In cases of large wounds open the compress and cover the whole wound. Apply the Antiseptic bandage over the compress. Then use the triangular bandage as shown by illustrations on the same. J. ELLWOOD LEE CO., Conshohockeo, Pa. Contract. Feb., 1905 The antiseptic compresses are cheese-cloth roller bandages, a yard long and three and a half inches wide, folded to two inches wide and three and a half long ; the antiseptic band- age is a roller two yards long and four inches wide, and both are impregnated with corrosive sublimate, the most efficient germicide known to science. The oiled papers in which the compresses are wrapped serve to protect them from any external influences which may penetrate through the outer covering, and keep them from all possible contamination, and as well as the gutta-percha cloth cover itself can be used as a protective. In case of a wound by a rifle ball passing through any part of the body, the two compresses should be applied, one at the entrance and one at the exit of the ball. In case of a THE FIRST-DRESSING PACKET III single large wound, the two may be combined, and by unfold- ing and refolding into another form they may be made to cover a wound ten or twelve inches long and three inches wide, or eight inches long and six inches wide. This would protect a shell wound of considerable size, while almost any sword cut that might be received could be dressed by it. The oiled papers should be bound over the compresses with the antiseptic bandage and secured with the safety pin. The whole wounded part may then be covered with the triangular bandage after the manner described in the chapter on ki\ots and bandages, or that portion of the dressing may be used as a bandage to bind on a splint in case a bone has been injured, as a tourniquet to check bleeding in case of a wounded artery, or as a sling in case of an injury of an arm. The first dressing packet of the British army consists of two com- presses of tow impregnated with carbolized wood tar, a carbolized gauze roller bandage with a safety pin, and a triangular bandage, without illus- trations, folded and fastened together with four common pins, all wrapped in tin foil with a cover of parchment paper, upon which are printed directions for use. In the German and British armies, every soldier carries one of these packets in some specified portion of his clothing. The German carries it stitched, in some branches of the service, in his trousers, and in others, in his coat skirts ; in the Soudan expedition the British carried them in their breast pockets. The place where the packet is carried is not of so much consequence as that it should always be the same, so that when required for use it can be found at once. The German plan of stitching it into the clothing so that it cannot be removed is an excellent one and prevents its loss. The value of these packets has been conclusively demonstrated in actual warfare. At Tel-el-Kebir, after the Egyptians had been driven from their position, and the wounded of the British forces were still lying near their works, the dressings from the packets were applied in numerous instances with great benefit, either by the wounded men themselves, by their comrades, or by sanitary soldiers. During the oper- ations around Santiago, in 1898, the American troops found the packet, there used for the first time by the United States army, of incalculable value, and numerous wounded men owed their lives to the opportunity which it afforded for promptly treating their injuries. At Santiago, as at Tel-el-Kebir, the dressings were in many instances applied so satis- factorily by the soldiers themselves that the surgeons found no further dressing necessary until the men were removed to the hospital. 112 THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR The use of the packet as an immediate dressing insures for wounds a temporary treatment which will prevent the inroads of micro-organisms, and, as well, protect the parts from heat and cold, insects and dirt, until they can receive proper treatment. In this way are avoided erysipelas, gangrene, and other diseases resulting from neglect of the prompt treatment of wounds, while in many instances loss of limb, and even of life, is prevented. Fixative applications are used both to hold the lips of wounds together and to retain dressings in place. The suture of silk or catgut with which a surgeon stitches a wound together is a fixative, and so is the bandage with which the dressings are bound upon the wound. Adhesive plaster is used for the latter purpose, but on account of the difficulty of keeping clean wounds that have been treated with it, it should never be applied to fresh wounds. They should rather be dressed with a compress and so retained until a surgeon can close them with sutures. The use of adhesive plaster in connection with wounds, then, is mainly confined to fixing dressings in place. Court plaster may be used for closing slight cuts of the skin resulting from ordinary household accidents. It is best, however, not to dampen the court plaster with the tongue, but with a little pure water, because the saliva is filled with micro-organisms, some of which may produce serious trouble in the wound. Emollient applications are bland substances, either fatty or not, which, when applied to sore and inflamed surfaces, exert a soothing influence upon them. Such are the petro- leum oils sold under the name of vaseline, cosmoline, petro- latum, and the like. Sweet, unsalted lard and butter, and oils of various kinds, are included under this head. They are also of use as applications to the surfaces about wounds, to prevent the dressings sticking. These ointments are often impregnated with antiseptics, so that they make an antiseptic application in themselves and, when covered with a suitable compress, make a very useful dressing. Carbolic acid is the antiseptic substance most commonly used for this purpose, and carbolized vaseline, cosmoline, and the like can be bought in the shops. POULTICES 113 Poultices are emollients of sufficient importance to be considered by themselves. They are applied for the purpose of giving and maintaining in a part heat and moisture ; they are soothing and allay pain ; they assist the formation of matter in boils and abscesses ; they draw the blood to the surface, relieving congestion of deep parts, and they absorb foul secretions and loosen sloughing matter from septic wounds. They are easily infected with micro-organisms, and should on that account, when used in connection with open sores or old wounds, be made antiseptic by the addition of some suitable germicide. Corrosive sublimate is not admissi- ble here, but carbolic acid may be added in the proportion of a couple of teaspoonfuls to the pint of water, and powdered boracic acid and charcoal may be dusted over the face of the sore and over the surface of the poultice. Any material which satisfies the requisite of retaining warmth and moisture may be used for a poultice. A com- press of Iceland moss soaked for an instant in boiling water makes an excellent poultice. These compresses are sold in the shops as the "Poultice Instantaneous." Linseed meal is the material generally used by medical men, but other materials, such as bread crumbs, oatmeal, starch, corn meal, and bran may be used. In order to prevent the escape of heat and moisture, a poul- tice should be covered in with oiled silk or muslin, or a layer of cotton wadding. They are very apt to stick unpleasantly to the parts after being worn for some time, and this may be prevented by covering the under surface with some thin material such as mosquito netting, or by smearing the part with oil or vaseline before applying the poultice. A poultice should be as hot as can be borne by the patient, remember- ing that children's skin is more sensitive than adults', and some adults 1 more than others' ; testing it by laying it upon the back of the hand, or by holding it close to the cheek, is usually sufficient. Poultices cool after an hour or two and should be renewed at least as often as once in two hours to secure the best result. The poulticed part should never be left uncovered, but a new poultice should always be on hand to replace one when it is taken away. 114 THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR Linseed-meal Poultices require for their manufacture (i) a small dish, (2) heat sufficient to boil water, (3) a table-knife, (4) a piece of muslin or flannel two or three inches larger each way than the desired poultice, (5) a piece of oiled silk or muslin of the same size, (6) a piece of thin cheese-cloth, tarlatan, or, better than either, mosquito netting, (7) sufficient linseed meal, and (8) boiling water. The poultice is then made by first scalding out the dish, then pouring in the boil- ing water — which should be kept boiling — and adding lin- seed meal little by little, stirring the mixture all the time, until it has the consistence of a thick paste. When the ingredients are thoroughly mixed, take a table-knife, and, pre- viously dipping it into boiling water so that the poultice will not stick to it, spread the poultice about half an inch thick upon the muslin, which has been evenly laid upon the oiled silk ; then lay the thin fabric over its face and neatly turn in the margins of the muslin and oiled silk to prevent the poultice spreading, and — first testing it to make sure that while as hot as it can be borne, it is not hot enough to be painful — apply it as needed. Oatmeal and Corn-meal Poultices are made in the same manner as those of linseed meal. Bread Poultices are made by boiling down some stale bread with water for five minutes, then draining off the water and spreading the bread on the muslin ; then treating it the same as a linseed-meal poul- tice, except that its inner face should always be smeared with oil pr vaseline before applying it. An objection to a bread poultice is its liability to become sour. Starch Poultices are prepared by first making a stiff paste with cold water, then adding boiling water to give it the required degree of warmth. All the foregoing are spread and applied in the same manner as the linseed-meal poultice. Bran Poultices are prepared by first making a flannel bag of the desired size, and then, after scalding the bran in a basin, putting it into the bag, the open end of which should be quickly sewed or pinned together; the bag with its. contents should then be quickly wrung out in a towel and applied like a linseed-meal poultice. Hot Moist Fomentations form another means of applying warmth and moisture to painful parts ; they are more quickly HOT FOMENTATIONS 1 1 5 made than poultices and may be applied where quick action is desired. They form a useful application in sprains, and headache may often be relieved by laying them upon the brow, while the rapidity with which they may be made ready renders them peculiarly useful as an application to the belly in colic. The fomentations usually consist of flannel cloths wrung out in hot water. The best way to prepare them is to crumple the flannel into a wad and roll it up into the middle of a towel, then dip the middle of the towel with the flannel into hot water and wring it out well by twisting the ends of the towel in opposite directions, touching only the dry ends of the towel. The fomentation should be taken to the patient before it is removed from the towel, and, with pre- cautions not to have it too hot, duly applied, the loss of heat and moisture being prevented by a covering of oiled silk or cotton wadding. They should be renewed as often as cooling shows it to be necessary. The action of the fomentations is said to be assisted by the addition of two or three table- spoonfuls of turpentine to the water. Hot Dry Fomentations are applied whenever there is a lack of heat in the system, or in any part of it. The most common method of application is by means of hot-water bags of india rubber. However, in their absence, flannel bags filled with salt, bran, or sand, and thoroughly heated, may be used with great advantage. Where the heat is needed very quickly, ordinary bottles filled with hot water and tightly corked are an excellent substitute. Heated bricks, frag- ments of rock, flatirons, and many similar articles, when carefully wrapped in flannel or a bit of blanket, have been used for this purpose. The chill following great loss of blood, the coldness following an escape from drowning, the lack of warmth accompanying extreme prostration from many conditions, are all to be treated by dry fomentations. In these cases, the heated articles should be wrapped in cloths and laid in contact with the feet and along the side of the body, care being taken not to have them too hot, for in partially unconscious conditions the patient might be burned without having the power to. move away. Il6 THE IMPLEMENTS OF REPAIR Counter-irritants are commonly used as a relief to pain. They are useful in colic, muscular rheumatism, and other painful affections, and should be used as a rule under the direction of a physician. The Mustard Plaster is perhaps the most common form in which counter-irritation is applied. The dry mustard should be mitigated by mixing with an amount of flour varying according to the effect desired, and stirred up with water, or preferably the white of an egg. This mixture is then spread upon a bit of flannel or muslin and laid upon the skin ; if the skin be very sensitive, however, it may be desirable to lay a layer of some thin material over its face. The plaster should not be kept on too long, or it will form a blister instead of merely reddening the skin, as is desired. Fifteen minutes is usually long enough. The Spice Plaster forms an agreeable and gentle counter-irritant, and is made by using a mixture of ordinary cooking spices with the white of an egg, in the same manner as a mustard plaster. This is particularly useful in children and persons with a very delicate skin. The Mustard Poultice combines the good qualities of a poultice and a counter-irritant, and is a particularly excellent way to apply counter- irritation where deep-seated parts are to be affected. It is prepared by mixing mustard thoroughly with warm — not hot — water, making from a tablespoonful to half the bulk of the proposed poultice, according to the strength desired. Then, having made a linseed-meal poultice as already described, mix the mustard into it before spreading, and pro- ceed as in a simple poultice. Part III EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS CHAPTER XV HOW TO ACT AT FIRST In the presence of an accident or other emergency, the first requisite is presence of mind. The slang expression, keep cool, is the first precept to be impressed upon the mind. Nothing is more fraught with danger to a person suffering from the depressing shock of a severe accident than the noise and excitement of an officious bystander ; nothing, on the contrary, is more soothing and satisfying to such an one than a quiet, collected demeanor upon the part of those assisting him. A knowledge of the proper course to pursue in such cases will contribute largely toward investing one with the proper manner, but it is necessary, particularly for those ot a more or less excitable temperament, to practise curbing the nerves, and to restrain themselves by the knowl- edge that a hasty act may precipitate most unhappy results. But while excitement and haste are to be condemned, promptness coupled with quiet cannot be too earnestly sought. In many instances, the ready appreciation of the emergency, followed immediately by the application of the proper treat- ment, has been the means of saving a life to which a moment's delay would have been fatal. But rapidity must be distin- guished from haste, and quick movements from excitement. The patient should never be able to read the danger of his condition from the countenance of his helper. And while applying quietly and quickly whatever means of assistance he may be able to contribute, the helper must remember that his services are but temporary and only to tide over the time until educated assistance can be brought. Then, if it has not already been done, on coming into the presence or a medical or surgical emergency, send for a doctor immediately I The great danger of instruction in 119 120 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS methods of meeting emergencies is the tendency developed in some students to feel that they have mastered the healing art, and worse, to act in accordance with their feeling. The , work of the layman instructed in first aid should be restricted strictly to the interval between his arrival and that of a qualified medical man. A step beyond this is a piece of presumption that might readily result in permanent damage, if not a fatal result to the patient. The reason for the morbid curiosity which induces people to crowd about an injured person is difficult to discover. It may be a characteristic not eliminated in the evolution of man from the monkey. Even cattle and horses crowd about an injured one of their kind. It is not uncommon to see a person disabled on the street surrounded by a dense over- arching wall of humanity, cutting off his supply of fresh air and polluting with the breath the small amount that he can obtain. The impropriety of this is evident ; then always keep crowds back and give the patient an abundance of fresh air. On no account should a patient be annoyed by miscellaneous questioning, and certainly not by unnecessary handling or moving, which might, by reopening a wound or displacing a broken bone, cause serious injuries and even the death of the patient. In many cases the course of action to be pursued in an emergency will be suggested by circumstances, especially to one who has made a study of the subject. Where no imme- diate action seems to be necessary, the patient should be placed in as comfortable a position as possible until the med- ical attendant summoned can arrive. On finding a person who has been injured, particularly if he be unconscious, the individual himself and his surround- ings should be observed with great care, since the case may come into the courts, where such evidence has been of vital importance. The location of the person with regard to sur- rounding objects should be observed, his relation to neighbor- ing dwellings and the possibility of his having fallen from an elevated point, such as a window or roof. Any articles lying near by should be noted with a view to the possibility of their HOW TO ACT AT FIRST 121 having been used as missiles or weapons. A whiskey flask near by would suggest intoxication ; a bottle labelled lauda- num would create a suspicion of opium poisoning ; a recently discharged pistol would cause a shot wound to be suspected, and a bloody knife would be suggestive of stabbing ; while a riderless horse or a fallen ladder would make one think of injuries consecutive to a fall. The appearance of the ground surrounding should be examined to see whether it bears traces of having been trampled upon as in a scuffle or not. The patient himself should be observed with great care — even his attitude may tell an important story. His clothing, if torn or cut, or soiled with blood, may be a valuable link in future evidence ; and the location of his injuries, if there be any, should be noticed, as well as their relation to surround- ing objects. All this should be taken in by a rapid survey immediately upon arriving upon the scene, and should not interfere with rendering the victim immediate assistance. A sick or injured person should always be made to lie down on his back if the character of his injuries does not forbid, with his lower extremities extended and his arms by his side. If he seems faint, his head should be rather lower than his feet ; if faintness is not present, the head may be raised a little and turned rather to one side. Nausea and vomiting are very apt to accompany emergency attacks, and the probability of this occurring should always be considered. If the patient be insensible, he should be watched carefully, and in case of nausea, turned to one side, so that the vomited matter can be thrown out of his mouth ; if he is left upon his back, it will be likely to fall back into the windpipe and cause fatal choking. If he be conscious, he will the more easily be cared for. ■> All tight articles of clothing should be loosened to prevent interference with breathing or the circulation. Belts and collars in particular need attention. The popular idea of relief to the injured seems to begin with the administration of stimulants. This is an incorrect and dangerous notion ; for while there are but few cases in which stimulants are of benefit, there are many in which 122 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS they are injurious. Where there has been any bleeding, stimulants are liable to cause recurrence with all the dangers attendant upon it. In case of thirst, water is the best bever- age — cold in summer and warm in winter. Warm water being distasteful to most persons, it may be administered in the form of tea or coffee or broth — they are vastly superior to alcoholic drinks. While there are a few conditions in which brandy or whiskey or wine may be given with advan- tage, they are comparatively so few, and subject to so many modifications, that such beverages should never be admin- istered except under the direction of a physician. In case of a person who is unconscious, or so weak as not to be able to give an account of himself, after meeting such indications as are conspicuous, he should be systematically examined. Beginning with the head, the fingers should be passed gently over it in the search for wounds, depressions, or bruises. If the eyes are closed, the upper eyelid should be raised to permit of examination, and the open eye should be examined as to whether the pupils are dilated or con- tracted, of the same size or unequal, and whether the eyeball is sensitive to the touch. Passing down the neck in the same manner, the two sides of the body should be carefully compared and any variation noted ; the ribs and collar bones should be felt to see if they are sound. The breathing should be watched to see if it is easy or difficult, snoring or imper- ceptible, and the odor of the breath should be tested for indications of drugs or liquors taken. The arms and legs should then be looked over; the attitude, the increase or diminution of length of one as compared with the other, the possibility of bending at an abnormal point and crackling felt at the point, — all have their value and should be sought for. If a wound be discovered in some part covered by the clothing, it should be examined to see whether it needs treat- ment or not, and if dressings are demanded, the part should be uncovered to a sufficient extent to permit their ready appli- cation. The examination should be made with the greatest gentleness on account of the extreme sensitiveness of injured INDICATIONS OF DISEASES 1 23 parts ; and as little as possible of the person should be uncov- ered, for the natural tendency of an accident is to produce a greater or less amount of shock, which is manifested in a diminution of the heart's action with a cold feeling all over the body, often manifested by shaking chills and cold sweat. The chill, certainly, should not be increased by exposure of the body. The injured part should be exposed by ripping the nearest seam in the clothing and cutting the under- clothing under it, taking care to uncover no more of the part than is absolutely necessary for the dressings. When an injured person has been brought to his bed and has received proper attention, it will be desirable to remove his clothing. This should be done with the utmost gentle- ness, the sound side should be undressed first, and then the clothing removed from the injured side with as little disturb- ance as possible, assisting the process by ripping and cutting whenever the slightest difficulty appears. If it is necessary to replace the clothing upon an injured person, the injured side should be clothed first and then the sound side ; but ordinarily no attempt should be made to put clothing on again — it is sufficient to lay it loosely about a patient. Indications of Diseases. — Certain conditions or appear- ances point toward the existence of certain affections ; these are signs or symptoms. A flushed face is a symptom of fever, of apoplexy, of epilepsy, and of intoxication, while a pale face indicates poor circulation or faintness. The eyes afford important symptoms : if the pupils are enlarged and the patient unconscious, paralysis, apoplexy, or belladonna poisoning are indicated ; if they are very much contracted, on the contrary, opium poisoning and congestion, and inflam- mation of the brain are indicated ; while if they are unequal, there is probably some brain trouble affecting but one side. Inability to move a limb or to feel sensations in a part indi- cate paralysis there; the same affection is indicated by a drawing of the face to one side and a dragging gait. Bleeding from the mouth or nose occurs in a large number of disorders and cannot be said to be in itself a distinctive symptom ; but when frothy blood is coughed in considerable 124 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS quantity from the mouth, bleeding from the lungs is to be suspected, and when the bleeding comes from the ears, nose, and mouth after a fall upon the head, fracture of the floor of the cranium has probably occurred. Fits, spasms, or convulsions also occur in a. variety of affections and may be very violent in epilepsy, drunkenness, and in insanity, kidney troubles, and apoplexy ; comparatively slight causes, such as teething and even indigestion, will pro- duce them in children, and on the other hand they may indi- cate extensive brain disease. The drunken man staggers in his gait, but disease of the brain or spine may also cause irregularity in walking. A weak pulse is a sign of fainting, bleeding, shock, or collapse ; an irregular pulse indicates heart disease ; a slow pulse is a symptom of pressure on the brain and opium poisoning ; and a rapid pulse leads to a suspicion of fever, although it may be due to nervous excitement, or may be the normal condition of the patient. Difficult breathing may be due to a stoppage of the air passages, to broken ribs, to water in the chest, to disease of the heart or lungs, and to disease or injury of the breathing centre in the brain, or the nerves supplying the breathing apparatus. Snoring breathing, also called "stertorous," is a sign of pressure on the brain, as in apoplexy. Hiccup is a spasmodic breathing, and may be caused by indigestion, nervous trouble, and exhaustion. Coughing occurs in foreign body in the larynx, irritation in the windpipe or bronchial tubes, and in lung and heart disease. Dizziness may be due to digestive disorders, kidney troubles, and brain affections, while shivering chills, aside from cold- ness, may point to the beginning of fevers, or to weakness and danger in the course of an illness. It will be observed that it is rare that a single symptom points exclusively to a single disorder, and the physician relies upon a combination of signs for the identification. Typical cases of disease are rare, and two cases of the same affection may differ so greatly that the uneducated mind would never class them together. BRUISES 125 Cases of feigning accidents or disease in order to profit by the sympathies of bystanders are not unknown. Indeed, men have been known to make an excellent living by simulating epileptic fits ; in cases of fits, then, where the fall is very gentle and always at a point where a generous contribution is to be expected, and where the convulsions are never directed toward a body, contact with which might hurt the subject, such cases should be looked upon with suspicion. All the symptoms are probably assumed and the froth at the mouth produced by a bit of soap. Blindness and deafness are fre- quently feigned, and it has been a common practice among mendicants to irritate ulcers and other sores in order to obtain an excuse for soliciting charity. CHAPTER XVI BRUISES, BURNS, AND FREEZING Bruises. — Definition : Wounds under the skin. Causes: Blows, falls, squeezes, pinches. Symptoms : Pain, at first numb, later sharper. 3welling. Change of color : at first a purplish red, fading out to a greenish brown, and lastly to a dirty yellow. In severe cases the symptoms of shock are present. Treatment : If it be slight, cold applications, in the form of wet cloths and sponges ; if more severe, cloths wrung out in hot water, and bran poultices ; laudanum directly to the part relieves pain. Very severe and extensive bruises may involve deep tissues to a great extent, and treatment appropriate to each case must be administered by a physician. Shock, however, should be treated with hot, dry fomentations pending his arrival. Bruises are technically known as contusions, and vulgarly as " black- and-blue spots," " black eyes," and by other names, varying according to the location. 126 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS The discoloration is caused by blood issuing usually from capillary blood-vessels, broken under the skin by the violence which has torn the surrounding tissues to a greater or less extent. Where the tissues under the skin are loose and spongy, a considerable amount of dis- coloration may occur. This is seen in the " black eye," where the amount of blood issuing into the tissues may be quite considerable. The discoloration does not appear at once, since it takes some little time for the blood to spread into the tissues sufficiently to be seen under the skin, but it is usually apparent in from a few minutes to sev- eral hours. However, if the parts especially bruised lie very deep, as when a bone is broken, it may take several days for the color to reach the skin. The blood soon begins to decompose to a suitable condition for absorption, and as the color fades out it is carried off and discharged from the system. The time required for the return to the normal color occupies a period varying — according to the extent of the injury — from a few days to several weeks, and even longer, in very severe cases. While it would seem that without a break in the skin, an injury could not be very severe, as a matter of fact, the greatest amount of damage may be accomplished. The entire substance of a limb may be crushed to a pulp ; large veins and arteries may be torn ; the liver, kidneys, or spleen may be broken, and the stomach or bowels may be bursted, while the brain is peculiarly subject to such injuries, — without any ex- ternal wound. In these severe cases the symptoms are correspondingly accentuated. Where the chest or abdomen has been bruised, injury to their contents is shown by spitting or vomiting blood, or passing it from the bladder or bowels. This is usually accompanied by great pros- tration, with feeble pulse, cold, clammy skin, anxious expression, and bewildered mind. The most important point of treatment in this case is to counteract the tendency to weakness by the application of warmth, inside and out. Hot, dry fomentations, consisting of bottles of hot water, hot flatirons, hot stove-lids — in fact, anything hot that can be obtained quickly, taking care to cover it, so as not to burn the patient's skin — should be applied at once. Hot drinks should be given him, coffee preferably, but in default of that any similar material. On account of their effect upon bleeding, alcoholic drinks should not be given. And, above all, a surgeon should be instantly summoned! Where the accident affects larger vessels than the capillaries, the amount of blood lost into the tissues may be very large, and form a haematoma or " blood-tumor," and these require the care of a physician. If an artery is torn, the swelling forms very rapidly, and beats with the heart like the pulse of an artery. In large bruises the parts may be so injured as to make it necessary to remove the bruised limb; and even in comparatively slight bruises the blood may break down into an abscess which has to be opened to let the matter out. Paralysis of a limb, necrosis or death of a part, and long-continued tenderness may result from an extensive bruise. BURNS 127 The treatment looks toward three points: (1) to stop the issue 0$ blood ; (2) to hasten the removal of blood already in the tissues ; and (3) to diminish any resulting inflammation. The first indication is fulfilled by the application of cold water or chopped ice to the bruise. Both the first and second are fulfilled by stimulating washes; a mixture of three drachms of table salt and one drachm of muriate of ammonia in six ounces of baywater is perhaps the best of these; dilute alcohol and a mixture of dilute alcohol and water are also excellent applications for this purpose. The second indication is also well fulfilled by kneading or rubbing the bruise with oil or a simple liniment, and by pressing a compress firmly upon it. The application of a mass of raw lean beef, so popular in the treatment of " black eyes," also belongs to this class. The third indication is fulfilled by the cooling applications already mentioned. If an abscess should form, it should be treated by a surgeon. Pain may be treated, in addition to the applications detailed, by the administration of anodynes, locally and internally, and always under the direction of a medical man. Burns. — Definition : Injuries due to the action of too great heat on a part. Causes : Contact with fire, very hot bodies or chemicals. Varieties : Burns are divided into three classes, accord- ing to the degree of severity of the injury: (1) Mere painful redness. (2) The formation of blisters. (3) Charring. They are also classified, in accordance with the mate- rial inflicting the injury, into (a) burns, produced by contact with fire, hot solids, or chemicals, and (b) scalds, caused by hot liquids. Symptoms : Pain. Simple reddening of the skin in the first class, redness with the formation of blisters in the second class, and actual destruction of the skin and more or less of the underlying tissues in the third. In burns of the first two degrees, the skin only is involved, while in charring there is no limit. In severe burns there is apt to be a great amount of prostration with the symptoms which together form shock, de- scribed in the chapter on Fainting. 128 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Treatment: Remove the clothing by cutting it away with a knife or scissors ; if it sticks, do not pull it off, simply cut around it and flood it with oil. Let the water out of blisters by pricking them with a new and absolutely clean needle or pin, and gently pressing them, taking great care not to break them and expose the tender surface underneath. Promptly exclude the air by : — a. In case of a slight burn of the first degree, and in particular of a scald, applying a compress wet with water in which is dissolved as much baking-soda as the water will take up. b. In any case, applying any clean oil such as salad oil, olive oil, sweet oil, fresh lard, unsalted butter, vaseline, cosmoline, petrolatum. The white of an egg is even better than these, and all of them are improved by being carbolized by the addition of fifteen grains of carbolic acid to the ounce. c. Better, however, by applying " carron oil," a mix- ture of equal parts of linseed oil and lime water. d. In the absence of oils, by dusting flour or whiting over the burn. If nothing else can be gotten, moist earth, preferably clay, makes a useful application. Cover the part with cotton or the nearest available substitute for it. Burns caused by acids, such as oil of vitriol or sul- phuric acid, carbolic acid, and the like, should first be thoroughly drenched with water and then washed with a solution of washing or baking soda and water ; then treated like an ordinary burn. Burns caused by alkalies, such as caustic potash, caustic soda, strong ammonia, and the like, should first be thoroughly drenched with water and then washed with vinegar or some other dilute acid ; then treated like an ordinary burn. Treat shock by hot, dry fomentations and warm drinks as prescribed in the chapter on Fainting. In severe cases send for a physician. BURNS 129 Burns are by surgeons divided into six classes instead of three, as follows: (1) Simple redness of the skin. (2) Redness, with slight blistering, which leaves no mark after recovery except, perhaps, a slight stain. In these two classes the burn does not go below the epidermis or scarf skin. (3) Partial destruction of the true skin also, which leaves a scar, but no deformity. (4) Entire destruction of both scarf skin and true skin, which invariably leaves a scar, and always produces deformity, sometimes frightful in extent. (5) Destruction of muscles and other soft parts, followed by great deformity and possible loss of limb, if recovery takes place. (6) Charring of the entire thickness of a limb, which always imposes loss of the limb if the patient survives. Burns are more frequently the result of carelessness than not. But they cannot always be avoided, as in accidents of various kinds, such as explosions of gas and gunpowder, explosions of lamps, falls upon stoves or into fireplaces, burning clothes, and the like. Scalds are caused by contact with steam, hot water, and other fluids. The pain attending a burn is very intense, and the removal of cloth- ing by cutting, instead of pulling it off in the usual way, is designed to avoid increasing it as well as to avoid tearing of the blistered skin and exposing the exquisitely tender surface below. The chief indication in severe burns is to cover them as quickly as possible with something that will exclude the air. The application should be ready to apply the moment the clothing is removed. A very brief delay is likely to be fatal to the patient, from exposure of the burned surface to the air, especially in case of the chest and abdomen. For this reason it is well, where a burn is extensive, to expose and dress but a small portion of the burn at a time. Baking-soda water — the bicarbonate, not washing soda or baking powder — and the oils are best applied by dipping into them, and the ointments like vaseline, by spreading them thickly upon, cloths, which are then immediately laid upon the burned or scalded surface. Both baking soda and carbolic acid have a soothing effect upon the pain. It is well to complete the dressing of a burn by covering the cloths with layers of cotton batting, cotton wadding, flannel, oakum, and other simi- lar materials which should be bound lightly upon the part. The inside of the mouth and throat may be scalded by drinking hot fluids or swallowing chemicals. In addition to the dangers attendant upon burns in other parts of the body, choking and smothering from swelling in the throat is to be feared in this case. Cloths cannot be applied here, and the oil or the white of an egg must be applied by drinking them. If the injury is due to chemicals, the mouth and throat should be rinsed by the proper antidote — vinegar or exceedingly dilute acid in case of caustic soda, potash, ammonia, or lye, and a solution of baking soda or washing soda in case of an acid. It does no good to hold a burn to the heat, and the exposure may I3O EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS often cause great injury to the system. Warm moist cloths are, how- ever, very grateful in slight burns. Where charring has occurred, more or less of the tissues have been. killed, and the dead or " necrosed " portions will be cast off with the formation of matter. In these cases, the physician will take great care to use antiseptics to prevent infection of the wounds by micro-organisms. The process of casting off the dead matter may be hastened by the use of poultices, which must be antiseptic. Where the entire skin has been involved in a burn, the healing will form a trouble- some scar which will ultimately contract and produce a deformity varying in degree Fig. 94. — Deformity of the according to the extent of the burn. The hand, due to a contract- accompanying illustration shows a deformity ing scar after a burn. of the hand due to a contracting scar after a burn. It is one of the milder cases; the deformities are often frightful in the extreme. To avoid this as much as possible, the parts should be placed in a natural position while heal- ing and kept so. Sunburn is caused by exposure to the rays of the sun, and is a burn of the first degree — simple redness of the skin; mustard causes a simi- lar condition. The application of baking-soda water and of oils, un- salted lard and butter, white of egg and vaseline — plain, but preferably carbolized — is indicated here as in other burns of the same class. Sunstroke and heatstroke, although they are accidents due to the action of heat, are considered to be best treated in the chapter on Fainting. Burning Clothing, particularly that of females, has been the unnecessary cause of many horrible deaths, either from ignorance of the proper means of extinguishing the flames, or from lack of presence of mind to apply them. A person whose clothing is blazing should (1) immediately be made to lie down — be thrown down, if necessary. The tendency of flames is upward, and when the patient is lying down, they not only have less to feed upon, but the danger of their reaching the face, with the possibility of choking and of ulti- mate deformity, is greatly diminished. (2) The person should then quickly be wrapped up in a coat, shawl, rug, blanket or any similar article, preferably woollen, and never cotton, and the fire completely smothered by pressing and patting upon the burning points from the outside of the envelope. FREEZING 131 The flames having been controlled in this way, when the wrap is removed, great care should be taken to have the slightest sign of a blaze immediately and completely stifled. This is best done by pinching it, but water may be used. Any burns and any prostration or shock should be treated in the manner prescribed for them. It is always dangerous for a woman to attempt to smother the burn, ing clothing of another, on account of the danger to her own clothing. If she attempts it, she should always carefully hold between them the rug in which she is about to wrap the sufferer. Freezing. — Definition : An injury due to the action of too great cold on a part. Causes : Exposure to excessive cold. Varieties : (1) The frost bite, where portions only of the system have been affected. (2) General freezing, where the entire system is affected. Symptoms: (1) Of the frost bite: Affecting projecting points on the person, such as the ears, nose, fingers, and feet, the affected part first tingles with pain and is red, and then blue or purple in color ; as the freezing goes on, the part becomes white and free from pain. (2) Of general freezing : The entire person, under exposure to severe cold, becomes chilled, stiffened, and pale ; the mind becomes sluggish and drowsy ; the extremities are benumbed and shrunken ; unconscious- ness supervenes, and unless proper restorative means are applied, death ensues without awakening. Treatment : (1) Of frost bite: Too rapid warming is apt to cause mortification, hence the frozen part should be restored by rubbing with snow or with cold water until the white color is replaced by the natural hue and an aching pain is felt in the part — then treat like a burn. (2) Of general freezing : In a dry, cool room which can be gradually heated, but not near a fire, the clothing should be removed and the body rubbed briskly and carefully, at first with snow or cold cloths, and then 132 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS with dry flannel ; as soon as the ability to swallow is restored, stimulants and hot drinks should be given ; upon restoration the patient should be snugly wrapped in warm clothing and put to bed ; individual frost bites being treated as above. Under ordinary circumstances, an hour's exposure to intense cold may determine a fatal result. This outcome, however, may be modified by circumstances : a covering of snow retains the heat of the body to such an extent as to considerably delay death ; well authenticated cases are on record in which persons, buried even for days in the snow, have nevertheless survived and ultimately recovered with little permanent damage. In a still day a very low temperature can be endured with compara- tive comfort, while a wind will make a much warmer day productive of great suffering. The rapid movement of the surrounding air carries away from the surface of the body the warmth which remains undis- turbed on a quiet day. When a part is frozen, it becomes bloodless, as is shown by the white color, and the object of treatment is to bring the blood back into the emptied tissues. There is danger, however, if the return of the circula- tion be produced too rapidly, that the resulting excess of blood in the part will produce mortification and decay, — gangrene and sloughing, — and for this reason, cold applications are combined with the rubbing, by which the circulation is restored. The effect of cold is very similar to that of heat, and frost bites are much like burns, so much, indead, that the after-treatment is the same. Like heat, cold produces blisters, which are treated by careful pricking with a new and absolutely clean needle or pin, pressing the fluid out, and dressing the frozen surface with oils or ointments. Like charred burns, the dead matter resulting from the mortification of a frozen part should be treated antiseptically, and the process of throwing it off hastened by an antiseptic poultice. Chilblains are the result of too rapid warming of cold feet. The blood having been to a considerable extent crowded out of the feet by the cold, when they are rapidly warmed, it finds its way back in so large a quantity that it cannot all be disposed of, and the excess can be seen collected in small patches, scattered over the sole of the foot — the chil- blains. This form of congestion sometimes becomes chronic in persons of poor circulation. An individual subject to chilblains should never come in out of the cold and toast his feet at a warm fire. He should warm them by stamping or briskly rubbing them, and by warming other parts of the body. Astringent applications to his feet, such as alcohol or alum water, will usually control them when they have been developed. WOUNDS 133 CHAPTER XVII WOUNDS Wounds. — Definition: Injuries, in. which an opening is made through the skin and more or less of the parts underneath. Varieties : (1) Cut or incised wounds ; (2) Torn or lac- erated wounds ; (3) Bruised or contused wounds ; (4) Pierced or punctured wounds, including gunshot wounds ; (5) Poisoned wounds. Causes : ( 1 ) Of cut wounds, blows with sharp-edged in- struments, such as knives, razors, and swords ; (2) Of torn wounds, blows with blunt instruments, such as clubs or stones ; irregular bodies, like fragments of shell and forcible tearing of a part from the body ; (3) Of bruised wounds, blows with blunt instruments — torn wounds are usually bruised also ; (4) Of pierced wounds, thrusts with narrow, sharp-pointed instru- ments, such as bayonets, arrows, and daggers — a gun or pistol shot also produces a punctured wound ; (5) Of poisoned wounds, usually bites of venomous reptiles or insects. Symptoms: Pain at the point of injury. An opening through the skin. Bleeding, varying in amount ac- cording to the injury. Where bones are broken, the signs of that injury. Treatment : 1 . If the wound be a large or disabling one, lay the patient in as comfortable a position as possible. 2. Stop the bleeding as far as practicable by the employment of the means described in the chapter on Bleeding, taking care not to destroy the clot, if one has formed. 3. Cleanse the wound from bits of glass, stone, splinters of wood, dirt, or any other matters of the kind, by washing with absolutely clean water, rendered 134 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS antiseptic if possible by a tablespoonful of common salt to the pint, or vinegar in the proportion of one fourth ; or, better, carbolic acid or corrosive sublimate solutions, prepared as directed in the chapter on Germs. If clean water cannot be obtained, do not wash the wound ; simply pick out the larger particles. 4. Place the edges of the wound as nearly as possi- ble in their natural position. 5. Set any broken bones by the methods related in the chapter on Broken Bones. 6. Use a first-dressing packet in accordance with directions, if available ; if not, apply compresses, pre- pared according to the methods detailed in the chapter on dressings, wetting them with the same antiseptic solution used for cleansing. Bandage this dressing neatly in place. 7. Apply splints, if necessary, not binding them di- rectly upon the wound. 8. Apply a triangular bandage over the wound now dressed, and if it affect an upper extremity, support it in a suitable sling, as detailed in the chapter on Band- aging, and keep it quiet. 9. Treat shock by hot drinks, and hot, dry fomen- tations, as directed in the chapter on Fainting. Through the appreciation of the germ theory, both the treatment of wounds and its results have, within a few years, undergone striking changes. The recognition of the fact that bad results and slow healing of wounds are due to the presence of poisons, developed by noxious germs, which have found their way into wounded tissues, has led to the observance, by surgeons, of the strictest precautions to prevent the entrance of germs, and to destroy or paralyze them if they should gain access to them. And by doing this, the surgeon of the present day is able to perform operations that would in former times have been con- sidered as actual murder. With improved means of proceeding, hardly any part of the body is sacred from the surgeon's knife. We saw open- ings into the skull, and operate upon the brain; we open the belly and cut out kidneys, spleens, and parts of the stomach and bowels, the liver and pancreas, the bladder, and whatever other organs are contained in the abdomen ;' we open up joints and nail bones together, or cut out pieces of them ; we cut off bits of the lungs, and even the heart itself is WOUNDS 135 ;ikely to become subject to operation at no distant day, for it has already been pierced, and had blood pumped out of its cavity. Several circumstances modify the danger of a wound, such as its depth, its extent, and its location. The character of the deeper parts affected also has a powerful influence upon the result : wounds of the blood-vessels are likely to result fatally, unless the bleeding is checked; wounds of the brain, lungs, and intestines are likely to be followed by death, unless treated with the utmost skill and care ; heart wounds rarely /ail to be mortal, while those affecting the bones and joints are liable to complications which may induce death. The kind of wound inflicted also affects the result. Punctured wounds, such as stabs and shot-wounds, are the most dangerous in proportion to the amount of external injury inflicted, both because they may penetrate deep enough to sever a blood-vessel or injure other vital organs, and because foreign bodies, such as bits of clothing and splinters of bone, may have been carried into the wound in addition to the bullet, which is generally harmless to the surrounding tissues. In a chapter devoted to the subject, methods of checking bleeding will be discussed in detail. It will be seen that bright red blood spout- ing in a jet from a wound indicates that an artery has been opened, and that such bleeding may be stopped by pressure upon a limb above the wound, or by thrusting a finger or thumb into the wound itself and holding it there until other means of arresting bleeding have been applied. If the bleeding consist of dark, blackish red blood pouring steadily from the wound, it will have originated in an injured vein, and this should be treated by pressing a thumb or finger into the wound until other more serviceable means of treatment can be applied. In either one of these cases a surgeon should be summoned immediately, especially if the amount of bleeding be great, and, meanwhile, no other dressings can well be applied except where bleeding has been checked by pressure above the wound, or by a plug in it : in this case a wet compress may be laid upon the wound pending the arrival of a surgeon. The wound, however, should still be watched with increas- ing vigilance, so that any recurrence of bleeding may be observed at once. Slight bleeding, especially that from the capillaries, may be readily controlled by the application of a little hot or cold water, and by the pressure of dressings which may be applied at once. Cleanliness is of Vital Importance to Wounds. All foreign matters should be removed. Dirt, bits of glass, gravel, or cloth, splinters of wood, fishhooks, pins or thorns, should be picked out and the wound washed with clean, or, preferably, clean water with germicides — corro- sive sublimate, carbolic acid, salt, sugar, vinegar, etc. — in solution. Micro-organisms contained in water are killed by boiling, and fresh- boiled water may always be used with advantage where antiseptic solu- \ 136 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS tions cannot be obtained. In washing wounds, use absolutely clean materials, sponges, or masses of absorbent cotton or gauze if available, and failing these, use clean handkerchiefs or other linen, or paper. Do not use materials torn from the clothing of the patient or by- standers. The wound should not be mopped with the sponge, and except in assisting in the removal of something especially difficult to extract, should not be allowed to be touched by it. The sponge should be dipped into the water and then held in the closed hand a few inches above the wound, with one cor- ner protruding, and gently squeezed so as to cause a single stream to trickle gently down upon the injured sur- face. The force of the flow of the fluid used for washing should be varied according to the difficulty of washing away the dirt ; the size of the stream can be increased by squeezing the sponge harder, and its force by holding it at a greater distance from the wound. Unclean water should never be used — a wound had better be left dry. Stagnant water is particularly liable to be full of vegetable and animal microscopic life. Any hair in the vicinity of a wound should, if possible, be carefully clipped short, and preferably shaven, to obviate any irritant action by its contact with the wound. Having cleansed the wound, the injured parts should be carefully drawn as nearly as possible into their original position. This is of importance in diminishing the size of the scar. In a simple cut, if the edges are promptly drawn closely together, healing will occur without leaving any scar. The rapidity and completeness of the healing in such cases is often astonishing. Where a greater or less part of a finger or toe has been cut off with a sharp instrument like a knife or an axe, it has often been made to unite to the stump by binding it closely to the point whence it has been removed. In these cases, the amputated finger or toe has often readily grown again to its old place. A finger or toe, then, which has bee?i cut off should be immediately fitted into its place and neatly bound there in order to give it a chance to grow to the body again. Fig. 95. — How to squeeze a sponge in washing a wound. CLOSING WOUNDS 137 The preferable method of retaining the edges of wounds together is by means of stitches of antiseptic materials ; the surgeon uses silk, catgut, silkworm gut, and a number of similar materials. Horse hair properly treated may be used with advantage. Stitching, however, should not be attempted except by a medical man, or one who has had practical experience in the manoeuvre under the eye of a surgeon. Switching a wound leaves a much smaller scar than any other means ot closing, and where a surgeon can be obtained, a wound should always be so treated. Sticking-plaster will retain the edges of a i — y y — | wound together superficially, but it is impossi- / \ j ble to keep an injury clean with plaster sticking to it, and where practicable to avoid it, the Fig. 96. — Mode of cutting plaster should not be used. If, however, one stri P s of Poster to afford is driven by necessity to use it, the wound a larger sticking surface. should never be entirely covered by the plaster, since it would then confine any matter which might be secreted. The edges of the wound should be drawn closely together and held in place by narrow strips of plaster, leaving intervals between them for the escape of secretions and the contact of dressings. Where there is a marked tendency for the edges to gape, a larger sticking surface may be obtained by making the plaster a little larger at either end. However, where adhesive plaster spread on muslin, such as surgeons use, is available, all contact of the plaster with the wound may be avoided by taking two strips of plaster one or two inches wide and a trifle longer than the wound. Lay these on either side of the wound with their inner Fig. 97. — Wound closed by sticking plaster and laced threads. edges a half an inch from it on either side, parallel to it and leaving about a quarter of an inch of the upper margin loose and having the remainder tightly stuck. Then with a needle and thread, preferably silk, draw the edges of the wound together by lacing the free edges of the plaster as shown in Fig. 97, fastening the thread at either end with I38 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS knots and pressing the plaster firmly down as soon as the thread has been drawn tight. Any hair should be cut, by shaving, if possible, from localities where the plaster is to be applied. If the hair is left in place, the removal of the plaster sticking to it will be painful. Strips of sticking-plaster should not be drawn completely about a limb, on account of the danger of interference with the circula- tion of the blood in the extremity. In removing strips of plaster from a wound where it has been applied, the two ends should each be raised as in Fig. 98, and that part lying over the wound removed last. Where stitching and closure with stick- ing-plaster are both impracticable, the Fig. 98. — Mode of removal of parts should be drawn together as well sticking-plaster strips. as possible, and a compress applied and bandaged in place. In dressing a wound, two objects are to be considered: (1) to retain the parts in a position suitable for healing, and (2) to prevent future dangerous complications. To fulfil the first, we apply stitches, adhesive plaster, compresses, splints, and bandages. The fulfilment of the second demands care against (a) catching cold, (6) getting into painful positions, or being jarred, and (c) the access of micro-organisms. The parts having been cleansed and brought into proper position, the application of a compress is the next procedure in order. In the chapter on Dressings and Applications, the method of preparing com- presses has been fully described. After a pad of antiseptic gauze, cloth, lint, oakum, cotton, paper, or other proper substance has been duly prepared, soaked with clean water, preferably boiled, or an antiseptic solution, it is gently placed upon the wound and made to lie closely upon it. As has already been noted, where absolutely clean water or antiseptic solutions cannot be obtained the dressings may be applied dry. The compress is then bound securely in place by a triangular band- age, a folded handkerchief, or possibly a roller bandage, and the part placed in a comfortable attitude. The bandages may be left in place until the wound heals, or until the production of matter of a disagreeable odor shows that the dressings need renewing. The injured part should lastly be placed in such a position as to give the patient the least discomfort, whether he remains on the spot or is carried away. If the head be so injured that the patient is unable to hold it up, he should be laid down with the head resting upon a pillow, extemporized, if necessary, from folded clothing, hay, straw, grass, or any other material which would answer the purpose, taking care that TORN AND PIERCED WOUNDS 1 39 the injury be kept from contact with the surrounding articles which might prove painful. If the arm be injured, it should be supported in a sling if the patient is able to walk ; or supported in a comfortable attitude either across the body or by his side, if it be necessary to carry him. If a lower limb be affected, it may be supported by pillows, extemporized if necessary, in such a position as may be comfortable, while at the same time not tending to disturb the parts. If the chest be injured, the head and shoulders should be raised by pillows until the patient is able to breathe comfortably, the body being turned slightly to the injured side. If the belly be wounded, the patient should be made to lie down with his knees well drawn up and turned upon the injured side, or upon the back if the wound is in front. Torn or lacerated wounds are almost always bruised as well, but are characterized by ragged edges. They may be caused by stones or bricks, clubs or broken glass, machinery, and many other agents. They may be dangerous in the extreme, especially in connection with accidents due to the railway, or machinery. An entire limb may be torn away, or it may be so crushed as to require to be amputated. In these accidents it often happens that the blood-vessels are so twisted as to close them, and render the bleeding comparatively trifling. Such injuries are to be treated temporarily like ordinary wounds — foreign matters are to be removed, the parts cleansed and covered with suitably prepared com- presses, bandaged, and placed in as comfortable a position as possible. The pain in extensive injuries of this kind is often not very great, but the depression or shock is likely to be extreme ; it should be treated with hot, dry fomentations, hot drinks, and the like, as detailed in the chapter on Fainting. Where the head, chest, or belly has been crushed, the accident is almost always immediately fatal ; but in other localities, recovery occasionally occurs in apparently desperate cases. Small wounds of the head and face, because of the abundant blood supply, usually unite promptly, and with but a trifling scar, if the parts are neatly drawn together. Torn wounds generally, however, heal slowly, and by granulation, producing a greater or less amount of offensive matter, requiring frequent renewals of the dressings. Pierced or punctured wounds are caused in war, by bayonets, swords, arrows, daggers, and similar implements; and in peace, by needles, thorns, splinters, fish-hooks, bits of glass, and other articles of like character. The immediate treatment of pierced wounds in general, after the piercing body has been removed, consists simply in the appli- cation of suitable wet compresses. If the wound be large, the injury of important organs of bleeding may modify the treatment. Upon re- moving a needle, examine it, to see if any of it has been broken off in the flesh. If any portion has been left behind, or if the whole needle has been pushed in, do not try to remove it, but keep the part absolutely still, and summon a surgeon. Any movement of the part will cause I40 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS muscular contractions, which may so move the needle in the flesh that it cannot be found when the surgeon comes to look for it. Thorns should be pulled out, and, if poisonous, the wound should be treated like a poisoned wound. Splinters should be pulled out by slipping the point of a pen-knife under the protruding end of the splinter, catching it against the blade with the thumb nail, and drawing it out. If the end does not protrude, the scarf skin over it can be pricked away with the point of the knife, Fig. 99. — How to pull out a splinter. until the end of the splinter is uncovered, when it can be removed as before. If a splinter be located under a nail, and the end be broken off so that it cannot be reached, the nail over the splinter should be scraped thin to the tip on the outside; a little tongue can then be gently cut out over the end of the splinter, which may then be raised on the point of the knife, and drawn out as in other parts. When the splinter cannot all be removed in this way, the cutting away of the nail will make it easier for the remainder to work its way to the surface after the formation of matter. A splinter in the eye may be drawn out, as in other parts, if it can be reached. If it cannot be reached, the eye should be covered with a cold, wet compress, and so kept until the arrival of a medical man. On no account should a non-medical person attempt to interfere with splinters buried in the eye. In the case of needles or large splinters, where a portion may possibly remain in the flesh, the part which has been pulled out should be kept to show to the medical adviser when he shall have arrived, in order to assist him to determine the character of the portion left behind. PENETRATING WOUNDS I4I Fish-hooks and arrows in the tissues demand much the same treat- merit, the difficulty in removing both being due to the barbed point. As fish-hooks never penetrate deeply, they can readily be pushed through the tissues — they should never be drawn back unless the barbed point has been cut off. The best method of treating fish-hooks in the flesh is to draw them through : this procedure is assisted by cutting off the loop by which they are connected to the lines. So with arrows — where the tip lies near the surface, and important organs are not in the way, — they may be pushed through. Where this is impossible, a string should be firmly tied about the shaft, so that it cannot slip, within a half an inch of the wound, and the shaft should then be cut off a half an inch above that point. The wound should then be treated with antiseptic com- presses, until a surgeon can remove the arrow. The string will prevent the arrow's being lost, should an accidental movement push it into the tissues. Gunshot wounds, including pistol-shot wounds, are pierced and often torn wounds. Like other wounds, they should be treated by checking bleeding, removing superficial dirt, applying antiseptic compresses, and, lastly, splints to prevent unnecessary movements. Often the bleeding from these wounds is very slight, and is checked by the simple pressure of the dressings. There is apt to be much depression and other symp- toms of shock, which should be treated by hot drinks, and hot dry fomentations, as directed in the chapter on Fainting. The bullet is apt to be the source of much anxiety to the uninitiated. Ordinarily, there is no danger whatever in the presence of a bullet in the tissues. It is the wound made by the bullet that bothers us. There are thousands of men wa king about the country to-day with bullets in their bodies, which are not of ihe least trouble to them. A shot wound, then, should be treated like an ordinary wound, and without regard to the presence of the bullet. W ounds of the chest may penetrate into its cavity or not. If they do not, their treatment is the same as that of simple wounds in other parts. If they do penetrate, they are liable to involve the organs contained within it. If the heart is wounded, death usually quickly follows; although that this is not always so is shown by a considerable num- ber of cases recorded in surgical literature. If the lung be wounded, difficulty of breathing, coughing, and spitting of blood will occur, and the lung may protrude through the wound. Such an injury should be treated by making the patient lie down upon the wounded side, so as to let the blood drain to that side, and keep absolutely quiet : an attempi should be made to check excessive bleeding, and the wound should be dressed with a compress, and the entire chest closely surrounded with bandages. Penetrating wounds, in rare instances, do not involve the organs in the chest. t4 ounds of the abdomen, like those of the chest, may penetrate into 142 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Fig 100. — Relations of the organs of the chest and abdomen to the clothing. the cavity or not. If they do not, their treatment is the same as that of simple wounds in other parts. If they do pene- trate, they may involve the organs of the belly or not. The bowels or other parts may protrude from the wounds, and may or may not be injured. If the bowels or other parts protrude, they should be care- fully examined, — the hands having previously been washed either with an antiseptic solu- tion or with clean water, — and if they are uninjured, gently pushed back into the belly. If they have been injured, they should not be returned, but should be covered with wet fomentations as hot as can be comfortably endured with the hand. These in turn should be thoroughly covered to pre- vent cooling. And a surgeon should have been summoned. All wounds of the body are likely to produce great shock, and every effort should be made to sustain the victim by hot drinks and other treatment appropriate to this condition. Penetrating wounds affect different organs according to their location. In Fig. ioo an effort has been made to show the relations of these organs to the uniform of the soldier, and from it a similar notion of the relations of the clothing of others may be derived. In the chapter on Bones, the method of identifying the different vertebrae of the spine has been related. The verte- DANGERS OF WOUNDS 1 43 Dorsal Vertebrae. brae bear constant relations to the organs of the chest and belly, and by an examination of them an idea of the parts probably injured in a wound of the oody may be obtained. It is easy to discover the spinal processes of the vertebiae by briskly rubbing the hand up and down along the back of the spine, when each one will be marked by a red spot. The following table, from Holden's Landmarks, indicates the relations : — Cervical ( 5th. Beginning of the oesophagus or " gullet." Vertebrae. \ 7th. Upper extremity of the lungs. ' 3d. (a) Apex of the arch of the aorta, the great funda- mental blood-vessel of the body, (b) Division of the trachea or " windpipe " into two primary bron- chial tubes. (a) Upper margin of the heart. (b) The begin- ning of the arch of the aorta on the right side, and (c) its end on the left side. Apex or lowest point of the heart on the left. (a) Passage of the oesophagus or " gullet," through the diaphragm or " midriff" into the abdomen or " belly." (b) Upper edge of the spleen on the left. (a) Lower edges of lungs, (b) Upper orifice of stomach on the left. Lower edge of spleen on the left. (a) Lowest part of the cavity of the chest (b) Pas- sage of the aorta through the diaphragm, f 1st. (a) Arteries of the kidneys, and (b) the centres of the kidneys themselves on both sides. 2d. (a) End of spinal cord, (b) Pancreas or " belly ■{ sweetbread." 3d. Umbilicus or "navel." 4th. (a) Division of the aorta, (b) Highest part of the hip bones on both sides. The dangers of wounds, when not properly treated, are many. Blood poisoning, gangrene, or death of a part, excessive production of matter, together with great depression due to it, long-continued inflammation, and high fever are liable to follow any wound, and are due to the fact that micro-organisms have gained access to the wound. Even the smallest wounds may be productive of the most unfortunate consequences, when neglected. Small scratches and pricks, when not properly cared for, may result in inflammations and formations of gatherings or abscesses, which may disable a person for a considerable time, or cause loss of a limb, or even of life itself. This fact still further emphasizes the necessity for the utmost care in removing all impurities from a wound at once by washing 4th. 8th. 9th. 10th. nth. 1 2th. Lumbar Vertebrae. ] 144 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS with clean water at least, and covering the wound with a bandage ol some kind to protect it from contact with possibly injurious matter. - The process of healing of wounds varies according to the nature of the injury and the character of the treatment. The processes may be grouped into two general classes, (i) Primary union or " first intention," and (2) Secondary union or " second intention." 1. Primary union occurs rapidly and without the formation of matter, and leaves only a slight scar. It can be obtained in wounds with clean- cut edges, where the margins can be perfectly fitted together without anything intervening;, they must be kept perfectly quiet and protected from outward injury and from contact with external impurities. In this case, a material called lymph, which is practically the liquor sanguinis. is thrown out from the capillaries in the wound and acts like glue in sticking the sides of the wound together. The capillary vessels are then extended across the wound, and the circulation through it be- comes as complete as before the injury. The surgeon always seeks to approach as near primary union as possible, a wound uniting by this process completely in two or three days. Under old methods such a result was comparatively uncommon, but with the recognition of the functions of micro-organisms and the means of preventing their action, the surgeon is able to obtain primary union in the great majority of cases. 2. Secondary union, second intention, or granulation, occurs slowly with the formation of matter and leaves a considerable scar. In this case (a) more or less of the tissues may have been lost, as in deep burns, ulcers, or wounds where more or less of the tissues have been torn out ; (£>) the tissues adjoining the wound may be so injured as to be incapa- ble of new life, as in cases where the parts have been bruised or torn to a greater or less extent; (c) foreign matters, such as bits of cloth, or even clots of blood, may be interposed between the edges of the wound ; (d) the wound may not have been kept quiet ; (e) micro-organisms and dirt may have been allowed to enter the wound, causing decay of the tissues and the formation of matter. In these cases there is a vacancy which has to be filled up by new tissue. This is accompanied by the development in the wound of small red bodies like pin heads, called granulations, which are often covered to a greater or less extent with a thick, creamy fluid consisting of lymph with white blood corpuscles which have escaped from the capillary vessels. These granulations increase in number until the cavity of the wound is entirely filled. When this occurs, the skin at the edges of the wound begins to grow inward toward the centre, gradually diminishing the size of the opening until it is entirely covered by a fine red skin called scar tissue ; as time passes, the unnecessary blood-vessels which at first are very numerous disappear and the scar loses its red tinge, often becoming whiter than the surrounding skin ; at the same time the seal BLEEDING 145 becomes harder and contracts, so that if it be a large one the parts may be greatly drawn, as seen in the hand illustrated on page 130. While this is going on at the surface, the capillary blood-vessels find their way among the granulations, and the mass is organized into new tissue. Healing by second intention requires from a week to several months for its completion, according to the size of the wound and the favorable character of its surroundings. The excessive formation of granulations causing them to project above the surrounding skin is commonly known. as "proud flesh." And where a wound refuses to heal, but breaks down with the forma- tion of granulations and the production of yellow or greenish yellow matter or pus, it is commonly said that the wound has " festered." The healing of wounds is modified by many conditions. A wound is apt to heal more rapidly in a healthy than in a delicate person. Youth is a great advantage, and habitual drinking a great disadvantage. A wound of the head heals, as a rule, more rapidly than one in any other part of the body, while one of the upper extremities closes more quickly than one of the lower. Poisoned wounds naturally heal badly, but these are reserved until they can be considered in the light of an acquaintance with the action and effects of poisons in the chapter devoted to that subject. CHAPTER XVIII BLEEDING Bleeding. — Definition : The escape of blood from its vessels. Varieties: (1) Arterial bleeding — the most dangerous. (2) Venous bleeding. (3) Capillary bleeding or oozing — the least dangerous. Causes: (1) Of arterial bleeding: a wound of an artery. (2) Of venous bleeding : a wound of a vein. (3) Of capillary bleeding or oozing : a wound involving only capillary vessels. Symptoms. A. Common to all: The appearance of blood, except in internal bleeding. Where severe and not promptly checked, the face is first pale and : 4 6 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS then blue, the pulse sinks, the body becomes cold, the patient is dizzy and inclined to vomit, the eyes are dazzled, he hears noises, and finally becomes uncon- scious. B. Peculiar to each variety, (i) Of arterial bleeding : color bright red, and spurts in jets. (2) Of venous bleeding : color dark red or purplish, and wells out in a continuous stream. (3) Of capillary bleed- ing : slow oozing of blood, neither dark nor bright red. Treatment : 1 . Of arterial bleeding. Summon a surgeon immediately ! (a) Expose the wound. (b) Make the patient lie down, and lift up the wounded part. (c) Press with the thumb or finger on or into the wound to temporarily stop the bleeding, (d) If the location of the large artery of the part is known (as per appended table), press upon it above the wound with the fingers, and later with a tourniquet ; if the location of the large artery is not known, surround the limb above the wound with a bandage drawn so tightly as to check the flow of blood, (e) Dress the wound with a compress and bandage. Point Wounded. Artery to Compress. Location. Part pressed AGAINST. Arm (see also Forearm) j 1 Subclavian. Runs over ist rib, back of middle of collar bone. First rib. Axillary. Runs along the arm side of the armpit, near the front of the arm. Arm bone (Humerus). Brachial. Runs along inner bor- der of the biceps muscle. Arm bone (Humerus). Armpit. Subclavian. Runs over ist rib, back of middle of collar bone. First rib. Cheek. Facial. Runs over lower jaw bone one inch in front of its angle. Lower jaw bone. BLEEDING 147 Point Wounded. Artery to Compress. Location. Part pressed AGAINST. Chest. Intercostal. Runs along inner mar- gin of upper or lower border of rib. Inner face of adjacent rib. 1 Lower part Face ) Facial. Runs over lower jaw bone one inch in front of its angle. Lower jaw bone. I Upper part Temporal. Runs along temporal bone just in front of the ear. Temporal bone. r Finger . . . -^ Digital. Front of finger on either side. Phalanges. Palmar arches. Palm of hand. Metacarpus. f Sole . . Foot contro „ ing In case of a wound of either temple, bleeding in the temple, the temporal artery below the wound should be compressed upon the bone (Fig. 104). It will be remembered that this artery runs up in front of the ear, and divides into two branches. Permanent compression may be 154 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Fig. 105. — Pressure with the thumb, controlling bleeding from the face. applied by means of the knotted turn of the roller bandage (page 1 06), a suitable pad being held in place under the knot. The arteries of the face are mostly branches of the facial, which crosses the lower jaw about an inch in front of the angle of the jaw, where its pulse can be readily felt. (1) Bleeding can then be controlled by pressing the artery down firmly upon the jaw bone with the thumb, or, if it be desirable to make it permanent, a suitable pad may be ap- plied instead of the thumb, and bound firmly in place by a bandage passing under the lower jaw and over the top of the head. (2) Temporary control of the bleeding may also be obtained in wounds of the cheeks or lips by passing the thumb into the mouth, and, grasping the cheek just below the wound, between the thumb and fingers, pressing the artery between them. Bleeding from Arteries of the Neck. — When the large vessels of the neck are severed, as in " cut throat " or other wounds in that region, the utmost quickness in checking the bleeding is necessary to save life. A moment's delay may be fatal, for the blood rushes from these vessels in tumultuous tor- rents. All of the carotid arte- ries and most of their branches are large and important vessels. It should be remembered that the line of the carotid arteries extends from the mastoid pro- cess behind the ear down to the edge of the top of the breast bone. Without an instant's de- lay, in a wound of this kind, the vessel should be promptly pressed back upon the spine with the thumb, and held there until the assistance of a surgeon is brought. No attempt should be made to substi- tute a pad for the finger, for nothing else can be trusted. Fig. 106. — Pressure with the thumb, controlling bleeding in the neck. BLEEDING FROM ARTERIES OF THE ARM 55 Fig. 107. — Pressure back of the collar bone, controlling bleeding from the upper extremity. As the hemorrhage in the neck may proceed from the veins, and as this is almost equal in danger to that from arteries, it may perhaps be best in al-1 cases to apply the pressure directly in the wound. It should be remembered, however, that there must be no hesitation or delay in applying the treatment, whatever it is. Bleeding from Arteries of the Upper Extremity. — The course of the great artery of the upper extremity may be remembered (Fig. 113) as arising out of the chest ; it runs over the first rib just under the middle of the collar bone {subclavian artery}, passes thence to the inner side of the arm {axillary artery}, running down along the inner edge of the biceps muscle {brachial artery) to the middle of the elbow, just below which it divides into two main branches {radial and ulnar arteries), which course down either anterior edge of the forearm, and form two arches in the palm of the hand {palmar arches) . If the injury be in the armpit, the artery must be compressed either under the collar bone or in the wound itself. (1) To compress the artery under the collar bone, the thumb should be thrust strongly down behind the middle of the bone until the pulsation of the subclavian Fig 108. — The handle of artery is felt, when the pressure should a door key padded for be cont i nuec J unt jl t h e blood Ceases to pressure under the col- n rT ^ 1 , , . . , ar bone flow. The subclavian is not easy to compress, and this manoeuvre should be thoroughly practised upon one's friends. If a surgeon can be got within a reasonable time, the pressure of the thumb should be maintained until his arrival. If, however, some 1 5 6 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS considerable time must elapse, the thumb, even of the strong- est man, will become tired and powerless, and a substitute for it will be desirable. • In this case the handle of a key or any similar article, suitably padded, may be slipped down under the thumb and applied upon the artery. (2) Pressure in the wound is performed by pushing the thumb forcibly into it, and pressing the parts strongly against the arm bone. If the injury be in the arm, the bleeding may be checked by compression of the subclavian, as described above, and by pressure upon the brachial artery in the wound itself or in the arm. Aside from pressure in the wound itself, (1) pressure of the ar- tery with the fingers against the arm bone is the most readily applied. The arm should always be raised in cases of this kind, as shown in Fig. 101. (2) Volker's stick tourniquet (Fig. 1 10) — composed of two sticks six to eight inches long, a half to three quarters of an inch thick, and notched at the ends, which are bound together by any available material — is an excellent means of exerting permanent pressure upon the artery of the arm. (3) A tourniquet extemporized from a handkerchief, a bandage, or any similar article, as described on -page 151, — particularly when supplied with a pad to press directly upon the artery (Fig. 102), — is of the utmost value, and perhaps the most valuable extemporized means of checking bleeding from the arm. (4) Where a screw tourniquet can be had, it should be used in preference to the other appliances, provided the artery can be located readily. Fig. 109. — Pressure upon the artery above the wound, controlling bleeding from the arm. Fig. 110. — Volker's stick tourniquet for pressure upon the artery of the arm. BLEEDING FROM ARTERIES OF THE ARM 1 57 The foregoing demand some knowledge of the course ot the vessels, and, while they are the best for the patient, yet it often occurs that those who are obliged to render first aid are not at all familiar with anatomy. In this case, methods not demanding such knowledge may be used, but it should not be forgotten that where a limb is tightly surrounded by any band, it is likely to become strangled and permanently injured. Still, where a life is at stake a certain amount of risk must be taken. (5) Rubber tubing, elastic bandages, and the like are available here as well as in other extremities, and can be used when obtainable with the greatest advantage. (6) A rod of wood, a base or billiard ball, and other articles of the kind, when pushed strongly into the armpit, form an excellent means of checking bleeding from the arm, if the limb be strongly bound down to the side, so as to compress the artery closely against the bone (Fig. 112). In case of a wound at the elbow, all the procedures pre- scribed for the arm are to be applied. If an artery in the forearm be wounded, in addition to pressure in the wound itself, (1) the methods employed for the arm and elbow may be used ; for if the arm be so bound that the blood cannot pass below the arm or elbow, it certainly cannot issue from the forearm. (2) A readily applied method consists in Fig. 112. — Pressure placing a hard body, such as a cane, a small upon the artery of bottle a rod f rom a tree Qr any s i m il ar article the arm by a ruler . , ,, , , , ,. in the armpit. m tne elbow, and strongly bending it upon it : this may be made permanent by band- aging the forearm strongly to the arm (Fig. 115). If the injury be low down, particularly in the wrist, in ad- dition to methods in the arm and elbow, bleeding may be Fig. III. — The screw tourni- quet applied for control- ling bleeding of the arm. I58 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS checked by pressing the wounded artery strongly upon the forearm bones. However, in this case, it is better to apply the pressure in the arm or elbow ; for, on account of the large palmar arches, the blood will spurt out of both ends of the divided artery. Pressing the artery on both sides of the wound, however, will arrest the bleeding and, as well, pressure in the wound itself. In the palm of the hand, the same condition exists, and pressure must be exerted either in the arm or elbow, or both forearm arteries must be compressed. Bleeding here can, however, often be controlled by grasping some hard object, like a billiard ball, or a smooth stone, or, in emergency, even an apple or a potato, in the palm : the pressure may be made permanent by bandaging the hand strongly in this position. Bleeding from the fingers can always be controlled by pressure in the wound or above it, with the finger, or any other means of applying it. Bleeding from the Arteries of the Body. — In bleeding wounds of the chest and abdomen, pressure should always be exerted in the wound itself, with a single exception. The exception is the case of a wound of one of the intercostal arteries, running along the edges of the ribs, and rather inside of the chest, so that the pressure upon the bone must be exerted from within outwards. To effect this, make up a little roll, preferably of antiseptic gauze, or of any other clean cloth, and tie it firmly with a string ; work the roll through the wound into the chest, and then pull upon the string forcibly enough to press the roll against the bleeding vessel upon the rib. In other wounds of the trunk, the bleeding should be con- trolled by pressure in the wound, with the fingers temporarily, or with a hard lump or pad and bandage permanently. Bleeding from Arteries of the Lower Extremity. — The arrangement of the arteries of the lower extremity is very similar to that of the upper extremity. A single large vessel {femoral artery) passes into the thigh, over the front of the hip bone, at the middle of the groin ; it runs down the middle of the thigh, and in the lower portion passes through BLEEDING FROM THE ARTERIES 159 Fig. 113. — The arteries of the body, showing their relations to the bones at the points where pressure is to be made to control bleeding. i6o EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS to the back of the thigh, where it runs behind the knee (popliteal artery), and, just below the joint, separates into two arteries, one of which runs down, skirting the lower edge of the internal malleolus, at the inner face of the ankle, to supply the sole of the foot (posterior tibial artery), and the other down the front of the ankle, to the top of the foot (anterior tibial artery) . The artery is found near the surface in the groin and the upper part of the thigh, the back of the knee, the outer side of the heel, and in the front of the ankle. These points are naturally the proper localities for the appli- cation of pressure to check bleeding. In case of bleeding from the arteries of the thigh, (i) the great femoral artery must be compressed in the middle of the groin, against the hip bone. Wounds of this artery are rapidly mortal unless immediate treatment is applied. Delay is fatal I Like the subclavian, it is very difficult to compress, and both thumbs should be applied upon it with all the force possible. If the arrival of a surgeon — who should be summoned immediately — is delayed, a substitute should be pro- vided in a tourniquet, extemporized or prepared. (2) The Spanish windlass (Fig. 102) — a lump, suitably padded, being applied directly upon the artery — may be used. (3) An elastic band or a rubber tube is useful here as 'in other places . A screw tourniquet, with the pad upon the artery, is of service. (4) A pole, extending from the ceiling to the bed, may be so arranged — one end pressing upon the ceiling and the other upon the artery — as to hold the flow of blood in check. (5) Compression by the finger in the wound is here of value as well as elsewhere, and the only objection to it is the liability to soil the wound with matters clinging to the thumb. Bleeding from the back of the knee or ham proceeds from Fig. 114. — Pressure upon the artery of the thigh by the thumbs, to control bleed- ins: below it. BLEEDING FROM ARTERIES OF THE LEG l6l the popliteal artery, a continuation of the femoral, and it must be controlled by precisely the same manoeuvres as bleeding from the thigh, — compression of the femoral artery in the middle of the groin, or pressure in the wound. If the injury involve an arterial wound of the leg, (i) the bleeding may be controlled in the same way as that of the thigh and ham. (2) It may be checked for a short time by bending the leg strongly back on the thigh, but this position cannot be maintained long on account of the resulting weari- ness to the patient. (3) But the appli- cation in the ham of a pad, such as an ordinary base ball, or an apple, potato, or even a stone of a similar size and shape, with the leg strongly bent upon it, will control the bleeding without the insufferable weariness. A rod, such as a cane or umbrella, a branch from a tree, or anything of the kind should be Fig. 11 5. — Pressure by a pad passed under it, and supported strongly in the hollow of the knee v . . \ , l . , & J with a rod, to hold it in upon it by a bandage passing about place controMing b)eed . the bent limb. (4) The finger in the ing in the leg and below. wound may be used here also, subject to the objection of being a possible conveyer of infection. The foot is supplied by three arteries, all of which, like those of the hand, communicate so freely with one another, that, as in the hand, it is usually best to apply the pressure directly upon the wound. This may be done first by the thumb, and later by a suitably prepared pad and bandage. The foot is peculiarly adapted to treatment by elevation, the patient lying on his back ; and it is well to apply all treat- ment with the foot lifted up. Bleeding from a wound of the sole of the foot may usually be controlled by pressure upon the posterior tibial artery, just below the internal malleolus, applied in the usual way. If the bleeding is not checked, pressure added upon the anterior tibial in front of the ankle will generally stop the bleeding ; and if this is not successful, the peroneal, a small artery on the outer ankle, may also be subjected to pressure. This will control the bleeding in the l62 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS most extreme cases. If the back of the foot be the seat of injury, the anterior tibial in front of the ankle should be compressed first, and then the others as needed (Fig. 116). Bleeding from Wounds of Veins. — Venous bleeding in general is comparatively free from danger, although a wound of one of the great veins of the neck {jugulars) in " cut throat " is a condition to be feared nearly as much as an arterial wound. Other large veins, especially in the extremi- ties, accompany the arteries, and although they are often injured at the same time, the veins may be divided alone. Not uncommonly, "superficial veins, particularly in the leg, become greatly enlarged, and form twisted, knotted ridges Fig. 116. — Pressure at the inner side of the ankle, controlling bleeding in the foot, under the skin : these are varicose veins. Injuries to them are equal in danger to those of veins normally greater in size. It will be remembered that veins are provided with frequent valves, which prevent the return of blood from the heart. In large veins, however, it often happens that the valves are absent, or incompetent, so that in case of a venous wound. BLEEDING FROM VEINS AND CAPILLARIES 163 the blood will flow from both ends of the divided vessel. In varicose veins the valves are, by disease, rendered useless, so that in case of a wound or rupture the blood will escape freely from both directions. It will also be recalled that veins are very flaccid and easily compressed, so that but little pressure is needed to control bleeding from these vessels. To control bleeding from any vein, then, a method which would compress both ends at the same time is desirable ; and this is found in the method of direct pressure in the wound itself. It is accomplished by pressing firmly with the thumb at first, in order to hold the bleeding in check temporarily. Then, a suitable pad having been provided, it should be bound upon the wound firmly enough to restrain the bleed- ing permanently. Any tight article of clothing which binds the body between the injury and the heart — since it may interfere with the return of the blood — should be loosened. Garters should be removed, belts should be unfastened, and collars should be taken off, so as to allow the blood free flow toward the heart. And the application of elev ition to all venous wounds should not be forgotten. Bleeding from wounds of veins may be controlled, where the valve. are intact, by simple pressure upon the vein below the wound — be- tween the capillaries and the wound. This method of treatment is advised by many authorities, and may be used with advantage where it is absolutely impossible to find clean materials for a pad — which will be rarely. Indeed, pads above and below the wound may be used to con- trol vein injuries where the blood comes from both ends of the vessel. Bleeding from Wounds of the Capillaries. — This is the variety of bleeding most frequently seen when blood, not so bright as that in the arteries nor so dark as that in the veins, oozes from a small wound. Capillaries are so generally pres- ent in the tissues that capillary bleeding is present in all wounds, even though injury of larger vessels may mask it. It may vary in severity, sometimes oozing very slowly, as when a bit of scarf skin is scraped off, and again, flowing in 164 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS a considerable stream, as when a finger has been cut with a pocket knife. It will be found in scratches, pricks, and slight cuts of all kinds, whether from the careless use of the razor, a slip of a knife, accidental contact with broken glass, or similar accidents. The treatment is simple. Mere exposure to the air for a few moments, with no other treatment, will often see capillary bleeding completely checked. The exposure causes contrac- tion of the open vessels and clotting of the blood, which, together with the small amount of blood pressure, renders it possible for plugs of blood clot to* quickly fill them. Hot water, as hot as it can be borne by the patient, is one of the most valuable and efficient means of controlling cap- illary bleeding, and is often used by surgeons to diminish the flow of blood during operations. It may be applied by squeezing out a sponge or a mass of cloth, as shown in con- nection with the cleansing of wounds (page 136). Extremely cold water has a similar effect to hot, although it is not quite as satisfactory in its action. Ice or ice water may be used with advantage for the relief of capillary bleeding. The pressure of a pad directly upon the bleeding part is also of advantage in controlling capillary bleeding. In this case the pad may well be wet with hot or cold water before binding it tightly in place. The use of styptics, such as perchloride of iron, Monsel's solution, tannic acid, styptic cotton, and the like, should be absolutely discouraged in any kind of bleeding, on account of their interference with the process of healing. The application of cobwebs or tobacco to bleeding surfaces is still more objectionable, — the first, on account of its liability to intro- duce not only dirt but disease-producing germs ; and the second, on account of the danger of absorption of its poisonous constituent, nico- tine. If a styptic is really needed, a little alum dissolved in clean water may be used, particularly in bleeding from the mouth and nose. Spitting of Blood. — The discharge of blood from the mouth is commonly known by this name, although it may be due to a number of different causes, and proceed from a num- ber of sources. (a) Blood may come from the mucous membrane of the SPITTING OF BLOOD l6$ nose, and run down through the posterior opening of the nose into the mouth. In this case, the blood can be felt passing down into the mouth ; and the treatment is the same as that for nosebleed. (J?) Blood may come from the mucous membrane of the mouth, and particularly from the gums. Slight bleeding of this kind is of no moment, and will quickly recover without treatment. At other times it continues so long and is so abundant as to be annoying in the extreme. In this case, filling the mouth with fluid as hot as can be borne, thus bringing it in contact with every bleeding point, is of advan- tage. Hot coffee or tea are as good as hot water, and are more agreeable to some. Pieces of ice in the mouth are also useful. Here alum can be used with advantage in a strong solution washed about the mouth. In the absence of alum, a strong solution of salt in water is of value, used in the same way. In case of bleeding from the cavity left after the ex- traction of a tooth, a plug of cotton saturated with either of the two latter agents may be of advantage. Severe bleeding from the tongue or the inner surface of the cheek may require to be controlled by pressure, which is best applied by pressing a pad directly upon the bleeding point with one finger, and supporting the opposite side with a thumb or another finger. (c) Blood may come from the throat, and in this case either the windpipe or the gullet may be injured. It is not prac- ticable to apply pressure directly here, and the treatment should be confined to placing the patient in a lying-down position, and keeping him as quiet as possible. If the bleed- ing is considerable, and ice is obtainable, he should be made to swallow a considerable quantity pounded into pieces the size of a pea. (d} Bleeding from the lungs, " pulmonary hemorrhage," is caused by the breaking of a vessel in the lungs, and is accom- panied by coughing, with rattling in the chest, while the blood itself is frothy and bright red. The break in the vessel is usually produced by the advance of consumption, although it may be due to a splinter from a broken bone sticking into the lung, or a wound due to any other cause. 1 66 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS A physician should be called at once. While awaiting his arrival, the patient should immediately be made to lie down, with pillows or their equivalent so placed as to slightly elevate the head and shoulders. Finely chopped ice should be eaten in this case also. If a teaspoonful or so of salt can be eaten with it occasionally, so much the better, or the salt may be dissolved in a little cold water, which may then be drank. The patient should be kept absolutely quiet, and while he should not be placed in danger of taking cold, the room should be kept very cool. If available, a quarter of a tea- spoonful of spirits of turpentine may be given in a little cold milk every two or three hours. The patient should be kept in a darkened room, and no persons not essential for his care should be admitted, while every effort should be made to have as little noise as possible. (e) Bleeding in the stomach is due . to the breaking of a vessel in the stomach, and may be caused by an ulcer eating into the vessel, or other causes which might produce rupture of a vessel in any part of the body. Blood from the stomach is vomited up, is usually clotted and never frothy, is of a color extending from dark red to black, and may be mingled with masses of food. It should be remem- bered that vomiting of blood if not invariably caused by bleeding into the stomach. Blood from the mouth, or even the nose, may be swallowed and thrown up again. The proper treatment in this case, after sending for a phy- sician, is to make the patient lie down, with the head and shoulders slightly raised ; keep him absolutely quiet, and feed him with chopped ice, and give him turpentine in quarter-teaspoonful doses in a little cold milk every two or three hours. Nosebleed, " nasal hemorrhage, 11 proceeds from the vessels of the mucous membrane of the nose, and, while it is usually of no moment, and stops spontaneously, it may be so severe and prolonged as to be very alarming. Usually, however, it need not be the source of the least anxiety, for a sufficient clot will readily form to hold it in check. If it be obstinate, cold water, or solutions of salt or alum, or even vinegar, may NOSEBLEED AND INTERNAL BLEEDING 167 be snuffed or syringed into the bleeding nostril. The arms may be lifted above the head — a procedure which is said to have been eminently successful. These having failed, the nostril must be plugged. The plug is best made of a long strip of cheese-cloth or old linen or muslin, a half an inch wide. With a pencil or a penholder, one end should be pushed into the nose as far as it will go ; the rest of the strip should then be pushed in firmly and packed tightly, the end being allowed to hang out of the nose. To remove the plug, the strip may readily be drawn out by this protruding end. If Jhe blood, dammed up in front, begins to find its way into the mouth through the posterior opening of the nostril, the plug has not been packed tightly enough behind, and it should be drawn out and packed in again. This plug should be kept in place for several hours, and when drawn out, the greatest care should be employed to prevent a renewal of the bleeding by too much force. If the dried blood has caused it to stick, it should not be pulled forcibly away, but should be loosened by warm water or oil. Internal Bleeding in General. — In internal bleeding, the blood may escape into a closed cavity, such as the abdomen or cranium, and present no external evidences, or it may escape through an opening in the cavity, artificial or natural, as through a wound in the chest or abdomen, or through the gullet or windpipe, from the lungs or stomach. Bleeding into the cranium is most often caused by rupture of one of the minute arteries of the brain, and constitutes the accident known as apoplexy, which will be treated further in the chapter on Fainting. Bleeding into the chest, where the lung is not wounded, may fill up the cavity with blood, and press upon the lung so much as to seriously interfere with breathing. In any case, the paleness, small pulse, chill of the body, dizziness, and inclination to vomit, and other symp- toms of bleeding are present, and demand the treatment due to shock in all cases, — a lying-down position, warmth in hot-water bottles to counteract the chill, and hot coffee or tea internally, except in case of bleeding from the lung or stomach. 168 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Secondary Bleeding, or " recurrent hemorrhage," not as common now as before the advent of the antiseptic era in surgery, may be due to the renewal of strength in the circulation after severe bleeding, or to the ulceration of a blood-vessel. In the former case, the bleeding comes on within a few hours, but the latter may occur after several weeks. Where the bleeding is slight, it may be controlled by the ad- dition of a little pressure upon the wound. If this is not sufficient, the dressing must be renewed, and the treatment proper to a fresh wound applied with great promptness. In severe secondary bleeding a surgeon should be summoned without delay. Special Susceptibility to Bleeding is sometimes found in persons who are surgically known as "bleeders." In these persons, the least scratch produces alarming bleeding, and the extraction of a tooth,has been known to result in death, by bleeding from the cavity. In such persons, the greatest care should be taken to avoid the occurrence of bleeding of any kind, and where the accident does occur, no delay should be made in applying temporary treatment and summoning a surgeon. CHAPTER XIX SPRAINS AND DISLOCATIONS Sprains. — Definition : A violent twist or strain of the soft parts about a joint. Causes : Any accident which may cause a twist or strain of a joint. Sympto?ns : Great pain at the joint, following an unusual strain, such as a wrench or twist. Swelling about the joint rapidly follows. Discoloration similar to that produced by a bruise is apt to appear in the swelling. The bones are in their proper place, as seen by com- parison with the same joint on the opposite side. The absence of signs of broken bones shows that that acci- dent has not occurred. Treatment : Place the joint in a position where it will have complete rest. Apply water as hot as can be borne freely about the joint, gradually increasing the heat, as long as it can be endured. Continue this for SPRATNS AND DISLOCATIONS 169 half an hour, and then substitute ordinary hot, moist fomentations for another half-hour, and finally put the joint up in a wet bandage, keeping it well elevated. Consult a surgeon. This affection invariably follows an accident. A man walking rap- idly, steps into a hole, and is thrown down, with a turn of his body. His foot being caught, the twist comes upon his ankle, and he has a sprain of the ankle, where this accident is by far the more frequently situated. Next in frequency comes the wrist, which is sprained by a fall, the hands being thrown out to catch the body, or in other ways. Other joints — the hip, shoulder, elbow, knee, etc. — are less frequently affected. The injury in a sprain depends to a great extent upon the inability of the ligaments to stretch when they are subjected to a strain. When a joint is wrenched or strongly pulled upon, the strain comes upon the ligaments, and they become bruised, and even torn. A small bit of the adjacent bone may even be torn off in a sprain. The same violence which has acted upon the ligaments is likely to act also upon the neigh- boring soft parts, the muscles, and even the skin. While in extreme cases, the bone and periosteum themselves are bruised. It is evident that a sprain is apt to be a much more serious accident than would appear at first. While there are slight sprains which will require no attention, it should not be forgotten that severe sprains are injuries of great importance, and that permanent lameness has often followed a failure to give such an injury proper immediate care. In sprains of the ankle, the entire foot and ankle should be plunged into water as hot as could be borne, and the heat should be gradually raised as high as possible without passing the endurance of the patient. In sprains of the wrist or fingers, the same course may be adopted. After continuing this from a half an hour to an hour, the part should be supported in an elevated position, — the foot placed on a chair, and the wrist in a sling, — and hot, wet cloths kept wrapped about it. After the first acute pain has subsided, in a day or so begin gently moving the joint, and rubbing it with soap liniment, oil, or vaseline ; and kneading it gently at intervals. Bones out of Joint. — Definition : The displacement of the end of a bone from its proper contact with another — a dislocation. Causes : Those of sprain in a more violent form ; a sud- den wrench or twist sufficient to tear the ligaments, and allow the bone to slip out of place. 170 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Symptoms: (1) The shape of the joint is changed. To ascertain this, the joint should be compared with that of the opposite side. (2) The limb is longer or shorter than that of the opposite side. (3) The relation of the limb to adjacent parts is changed. (4) Pain at the joint. (5) The patient cannot move the limb : this is an important factor in distinguishing a dislo- cated from a broken bone. Treatment: Send for a surgeon instantly. While await- ing his arrival, place the patient in as comfortable a position as possible, supporting the injured side by pillows and pads in its new attitude, and surround the joint with hot moist fomen- ^^ tations. In most varieties ID^j / \ \ of dislocation, although Jfeg'lQfe ^~j. delay in treatment is harm- ful, uneducated handling is still more so ; conse- quently they had better be left untouched. Where, however, the ser- vices of a surgeon cannot be obtained for several hours, an attempt may be made to correct dislocations of the fingers or toes, the lower jaw, and the shoulder. Dislocations 0} fingers can be reduced by strongly pulling on the linger, at the same time pushing the tip of the finger backward, if tjje end of the bone has slipped on to the back of its neighbor, or forward, if it has slipped on to the palmar face; and also pushing the dislocated em\ into its place. When returned to its proper place, the finger may be wound with a strip of sticking-plaster as wide as the finger is long. -■*«& ;Fig. 1 17. — Method of replacing a dislocated lower jaw. The upper diagram shows the relation of the bones in the dis- location. BONES OUT OF JOINT I/I Some dislocations of the finger are very difficult to reduce, and if suc- cess is not promptly attained by the method suggested here, the injury should not be irritated by further efforts. Dislocations of the thumb are very difficult to manage, and should be let alone. Dislocation of the lower jaw occurs as a consequence of extreme yawning or laughing, and is a most embarrassing accident to the victim, who remains with his mouth fixed widely open, with the saliva dripping from its corners, and deprived of the power of distinct speech. In this case, wind a handkerchief thickly about both your thumbs, padding them sufficiently to prevent injury by the sudden closing of the mouth when reduced. Place one thumb on to the lower jaw on each side as far back as possible, and grasp the jaw between it and the fingers with- out. Then press firmly downward and backward, when the jaw will be felt to move quickly into place. The thumbs should be drawn out from between the teeth with the greatest quickness, or they will be in danger of being crushed between the jaws when the muscles, tired by their enforced extension, rapidly and involuntarily contract. Once replaced, the jaw should be kept in position for a while by a handkerchief, bound about the point of the chin and the top of the head, or a four-tailed bandage would answer better still. * Fig. 118. — Method of replacing a dislocated shoulder, by the foot in the armpit. Dislocation of the Shoulder. — In this injury, in addition to the signs of -lislocation mentioned in the beginning of this chapter, the elbow usu illy projects from the side, and the upper arm appears to be slightly lengthened. The arm cannot be moved, and there is great pain in the joint. M. ke the patient lie down on a bed or couch, or on the ground — faring ;i better place. Roll a pad out of several handkerchiefs, or something else that will make a pad of about that size, and place it 172 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS in the armpit, to avoid injury, by your foot. Then seat yourself by his side, with your foot in a direction opposite to his ; remove the shoe from your foot nearest to him ; put your foot in his armpit ; grasp his dislocated arm in both your hands, and, pushing your foot in his armpit, pull strongly on the arm, at the same time swinging it toward his body. A snap will usually be felt, and the bone will be found to have returned to its place. If one or two attempts at reduction by this method fail, further efforts should be left to the surgeon, who should have been summoned in any case. After the dislocation is reduced, the arm should be bandaged firmly to the side for a day or two, in order to give the torn and bruised parts an opportunity to recover. CHAPTER XX BROKEN BONES Fracture. — Definition : A break in a bone. Varieties : 1 . Simple, when the bone is broken in a single place, and there is no opening to the surface of the body. 2. Comminuted, when the bone is broken into several pieces. A comminuted fracture may also be compound. 3. Compound, when, in addition to the break in the bone, there is an opening through the soft parts to the surface of the body. A compound fracture may also be comminuted. Causes : 1 . Direct violence, where some powerful force strikes upon the body at a certain point, breaking the bone there. 2. Indirect violence, where powerful forces strike upon the ends of a bone, causing it to break between them. Symptoms : 1 . A violent accident of some kind, involv- ing either a fall of the patient or of some heavy body upon him. 2. Pain at a fixed point — the place of the fracture. BROKEN BONES 1 73 3. A crack may have been felt or heard by the patient when the accident occurred. 4. The limb can be bent at that point, when it was immovable before. 5. The broken ends may be displaced by the action of the muscles, the ends having slipped past one an- other, in which case a limb would be shortened. 6. Upon gently feeling of the part, some irregularity of the bone will be felt at the painful point. 7. A crackling, called "crepitus" by surgeons, may be felt when the bone is firmly grasped above and below the painful point, and gently moved so as to cause the ends to rub upon one another. Treatment : 1. Simple Fracture, {a) If a surgeon can be gotten in a short time, place the patient in as comfortable a position as possible, supporting the in- jured part upon a pillow, or a similar pad made of clothing or other suitable material. (b) Where a physician cannot be obtained, and where it may be necessary to move the patient any distance, further treatment may be attempted. Apply splints or some stiff material, properly cushioned, in such a way as to prevent the fragments of bone moving upon one another. (V) If there is a prospect of several days elapsing before a physician's help can arrive, replace the frac- ture and dress it as specified hereafter in connection with individual fractures. 2. Compound Fracture. This is a most danger- ous injury, and needs the most thoughtful care. It is to be treated like a simple fracture, and, in addition, the wound is to receive the treatment proper for such an injury. By far the most common variety of broken bone is the simple frac- ture, in which there is no opening through the skin and other soft parts down to the break. It readily heals when properly treated, and is not in the least a dangerous accident. If, however, it is carelessly handled, and one of the broken ends is 174 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS pushed through the tissues to the external air, or an opening down to the break is made in any other way, it is transformed into a compound fracture, which, except under the most advanced surgical treatment, is an exceedingly dangerous injury, entailing prolonged illness, if not re- sulting in death. On the other hand, careless handling may not push the bone through the skin, but may cause it to cut across a large blood-vessel or an im- portant nerve, or in some way injure other tissues of importance, and in this way entail serious danger. Such an injury is called a complicated fracture. Since the bone may both push through the skin and produce these injuries, it is evident that a fracture may be both compound and complicated. It is hardly necessary to remark that the force causing the accident, and many other agents beside the bone, may render a fracture complicated. When a powerful force falls upon any portion of the body sufficiently strongly to crush a bone into several fragments, producing a commi- nuted fracture, the same force is very liable to injure the soft parts about it to such an extent as to render the fracture compound, and then we have a compound comminuted fracture. In some cases one end of the fractured bone is driven into the other, so that the fragments are wedged tightly together — this is an impacted fracture. The lack of an abnormal joint and of crackling in these cases makes their detection exceedingly difficult for the experienced surgeon, and entirely impossible for the amateur. A bone may be completely or partly broken. The former is a com- plete and the latter an incomplete fracture. The incomplete fracture is often called a green stick fracture, owing to its resemblance to a break in a green stick, where the tough, green fibres break with difficulty. This fracture is never found in the brittle bones of old people, but often occurs in young children, where, owing to the larger proportion of carti- lage or gristle, the bones are softer and tougher. If you strike your wrist violently with a hammer, you will break the bone at the point where you strike — this is fracture by direct violence. But if you fall from a distance upon the palms, you will break one of the bones between the hand and the shoulder; this is a fracture by indirect violence, the violence being applied at the shoulder and the hand, and the break being at a distance from both points. Cases sometimes occur where bones are broken by violent contrac- tions of the muscles. The knee cap is very subject to breaking by mus- cular action : its fracture, in the great majority of instances, being due to the violent contraction of the great extensor muscular mass of the thigh. I saw a soldier a short time ago who, while playing football, missed the ball with his foot in an attempt to kick it with great force : by this act his leg was thrown forward so violently as to break his thigh bone at its middle ; in other words, he kicked his leg in two by indirect violence. BROKEN BONES 175 The more important signs of fracture are the fact of an accident having occurred, pain at a certain fixed point, the ability to bend the limb or move the bone in an improper location, and the crackling felt or heard at the point of the injury. All these symptoms may not be present in every case, for abnormal motion is absent in an impacted fracture, and it may be impossible to get crackling or crepitus, since other tissues may have gotten between the broken ends so as to prevent their rubbing together. And it is evident that there can be no crepitus in a green stick fracture, since the broken ends are not free to be rubbed together. When a bone is broken, the blood-vessels of the bone itself and some of the surrounding soft tissues are broken, and a certain amount of bleeding occurs, followed by the formation of a blood clot between and around the broken ends. It takes about a week after the accident for this clot to be absorbed and carried off. During the second week a repair material called callus is thrown out about the broken points. It forms, in the case of long bones, a perfect sheath containing the two broken ends, and holding them in place ; where the broken bone is hollow, callus forms in the medullary canal, and forms an internal support, further uniting the bone. A certain amount of callus also lies between the broken ends of bone, and acts as a sort of cement in causing them to hold together. The callus develops into cartilage, and after four to eight weeks into bone. The cartilage ensheathing and lining the bone, after about a year, disappears, being absorbed into the system ; but that between the ends of the bone remains a permanent part of the bone, front which it is called permanent callus. The indication for treatment of broken bones is to bri?tg the frag- ments ifito proper position and keep them there. Any inflammation or other condition due to the injury is to be treated according to the needs of the particular case. The great majority of fractures occur in the limbs, and the general remarks upon the treatment of broken bones are applied to them. Fractures of the bones of the head and trunk are con- sidered only where treated individually. The injured point, if located in a part of the body covered by the clothing, should be uncovered and examined, due attention being given to the avoidance of pain to the patient by unnecessary movements in re- moving the clothing, and to the preservation of the clothing itself by unnecessary mutilation. Any limb may be neatly and satisfactorily exposed by carefully ripping up one of the seams in the garment cover- ing it. Moreover, when the splint is to be applied, the flaps of clothing folded assist in the formation of padding for it. The bringing the fragments of a broken bone into place, or " setting the bone," is called by surgeons " reducing the fracture." Where a fracture is complete, the ends of the bone are often drawn by the action of the muscles so that the ends overlap. To reduce a fracture, 176 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS then, it is necessary to pull the fragments in opposite directions until the ends can be placed end to end ; this is accomplished in case of a fracture of the arm bone, for example, by having one person, with his hands in the armpit, pulling in one direction, while another, holding the forearm and wrist, pulls in the opposite direction. When the fragments are drawn out far enough, the ends should be worked into their position end to end. It should not be forgotten that where the services of a physician can be secured within a few hours, and it is not necessary to move the patient, no attempts should be made to set the bone ; but that mean- while the fractured part should be pillowed in as comfortable a position as possible, and the patient kept perfectly quiet. Splints. — The fragments having been brought into the proper relation, the next object to secure is their retention in that position until nature can complete the healing process. This is accomplished by fixing the broken limb to some stiff material which will not permit movements of the broken pieces. Such applications are called splints. Four qualities are desirable in a splint : (1) It is absolutely necessary that the splint be composed of material sufficiently stiff to maintain the parts in position in spite of considerable tendency to displacement. (2) In order to properly support a broken limb, the splint must extend for some distance above and below the injury. And as the action of the muscles is liable to displace the fragments (Fig. 27), it is well to have the splints extend beyond the joints on either side of the injury, so that by making it impossible to bend the joints, movements of the muscles may be obviated. (3) It is de- sirable that the width of the splint should be as great and perhaps a trifle greater than the thickness of the injured limb. In temporary dressings, however, this is often im- possible, and narrow articles, such as scabbards, ramrods, and broom-handles may be utilized in emergencies. (4) The surface of the splint which is to come next to the patient should always be cushioned with some soft and more or less elastic material to obviate irritation from an unyielding surface. It is generally best to have two splints, one on either side of the limb, both held in place by the same bandage passed about them when in place. SPLINTS 177 In a hospital or in a surgeon's office may be found prepared splints, shaped to the limbs to which they are to be applied, and materials especially intended for the ready manufacture into splints. Among the latter are binder's board, felt, thin strips of wood glued to cloth, coarse wire cloth, and telegraph wire. Plaster-of-paris and similar bandages are used in the formation of permanent splints. But in ordinary emergencies the resources of the hospital and the surgeon's office are not available, and such materials as are at hand must be adapted to the purpose. It is difficult to conceive of a place where something from which to extem- porize a splint cannot be found. It has been remarked that splints must be cushioned with some soft material on the side coming in contact with the injured limb, for an unyielding surface might induce inflam- mation sufficient to greatly increase the trouble. Materials suitable for this padding may be found wherever splints are required. 1. In a Dwelling or its Vicinity. — Small splints may be cut out from cigar boxes, and from ordinary pasteboard boxes, although the latter are usually so thin that several thicknesses are required ; the binder's board, with which the covers of books are made, is excellent. Laths, shingles, and bits of wooden boxes of thin materials are good ; while flour or sugar barrel staves are unsurpassed. Broom or mop handles, fire tongs, pokers and shovels ; rulers from the desk ; and many other articles may be found for this purpose. The padding may be made from cotton, clean rags from the rag-bag, crumpled soft paper, crumpled soft muslin, linen, cheese cloth, or other fabrics. 2. In a Shop or Factory. — Tools and their handles, strips of leather belting, etc. Padding may be made from cotton waste, fine shavings, tow, oakum, and many other materials. 3. On a Public Street. — Splints may be extemporized from umbrellas and canes, parasols, folded fans, and policemen's batons. Padding may be made from bits of clothing, crumpled grass, cotton, and articles of that kind. 4. In the Country. — Splints may be found in branches, or sheets of bark from trees, bundles of rushes, straw or stiff grass, cornstalks, sugar- cane, and the like. Padding here may be gotten from the leaves, hay, grass, soft bits of clothing crumpled, and other soft and elastic substances. I78 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS 5. On the Battle-field. — Splints here are easily extemporized from weapons of various kinds, such as bayonets, knives, swords, and sabres and their scabbards, ramrods, rifles, picket pins, leather from saddles, and the like, while Munson has shown that the carbine boot is most excellently adapted to this purpose. Padding materials are found here in grass, hay, crumpled clothing, saddle cloths, blankets, tow from the limber-chest, etc. Splints may be held in place by triangular bandages in the broad or narrow cravat form, by roller bandages, which may be torn from sheets or shirts, and other articles of clothing. Pocket-handkerchiefs, napkins, towels, and scarfs make excel- lent substitutes ; while even garters, suspenders, tape, cord, and straps of various kinds may be utilized. In fixing a splint in place, care should be taken to avoid bending the limb so tightly as to interfere with the free circulation of the blood in the part, and the tips of the fingers or toes should always be left uncovered, so that they can easily be felt, to see if coldness or a purplish color indicates interference with the circulation. Great care is demanded in handling persons with broken bones, not only to inflict as little pain as possible upon the unfortunate victim, but to prevent further injury. The trans- formation of a simple into a complicated or compound frac- ture is an easy matter, but one fraught with evil consequences of the most dangerous description. Permanent disability — not to speak of death itself — has not infrequently resulted from the ignorant or officious treatment of broken bones. The lung has been injured bv a sharp fragment of a broken rib, an artery has been sawn off by the rough end of a frac- tured bone, and other important organs have been and are liable to be affected in the same way. In raising a fractured limb, it should be supported by a hand gently slipped under it, both above and below the injury, in such a way that there will be no tension on the break itself, and so that there is no bending at that point. If this be done with care, the limb may be moved with practically no pain. And the patient may be transferred to a litter or to a temporary resting-place, or splints may be applied without fur- ther displacement of the fragments. In applying splints, where possible the help of a second person should be utilized to support the limb while the dressings are being put in place. SLINGS FOR BROKEN BONES 179 Slings. — The slings made from the triangular and roller bandages should always be used when available. But some- times they are not at hand, and other - |p !!•• "" devices must be employed. The sleeve may be util- ized as a sling ; when it can be drawn on over the arm, it may simply be pinned to the breast of the coat ; where it has been necessary to slit the sleeve, it may be drawn around under the arm and pinned to the breast of the coat also as a sling (Fig. 119). The front flap of the skirt of a coat may be used as a sling by turning it up and pinning it to the coat, or by cutting a small slit in one corner and buttoning it on to one of the but- tons of the garment in front (Fig. 120). Two small handkerchiefs may be used for a sling. The first should be tied around the neck as loosely as possible, the knot being as near the opposite corners of the handkerchief as possi- ble ; the second should then be tied about the first in the same manner, and the forearm slipped through it. Patients should not be alone. — A man who fig. 120. — Coat flap turned has received even so slight an injury as a u^and utilized as a sling. fracture of the collar bone should not be left Fig. 119. — A slit sleeve utilized as a sling. l80 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS alone, and certainly should not be permitted to go either to the surgeon or home unassisted. If able to walk, he should be helped; and if in great suffering or unable to walk, he should be carried on a litter or in other ways, as described in the chapter on carrying the disabled. The reaction from an accident is liable to be accompanied by dizziness and faintness, even to unconsciousness, so that if alone, a fall may aggravate the injuries already received. The treatment required by fractures in various parts of the body differs in many respects, according to their location. The individual fractures, then, should be considered independently. Fracture of the Skull. — Causes : Either the skull cap or the floor of the skull may be affected. The former are due to falls, where the head strikes the ground, and to blows upon the head. The latter — fractures of the base of the skull — are caused by falls, striking upon the feet or upon the lower end of the spine in a sitting posture, or they are sometimes due to blows upon the vault of the skull itself. In some in- stances comparatively slight violence will cause very severe injuries. I have seen cases where the skulls of boys have been frightfully caved in by a blow from a base-ball club, carelessly thrown behind him by the batter. Symptoms : In a fracture of the skull cap there will be a large bruise, or more frequently an open wound, at the point struck. The bone will be movable or, if impacted, it will be depressed below the level of the skull. Fractures of the skull cap are almost always compound fractures. In a fracture of the floor of the skull there would usually be bleeding from the mouth, nose, and ears. The discharge of a clear, serous fluid — the cerebro-spinal fluid — from the ear is positive evidence of a fracture of the floor. The blood may settle in red patches under the eye. And in both cases there may be insensibility, with symp- toms of stunning and of compression of the brain. Treatment : Summon a surgeon immediately. Then carry the patient gently into a shady place, — a darkened room if possible. Lay him on his back, with his head and shoulders slightly raised, and keep him absolutely quiet. If there be an open wound in the head, it should be temporarily dressed with a wet antiseptic compress, as prescribed for the treatment BROKEN NOSE AND BROKEN JAW l8l of wounds. Any tendency to heat or fever should be com- bated by cloths wet with cold water or bags of chopped ice to the head. Fracture of the Nose. — Causes : A blow, a fall, or some crushing force, such as a wagon wheel running over the nose. The bones of the nose are prodigiously strong, and the vio- lence must be very great to cause the accident. Symptoms : The bridge of the nose is flattened down, or perhaps pushed to one side. The bones may be movable. Crackling or crepitus may be felt. The parts about the break soon display the signs of a bruise. The nose bleeds freely. The cartilage of the nose is fixed very firmly, so that it is rarely broken loose, although such accidents may occur. Treatment : Treat bleeding by injecting hot water and plugging the nostril, as described in connection with nose- bleed. Treat the bruise by moist fomentations, or a wound as directed for such injuries. Fracture of the Lower Jaw. — Causes : The lower jaw may be broken by a kick from a horse or a man, by a blow with the fist, a club, or a bottle ; by a heavy fall, striking on the chin, or by any similar accident producing direct violence. Symptoms : The patient often feels the bone give way at the time of the accident ; finds that he has not the power of moving it, and tries to support it with his hand. The gums are torn and bleeding, and the line of t The broken fragments can be felt both in the mouth and from without, and crackling or crepitus can be felt on moving them. This fracture is often compound, opening into the mouth. Treatment : 1st method. With the hand, gently push the bones into place, Fig. 121.— Treatment of and apply a broad cravat under the chin fracture of the lower 11 J ■, .1 1 jaw with two triangu- and over the head ; then apply a narrow lar handkerchiefs. cravat in front of the chin, tying the ends behind the neck, and passing them under the first cravat on either side. The cravats may be made from triangular band- ages or from ordinary pocket-handkerchiefs. l82 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS 2d method. Make a four-tailed bandage (page 101) from a piece of muslin, of sufficient length to pass under the chin and over the head, or by cutting a pocket-handkerchief diago- nally, leaving uncut a space about two inches long in the middle, and apply this like a four-tailed bandage. Fracture of the Collar Bone. — Caicses : A fall upon the outstretched arm or upon the elbow. A fall upon the shoul- der. A blow or a fall upon the bone itself. The most com- mon of fractures. Symptoms : The shoulder drops downward and inward. There is loss of power in the arm, and the patient generally leans his head toward the injured side, and supports the elbow with the hand of his sound side. On running the finger along the collar bone, an irregularity can be felt, due to the projec- tion of the outer fragment, the inner being pressed inward. Keeping one hand upon this point, and with the other raising the affected arm, abnormal motion is felt, and the irregularity is to a considerable extent removed ; crackling or crepitus may also be felt. Treatment : Remembering that the function of the collar bone is to hold the shoulder upward, backward, and outward, it is evident that the treatment needed to correct the deformity is to apply such apparatus as will accomplish the same end. (i) Make a good-sized pad, two or, better, three inches in thickness, and (2) thrust it high up into the arm- pit, (3) at the same time pushing the elbow as high up as possible, while Fig. 122.— Treatment of frac- , . , & , , • , tureofthe collar bone. keeping the arm as close to the side as the pad will permit. (4) Where triangular bandages are available, put on a large arm sling, so as to hold the arm high up in this attitude. (5) With a broad cravat, a scarf, a couple of handkerchiefs folded diagonally and tied end to end, or a roller bandage torn from some con- venient material, bind the arm to the side. The pad for the armpit can with advantage be made wedge-shaped, three inches thick at its upper end and tapering to nothing below. BROKEN SHOULDER BLADE AND BROKEN ARM 1 83 Fracture of the Shoulder Blade. — Causes : The fall of some heavy body directly upon the bone, by some crushing accident, by the kick of a horse, by a fall upon the back, and similar instances of direct violence. This bone is very rarely broken. Symptoms : Inability to move the arm freely without pain. Great pain at the injured bone. Unusual irregularities in the bone. Movability of the fragments. Crackling or crepitus on moving them together. Swelling and other symptoms of a bruise at the point of injury. Treatment : Apply a large arm sling, if a triangular bandage is available, or otherwise a substitute for it. Then bandage the arm to the side with a broad cravat or other bandage, as in fracture of the collar bone — the treatment being practi- cally the same, with the omission of the pad in the armpit. The bruises on the back should be treated with cloths wet with cold water, and other applications, like bruises else- where, until the arrival of the medical man. Fracture of the Arm. — Causes : A fall upon the arm or elbow. Direct violence, such as a laden wagon rolling across the limb. It may in rare cases be caused by violent contrac- tion of the muscles. Symptoms : The arm is helpless, and there is more or less change in its shape, shortening — if the fragments override one another — and art unnatural bending at the broken point, even where there is little shortening. The arm can be bent at an unnatural point, and at the same point — the site of the break — crackling or crepitus can be obtained. Fracture lying near the upper end of the bone is often very difficult to recognize. Treatment : An attempt may be made to set the bone, one person steadying the shoulder by grasping with both hands in the armpit, while another pulls strongly upon the arm from below, and a third gently pushes the bones together with his Fig. 123. — Treatment of fracture of the arm. 184 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS hands over the break. If the first attempt is unsuccessful, a second should not be made, but all future efforts should be left to a surgeon. Then (a) place a pad composed of a folded towel or handkerchief in the armpit, (d) Make two or more splints out of such materials as may be available — laths, book covers, picket pins, etc. ; (V) carefully pad them, and (d) apply them about the arm, taking care not to draw the bandages or handkerchiefs too tightly, and yet tightly enough to hold the parts in place. The splints which are to be applied to the outer face of the arm may well extend to the top of the shoulder above and to the tip of the elbow below ; while those that are on the inner side of the arm should be shorter. The object of the pad in the armpit is to avoid com- pression of the axillary nerves and blood-vessels by the inner splint. The forearm should then be well supported by a sling ; but in this fracture, unlike that of the collar bone, care must be taken not to push the elbow up, as it would tend to displace the bone. The small arm sling about the wrist should be used alone. Fracture at the Elbow. — Causes : A fall, striking upon the elbow. A blow upon the elbow. Symptoms : The patient cannot bend his elbow. Pain is felt at the joint, accompanied, after a while, by swelling and heat. Crackling or crepitus may be felt on bending the joint. Treatment : Take two straight splints, extemporized from any available source, and bind them together in the form of a r right angle. Thoroughly pad the splint FiS ' l24 's~int n angUlar thus formed ? and > a PP¥ n g k to the inner face of the arm and forearm with the thumb up, bind it securely in place. Support it in a broad sling, if available ; in others, if not. Fracture of the Forearm. — Causes : A fall or a blow. Symptoms : One or both bones may be broken. (1) If both bones be broken, the usual symptoms — pain, an un- natural joint, and crackling or crepitus — will show the character of the injury very clearly. BROKEN FOREARM AND BROKEN WRIST 1 85 (2) If only one bone be broken, the indications are not so evident. The finger should then be run along each bone to see if there is any unnatural motion or unusual projection ; if an inequality is discovered, it is easy to determine whether the bone is broken at the point or not, by turning the hand around, when crackling or crepitus will be felt if there is a fracture there. Treatment : Get or make two splints as long, if possible, as from the elbow to the tips of the fingers, and pad them well. Bending the elbow to a little more than a right angle, place the forearm with the thumb up. Then apply the two splints, one to the back and one to the face of the forearm, and secure them firmly with whatever means may be at hand. Support the forearm in the large arm sling, with the hand raised a little higher than the elbow. Fracture at the Wrist. — It should be noted that this is not a fracture of the wrist proper, but of the lower end of one of the bones of the forearm — the radius. It has been called Colles 1 fracture, Barton's fracture, Pilcher's fracture, etc., from sur- geons who have particularly in- vestigated it. This is, next to fracture of the collar bone, the most frequent in the body. Causes : The cause is invariably Fig 125 - The deformity in J fracture at the wrist. forcibly pressing the open hand backward, as in a fall, when the hands are outstretched to break the fall, or in attempting to push some heavy mass. Symptoms : Pain at the point of the break. A deformity at the back of the wrist (Fig. 125), called the silver-fork deformity, from its resemblance to the back of a silver fork. On turning the hand about, crackling or crepitus may be felt, and the fragment may be seen to be movable, although they are more often firmly fixed, and the deformity is the chief symptom. Treatment : If a surgeon can be gotten within a day, simply apply a small well-padded splint until his arrival. If some time must elapse, set the bones by forcibly bending the hand 1 86 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS backward and at the same time pushing the lower fragment forward. A surgeon would bind a broad strip of adhesive plaster about the wrist, which would be sufficient in the vast majority of cases to retain the fragments in place. But in an emergency, a small well-padded splint should be applied, ex- tending from the fingers well up the forearm on the palmar face. Apply whatever sling may be convenient. Fracture in the Hand. — Causes : Direct violence, in the form of a blow or a fall. The hand may be broken in games of various kinds and in fighting. Symptoms: When one of the bones of the metacarpus forming the hand is broken, pain will be felt at the point, the fragments of the bone will be found to be movable, crack- ling or crepitus will be felt, and the knuckle with which the bone terminates will usually be sunken. Treatment : Cut out a small splint from a cigar box, a bit of pasteboard, or something of the kind, having it long enough to extend from the tip of the fingers a little way up the fore- arm. Pad the splint well and apply it to the palm, taking care to have a thick wad of padding in the palm itself. Bind this splint in place, and put the arm in a sling with the hand rather higher than the elbow. Fracture of the Fingers. — Causes: A blow or a fall — direct violence. An injury to which ball-players are very subject. Symptoms : Pain, an irregularity at the broken point, pos- sible motion there, crackling or crepitus, and swelling. Treatment : The fracture in this case can easily be set. After this apply a small well-padded splint of cardboard, cigar box, or even a twig from a tree, extending from the tip of the finger up to the wrist ; bind it firmly in place, and sup- port it in a small sling. Fracture of the Spine. — Causes : They may be indirect, from a fall upon the head, feet, or buttocks ; or direct, either from the body falling across some projection or from some heavy article falling upon the body. These injuries are more frequent in railroad accidents and in mines and factories. Symptoms : Paralysis of all that portion of the body below BROKEN SPINE AND BROKEN RIBS 1 87 the injury, due to compression of the spinal cord by the broken bone. Deformity may be felt upon gently running the tips of the fingers along the spine. But no attempt should be made to obtain motion, or crackling or crepitus, on account of the danger of still further injuring the delicate structures within the spinal canal. Treatment : On account of the danger of increasing the injury, the treatment should be confined to placing the patient in as comfortable a position as possible, using the utmost pre- caution in moving him, to prevent injury. Apply hot dry fomentations to the body if cold, and send for a surgeon. Fracture of the Ribs. — Causes : A blow or a fall upon the chest. Squeezing in a crowd has been known to break ribs, while in still other cases violent muscular action in coughing has produced a fracture. The fifth to the tenth ribs are the more frequently broken, while the eleventh or twelfth, the " floating ribs," are rarely injured. Symptoms : The patient complains of a stitch at some point in the side, and his breathing is catching and in short breaths. Passing the finger over the painful spot, crackling- or crepitus can usually be obtained, either by making the patient cough or by pressing with the thumbs alternately on either side of the break. In case the lung is torn by the sharp points of broken bone, which is frequently the case, there will be spitting of bright frothy blood. In many cases the symptoms are very obscure, and it cannot be decided whether there is a fracture or simply a bad bruise. In this case, the injury should be treated like a fracture. Treatment : In ordinary fractures, it is considered that the bones must be kept absolutely quiet in order to heal properly. But in case of the ribs, this cannot be done without stopping the breathing, which will be impossible. However, the indi- cation is to limit the breathing as much as possible, and this may be done by the application about the chest of two broad cravats of the triangular bandage. A broad flannel roller bandage carried firmly about the chest several times so as to cover it, is better still ; while strips of adhesive plaster long enough to extend half-way around the body, and passed from 1 88 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS the spine to the breast bone, one overlapping the other, are better yet. The patient should be moved as little and as gently as possible, his chest and head being well elevated to prevent interference with his breathing. Fracture of the Pelvis. — Causes : Great and direct vio- lence, such as is incurred by the wheels of a heavily laden wagon passing over the hips, being squeezed between two railway cars, or being crushed by the fall of an enormously heavy weight. Symptoms : There is a sense of falling apart, the patient cannot stand, and an attempt to rise produces great pain. Crackling or crepitus is sometimes felt. And a most im- portant symptom is the fact of a tremendous crushing force having been exerted on the pelvis. Serious injuries to the bowels and bladder are apt to complicate this injury. Treatment : Summon a surgeon instantly. Place the pa- tient in a lying-down position, and pass a bandage about his pelvis. Handle him with the greatest care, and place him where he can have as nearly absolute quiet as possible. Fracture of the Thigh. — Causes : Direct violence either through a fall of the patient or through a fall of a heavy weight upon his thigh. Indirect violence, through a jump from a height or a fall of heavy matter upon his body. Symptoms : Differing somewhat, according to the location, the toes and foot are turned outward. There is pain at a fixed point. There is loss of power in the limb, which at the same time is shortened by the immense muscles of the thigh strongly drawing the lower fragment up with the leg. This is well shown in Fig. 27, page 32. The limb bends at an unnatural point, and crackling or crepitus may be obtained. Treatment : This injury is one in which much depends upon the treatment. With proper care, it will progress to a perfect recovery ; and on the other hand, with improper man- agement, permanent lameness and even death itself may result. Much depends upon the gentleness and skill with which the limb is touched. In so large an injury it is easy, by injudicious or hasty movements, to convert a simple frac- ture into a complicated one, by allowing the sharp points of BROKEN THIGH I 89 the broken bone to thrust themselves through the tissues, or to pierce a blood-vessel, — accidents which may make it necessary to remove the limb. In all manipulations, then, employ the utmost gentleness. First, summon a surgeon without delay. Then, place the patient in as comfortable a position as possible, preferably on his back, slightly inclined to the injured side, and with his head and shoulders some- what raised. Then look about for material from which to extemporize a splint. On the battle-field, a rifle may be used. A F(g l26 ._ Broom . handle used as a 8plint board from a board fence for broken thigh. will do well. Two billiard cues or a broom-handle will answer the indications excel- lently. These should be padded with clothing, blankets, leaves, grass, hay, or whatever may be available, and laid along the outer side of the injured limb. The limb should now be drawn out straight to its full length, and the splint bandaged to it by a bandage just above and below the break, with another about the waist and about the knee and the ankle. This done, additional support should be given the limb by bandaging it to the other limb. If a surgeon cannot be gotten within a day, more perma- nent treatment may be applied. Place the patient on a bed, with the foot raised five or six inches higher than the head. Then put a stocking and shoe on the foot of the affected limb, first having slit the shoe in the instep a quarter of an inch above the sole on either side, and passed a strap of leather or cloth through it. Fill a pail or bag with ten or twelve bags, six by three inches in size, filled with sand or earth ; having fastened the strap through the shoe to one end of a cord and the pail to the other, pass it over the foot of the bed in such a way that the pail will not touch the floor, but hang suspended and constantly drawing upon the foot. In this way the muscles drawing the leg up will soon be tired, and the ends of the bone will gradually be drawn into place 190 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS and retained there. In a less primitive fashion this is the treatment now given a fracture of the thigh by modern surgeons. Fracture of the Knee-Cap. — Causes : A blow or fall upon the knee ; great and sudden muscular exertion, such as is caused by efforts to regain one's equi- librium on standing or slipping. •Sy?nfttoms : Inability to move the limb or bend the knee. The limb is not shortened, and, upon feeling of the knee, one part of the bone will be felt pulled up by the thigh muscles, while another is left in place attached to the ligament, and there is a marked depression between them. Treatment : Keep the leg straight, guarding against bend- ing it, which would have a tendency to further separate the fragments. Place a splint of some kind — long enough if possible to run the entire length of the limb — on the lower extremity, bind it firmly at the ankle and the thigh, and Fig. 127. — Separation of the fragments of a broken knee-cap. Fig. 128. — Splint and figure-of-eight bandage for broken knee-cap. include it and the knee in a figure-of-eight bandage, which would tend to draw the fragments together. Fracture of the Leg. — Causes : Direct violence : heavy bodies falling on the leg, kicks from horses, and the like. Indirect violence : heavy falls, jumps, and turns of the leg. BROKEN LEG AND BROKEN FOOT I 9 I If l ' Fig. 129. — Bundles of straw or rushes as splints for broken leg. Symptoms : Pain at a fixed point, swelling and an alteration in the contour of the leg. On running the finger along the bone, a point of unnatural motion will be found, and at this point crackling or crepitus may be obtained. Where both bones are broken, the injury is easily detected, but where but one is affected, there is more difficulty, since the other bone forms a splint maintaining the limb in position. Treatment : Lay the patient comfortably upon his back, and having provided two splints from whatever material is avail- able, pad them well, and apply them to either side of the leg. The splints would preferably be a little longer than from the knee to the sole of the foot. On the battle-field, they could be extempo- rized from bayonets and other weapons ; on the street, from canes and umbrellas ; and in a house, from a host of materials. The padding may be made from clothing, bedding, hay, straw, and other materials used for the purpose. In civil life, a pillow can always be ob- tained, and if the leg is laid in it and splints applied on either side, we have a most satisfactory temporary dress- ing. Additional security will be contributed by tying the Fig. 130. — Splint extemporized from bayonets. Fig. 131. — Pillow for fracture of the leg. Fracture of the Foot. — Causes : Direct violence, such as is inflicted by a horse stepping on the foot, or by a wagon running over it. 192 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Symptoms : Pain, swelling, and other symptoms of a bruise, an alteration in the shape of the foot, motion at an unnatural point, crackling or crepitus. These fractures are often compound. Treatment : Uncover the foot and place it in a good po- sition. Dress a wound, if it be present. Apply wet cloths to the bruised spot. Support the foot by an angular splint (Fig. 124), which may be improvised by a short and a long splint tied together, and applied with an abundance of pad- ding to the side of the foot and leg. A surgeon should be consulted. CHAPTER XXI FOREIGN BODIES Foreign Body in the Eye. — Character : Cinders from a railway locomotive.; grains of sand and similar bodies blown about by the wind ; bits of metal and grains of gunpowder. Symptoms : Feeling the body in the eye. A copious flow of tears. Sometimes the body can be seen em- bedded in the cornea or conjunctiva. Treatment : Close the eye for a few moments and allow the tears to accumulate ; upon opening it, the body may be washed out by them. Never rub the eye. If the body lies under the lower lid, make the patient look up, and at the same time press down upon the lid ; the inner _surface of the lid will be exposed, and the foreign body may be brushed off with the corner of a handkerchief. If the body lies under the upper lid, (1) grasp the lashes of the upper lid and pull it down over the lower, which should at the same time, with the other hand, be pushed up under the upper. Upon repeating this two or three times, the foreign body will often be brushed out on the lower lid. (2) If this fail, the FOREIGN BODY IN THE EYE AND EAR I93 upper lid should be turned up : make the patient shut his eye and look down ; then with a pencil or some similar article press gently upon the lid at about its middle, and, grasping the lashes with the other hand, turn the lid up over on the pencil, when its inner sur- face will be seen, and the foreign body may readily be brushed off. If the body is firmly embedded in the surface of the eye, a careful attempt may be made to lift it out with the point of a needle. If not at once successful, this should not be persisted in, as the sight may be injured by injudicious efforts. After the removal of a foreign body from the eye, a sensation as if of its presence often remains. People not infrequently complain of a foreign body when it has already been removed by natural means. Sometimes the body has excited a little irritation, which feels like a foreign body. If this sensation remains over night, the eye needs attention, and a surgeon should be consulted ; for it should have passed away if no irritating body is present. After the removal of an irritating foreign body from the eye, some bland fluid should be poured into it. Milk, thin mucilage of gum arabic, sweet oil, or salad oil are excellent for this purpose. Foreign Body in the Ear. — Character : Usually insects in adults, although other articles may find their way thither. Children may insert various small articles, including grains of corn, beans, buttons, and the like. Symptoms : The foreign body, particularly if a living insect, may be felt by the patient. In most cases, however, it is not felt. It may be seen in the ear on examination. It may have been seen to be inserted. Treatment : In case of a living insect, (a) hold a bright light to the ear. The fascination which a light has for insects will often cause them to leave the ear to go to the light. If this fails, (b) syringe the ear with warm salt and water, or (c) pour in warm oil from a teaspoon, and the intruder will generally be driven out. If the body be vegetable, or any substance liable to swell, do not syringe the ear, for the fluid will cause it 194 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS to swell, and soften and render it much more difficult to extract. In a case of this kind, where a bean, a grain of corn, etc., has gotten into the ear, the body may be jerked out by bending the head to the affected side and jumping repeatedly. If the body is not liable to swell, syringing with tepid water will often wash it out. If these methods fail, consult a medical man. The presence of a foreign body in the ear will do no imme- diate harm, and it is quite possible to wait several days, if a surgeon cannot be gotten before. It will be remembered that at the bottom of the external auditory meatus, about an inch from the opening, lies the tympanic membrane, a very delicate structure, which is essential to hearing. Very slight pressure is sufficient to break this delicate organ ; consequently the insertion of button-hooks, hairpins, etc., into the ear in order to extract foreign bodies should never be attempted. I have known the tympanic membrane to be perforated and one of the small bones of the ear to be pulled out in an ignorant attempt to extract a foreign body, which a surgeon could have removed without the slightest difficulty. The tech- nical knowledge of the surgeon is required here, and he will use instru- ments constructed for the express purpose of clearing the ear. Foreign Body in the Nose. — Character : Usually small articles introduced by children, either into their own nostrils or that of their playmates. Symptoms : The irritation of the presence of the body in the nostril. The obstruction to breathing. The sight of the body. The knowledge of its introduction. Treatment : Close the clear side of the nose by pressure with a finger, and make the patient blow the nose hard. This will usually dislodge the object. If this fails, induce sneezing either by tickling the nose with a feather or something of the kind, or by administering snuff. The nasal douche, where a syringe or a long rubber tube suitable for a siphon is available, may be used in case the body is not liable to swell, injecting luke- warm water into the clear nostril with the expectation that it will push the body out of the other. FOREIGN BODY IN THE NOSE AND THROAT I95 If these fail, and the body can be seen clearly, an effort may be made to fish it out by passing a piece of wire, bent into a little hook, back into the nostril close to the wall, and catching the body with it. A hairpin may be bent straight and the hook formed at one end. Do not continue these manoeuvres very long nor let them be rough in the slightest degree. All simple efforts having failed, send for a physician. There is no danger in leaving the foreign body in place for some days if it is impossible to consult a physician in less time. Foreign Body in the Throat. Choking. — Character : Masses of food, bones, false teeth, etc., in adults. Coins, buttons, marbles, etc., in children. Symptoms : Sudden difficulty in breathing, a distressing cough, retching, the face assuming a purplish hue, the eyes starting from their sockets, clutching at the throat, unconsciousness . It is often difficult to tell where the foreign body lies. When it is possible for the patient to swallow, it is safe to presume that the body lies in the larynx or windpipe. When the foreign body lies in the gullet, there is little or no cough, although swallowing is impossible. When the foreign body lies in the pharynx, there is both coughing and inability to swallow. Treatment : The common practice of slapping the back often helps the act of coughing to dislodge choking bodies in the pharynx or windpipe. When this does not succeed, the patient's mouth may be opened and two fingers passed back into the throat to grasp the object. If the effort to grasp the foreign body is not successful, the act will produce vomiting, which may expel it. A wire, such as a hairpin, may be bent into a loop and passed into the pharynx to catch the foreign body and draw it out. The utmost precautions must be taken neither to harm the throat nor to lose the loop I96 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS In children, and even in adults, the expulsion of the body may be facilitated by lifting a patient up by the heels and slapping his back in this position. Summon a physician promptly, taki?ig care to send him information as to the character of the accident, so that he may bring with him the instruments needed for removing the obstruction. Where there is no serious interference with the breathing, any action should be relegated to the surgeon. For, as a matter of fact, there may really be nothing in the throat, the impression of some body already swallowed remaining there. This often occurs in swallowing pills, a sensation as if the pill were in the throat not unfrequently continuing for a considerable time after it has passed into the stomach. It may be impossible by any means to remove foreign bodies from the gullet or windpipe. A surgeon will, however, remove them from the latter, opening into it in the neck by a comparatively slight opera- tion. If they are caught in the gullet, particularly if it be well down in the chest, a most serious operation may be demanded, requiring cutting into the stomach and reaching it from below. When a foreign body, particularly one with sharp or rough edges, has been swallowed, do not give an emetic, for it will only increase any possible trouble. Make the patient eat freely of soft bread, potatoes, and similar starchy articles of diet, that they may surround the body with a mass of waste matter, cover its sharp edges and carry it safely through the bowels. Coins, nails, fragments of bone and the like may be carried through the bowels in this way with perfect safety. CHAPTER XXII FAINTING Unconsciousness in General. — Sudden loss of conscious- ness is an accident frequently productive of the greatest alarm among bystanders, and deservedly so, for it is often the pre- liminary to a fatal illness. A very large majority of such cases are not dangerous, however, and they generally possess sufficiently marked characteristics to make it possible to dis- tinguish them readily. UNCONSCIOUSNESS IN GENERAL I97 The cause of the insensibility often throws light upon the character of the trouble. If the patient has suffered a fall, striking upon his head, a depressed fracture would be proof positive of compression of the brain, while a similar fall, with- out any fracture and striking either upon the head or feet would indicate stunning. Fright, fatigue, loss of blood, and similar weakening occurrences would tend to produce faint- ing. Drinking freely of intoxicating liquors would cause drunkenness, while an irresistible tendency to sleep, after partaking of any suspicious medicine, would look like opium or chloral poisoning. Convulsions would suggest epileptic fits, hysteria, or kidney disease. A sudden insensibility in a person of advanced age after unusual physical or mental exertion would indicate apoplexy. Great weakness and de- pression, with or without unconsciousness, and following an accident or a sudden mental emotion, would suggest shock, while sudden loss of sensibility following exposure to long- continued heat would cause one to suspect sunstroke. If, however, the cause of the injury be unknown and the patient be found in a state of unconsciousness, the diagnosis must rest upon other points. And in this case a systematic examination should be made, beginning with the head. Com- pression would be indicated by a depressed wound, while a simple bruise would look more like stunning. The eyes should be examined to see if they are sensitive to the touch, and if so, brain injuries could be eliminated ; contraction of the pupils is a sign of opium poisoning, while unequal con- traction of the two pupils is a characteristic of affections of the brain. A glance at the face might discover that it is drawn to one side, in which case one-sided paralysis would be indicated, and pressure upon the brain either through a depressed iniury, or apoplexy would be suspected. A bloated and flushed face is a sign of a hard drinker. The odor of liquor or opium on the breath would be a sign of drunkenness or poisoning, while froth at the mouth and a bite of the tongue or lip would be present in cases of epileptic and other fits. The breathing is slowed in great weakness, I98 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS as in shock, and snoring in brain trouble, although it may be present in intoxication and poisoning by anodynes. A very slow pulse is found in brain troubles ; a very rapid pulse in sunstroke and other affections characterized by high fever, while a quick, thready pulse exists in great weakness, such as is present in shock. Abnormal coldness of the skin is to be expected in freezing, while it is always found in intoxication and in col- lapse from cholera, etc. Great heat of the skin, on the contrary, is found in sunstroke and diseases accompanied by high fever. Convulsions are present in epileptic fits, certain kidney troubles, hysterics, and in the indigestion and teething of children. Other points of distinction may be learned by a careful study of the symptoms attending the individual affections. Fainting. — Definition : A loss of consciousness due to a diminution in the circulation of the blood in the brain from a temporary weakening or stopping of the heart's action. Swooning. Syncope. Symptoms : Sudden paleness of face and whiteness of lips. Cold sweat on the brow. Pulse greatly weak- ened. Breathing quickened. Muscular power weak- ened, causing patient to stagger and fall. Treatment : Do not attempt to support the patient either in a standing or sitting posture. Lay him flat on his back with his head lower, if anything, than his feet. Let him have plenty of fresh air. Loosen tight clothing, such as collars and belts. Sprinkle the face with cold water. Apply smelling-salts to the nose if available. A glass of wine, or a cup of coffee, when consciousness has begun to return, will assist to give the patient strength. Fainting is the variety of insensibility most frequently seen, and occurs in a number of conditions, in all of which, however, weakness of the heart's action is present. Hunger and indigestion, pain and fright, heat and fatigue, tight lacing, and bleeding may all cause it. The close warm atmosphere of crowds is especially apt to induce it in FAINTING AND SHOCK 1 99 the weak, and the fainting of one or more persons is an almost constant feature of large assemblages. Mental emotions acting upon the heart often produce fainting; bad news, and even good news suddenly re- ceived, often throws delicate people into a swoon. Among soldiers, aside from bleeding, fatigue is the most frequem cause of fainting. It is a common occurrence on a long or forced march for men, especially recruits, to fall out of ranks and into a faint by the road. Where the man has suffered greatly from heat, the con- dition is apt to be much more serious, heat-exhaustion being added to fatigue-faintness and demanding special treatment. The loss of consciousness is usually of very brief duration, although it may in exaggerated cases extend over several hours. The growing strength of the pulse, flushing of the cheeks and lips, and warmth of the fingers, indicate approaching recovery, followed by opening of the eyes and speech. The main indication for treatment is to restore the blood to the brain. This will be assisted mechanically by laying the patient down with his feet higher than his head. If he be seated in a chair, or if he fall into one, nothing can be better than to tip him directly back in the chair; his feet will then be kept higher than his head without difficulty. If bleeding be the cause of the accident, it is hardly necessary to re- mark that checking the flow of blood is the first thing to be done. Warmth should then be applied to the extremities and warm drinks administered. When a person faints in an assembly where the seats are placed closely together, it maybe convenient in some cases to cause the patient to lean forward with his head between his knees for a few moments, when he may have regained consciousness sufficiently to walk out of the room. When the patient does not become conscious in a few minutes, a physician should be summoned without delay. Meanwhile, heat should be applied to the pit of the stomach, and diluted whiskey or brandy may be injected into the lower bowel — a tablespoonful of either, di- luted with five or six times its bulk of warm water or milk. And if the heart is very weak and the breathing seems likely to cease, artificial breathing, as described in connection with Smothering, should be tried. Shock. — Definition : A state of great nervous depression induced by severe injuries. Collapse. Symptoms : Following an accident, a surgical operation, or a mental emotion such as grief or fright, the face becomes pale and pinched and assumes an anxious, frightened expression. 200 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS The patient is weak and faint, depressed and chilly. The skin is cold and suffused with cold sweat, espe- cially abundant on the forehead. The pulse may be absent, and if present is weak, rapid, and irregular, while the breathing is sighing and irregular. The eyes are dull and sunken, the pupils dilated and generally turned upward, while the finger-nails are of a bluish hue. The condition is greatly like dying, and differs from fainting in the fact that the patient is not necessarily unconscious. These symptoms are lessened in light cases and exaggerated in severe ones. Treatme7it : Lay the patient at full length on his back, with his head low. Loosen all tight clothing, — collars, belts, etc. If there is bleeding or other causative conditions, control them. Dress wounds and bind up broken bones. Rub the limbs and body, where uninjured, with flannel or similar substances, to restore the circu- lation. Treat the coldness by hot, dry fomentations applied along his body and his extremities. A hot plate wrapped in a towel may be applied over his stomach, and bottles of hot water, hot flatirons, stones or bricks, may be applied to other parts. Hot and stimulating drinks should be given him, under proper limitations. Hot coffee is always good. If there is no bleeding, whiskey or brandy in hot water or milk may be given, a couple of teaspoonfuls at a time. If the patient is so depressed that he cannot swallow, whiskey or brandy may be injected into the lower bowel, a tablespoonful in five or six times its bulk of warm water or milk. These doses may be repeated three or four times an hour until the patient is better. SHOCK AND STUNNING 201 In shock, as in fainting, the brain is deprived of its proper supply of blood — indeed, it is held that shock is simply another form of fainting, differing simply in being the result of mechanical injury. The severity of shock varies greatly according to the person. A woman usually suffers less from shock than a man, although the weak, nervous, and timid suffer more than the strong, calm, and bold. The temperament of the injured person is almost as important a factor in determining the amount of shock as the severity of the accident itself. A plucky, determined man will endure a comparatively severe accident with less nervous depression than a flabby nervous individual. The mind has considerable control over shock. Not a few instances are on record where men have endured severe surgical operations, and through their mental equipoise banished shock entirely. The instinct of self-preservation may also prevent or delay shock. Sir Charles Bell tells of a sergeant of the King's German Legion at Waterloo, who, after his arm had been torn off by a cannon-ball, close to his shoulder, with- out any dressing whatever, galloped fifteen miles to Brussels ; but immediately upon arriving at the hospital he succumbed to shock and remained unconscious for a long time. The shock may be so slight as to need no treatment, a natural and slight reaction setting in immediately. In the more severe cases the reaction is longer in coming and greater in amount. It appears with a quickening of the pulse and flushing of the cheeks, with brightening of the eyes and dryness and heat of the skin, — the characteristics of fever, — and should be treated during the time which it lasts in the same way as fever of any kind. In other cases, and these the more fortunate, the heart simply regains its normal strength, the body returns to its ordinary warmth, and the mind resumes its wonted vigor — the system simply returns to the natural condition. A patient may suffer so severely from shock that reaction will not follow at all, in which case the symptoms will become more pronounced and gradually terminate in death. On the other hand, the reaction may be so violent as to produce congestive troubles, particularly of the "Drain, such as to render survival doubtful. Stunning. — Definition : A condition of the mind, extend- ing from bewilderment to insensibility, due to shaking of the brain by sudden violence. Concussion of the brain. Causes : Blows or falls upon the head. Falls upon the feet, or the lower end of the spine as in jumping — in all cases the violence being transmitted to the brain either through the skull or spine. 202 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Symptoms,: (i) Slight stunning : — After a blow or a fall the patient is confused, bewildered, and giddy for a few moments, with the pulse possibly a little weak, the breathing slow, and the face pale. (2) Moderate stunning : — After a blow or a fall, the patient lies insensible and immovable. His skin feels cold, his pulse weak and irregular, his eyes closed, and on examination his pupils are found to be con- tracted. May be aroused, but is peevish and falls back again into unconsciousness. After a time he becomes uneasy and tosses about, which is prelimi- nary to recovery : if vomiting occurs, it is a sign of recovery. (3) Severe stunning: — In this case the brain substance is usually torn and the symptoms are in- tensified. The patient cannot be aroused at all, the pulse is very weak and irregular, the skin is cold and clammy, and the patient is in a condition of marked shock, with a liability to excessive reaction. Death often occurs, and recovery is very slow, and liable to be complicated with acute congestion of the brain. Treatment: (1) Slight stunning: — Rest, lying down with perhaps a cloth, wet with cold water, to the brow is all that is needed for slight cases. (2) Moderate stunning : — Rest, lying down, the head somewhat raised, and perfect quiet maintained in order to enable the patient to sleep. Warmth should be applied to his extremities and body in hot water bottles, etc., as in shock. The head, on the contrary, should be kept cool by cloths wet with cold water, bags of chopped ice, etc. Stimulating drinks should not be given. (3) Severe stunning : — In this case the treat- ment should be the same as that for moderate stun- ning, particular attention being given to keeping the head cool, on account of the liability to excessive reaction followed by inflammation of the brain.. STUNNING AND BRAIN COMPRESSION 203 Stunning is liable to be complicated with other affections of the brain. The most common are compression and inflammation of the brain. The former may be due to the bursting of a blood-vessel by a tear in the brain substance, which is likely to occur in severe stunning. The rupture is also liable to induce subsequent inflammation. The extreme liability of the brain to excessive reaction after stunning absolutely prohibits the administration of alcoholic liquors which, them- selves producing congestion of the brain, would greatly increase the danger of subsequent inflammation. Compression of the Brain. — Definition: Pressure upon the brain substance, producing loss of brain power. Causes : The skull may be broken and a fragment of bone pushed in upon the brain, a tumor may grow in the brain itself, a blood-vessel may have been cut, and the blood, running between the skull and the brain, press upon it ; when this occurs, with or without an external wound, it produces apoplexy, which is con- sidered on the next page. Symptoms: Profound unconsciousness, even the eyes being insensible to the touch, while one or both pupils are dilated, but not uniformly. The breathing is deep and snoring, with a puffing of the lips and cheeks with each breath. The pulse is full, slow, and labored. There is paralysis, more or less complete. The face may be drawn to one side. The signs of a broken skull may be found in cases due to that accident. Treatment : But little can be done for these cases except by a surgeon, who should be summoned at once. The patient should be laid down with his head somewhat raised, and any clothing compressing the person should be loosened, such as the collar, sus- penders, and belt. Dress the wound with cold, moist dressings and apply cold to the head in the form of cloths wet with cold water, or ice bags. Keep the patient quiet and in the dark, if possible Give no stimulants of any kind I 204 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Compression of the brain is apt to be mistaken for stunning, but a comparison of the symptoms given for the two accidents will make it possible to distinguish clearly marked cases. Stunning, however, is present in almost every case of compression, so that it is not often that we have a distinct case of the latter to observe. A doubtful case should be treated like one of compression, the more dangerous accident Compression of blood from a bursted blood-vessel is called apoplexy, and is of sufficient importance to entitle it to distinct consideration. Apoplexy. — Definition ; Compression of the brain due to escape of blood between the skull and brain from a bursted blood-vessel. Paralytic stroke. Causes : Sudden mental or physical excitement inducing distention and bursting of one of the vessels of the brain weakened usually by advancing age. The blood thus escaped forms a clot between the skull and the brain and presses upon the brain substance. Symptoms : The subject is usually a person advanced in years. The patient usually falls suddenly to the ground as if struck down. In many cases he becomes unconscious at once, and when this does not occur, insensibility follows in a few minutes, and he cannot be aroused. The face is flushed. The eyes are insensible to the touch and irregularly dilated. The breathing is slow, labored, snoring, and puffing, the cheeks being puffed cut during expiration and sucked in during inspiration. Convulsive movements may occur. There is paralysis of one side of the body, shown by lifting up the hands, when one will be found to be cold and lifeless, while the other is normal. Treatment : Send for a medical man instantly. Make the patient lie down with his head slightly raised, and keep him very quiet and undisturbed. Loosen suspenders, collars, belts, and any tight articles of clothing. PARALYTIC STROKE OR APOPLEXY 205 Apply chopped ice or cloths wet with cold watei to the head. Apply warmth to the body and extremities by means of hot-water bottles, etc. Give no stimulating drinks of any kind I The cause of the bursting of the blood-vessel producing apoplexy is usually the softening and degeneration of the vessel due to advancing age. It most frequently affects persons over fifty years old. Anything which causes a strain on the vessels by overfilling them — such as joy or grief, bodily exertion or mental effort, a stooping posture, or a glass of wine — may burst the bleeding vessel. Younger persons, and even children, are occasionally attacked. Both physical indolence and mental activity render a man liable to it. A form of apoplexy is caused by excessive congestion of the brain without bursting of a vessel. This variety is more likely to affect a younger class of patients. Apoplexy is always alarming and dangerous. Many subjects, par- ticularly the elderly, never arise from the first stroke. Younger and more robust persons may survive a number of recurrences. The third stroke is apt to prove fatal, although this is by no means invariable, for double that number have been endured in some cases. The immediate danger of the attack does not pass away in less than ten days, and a patient should be carefully watched for that length of time. The paralysis due to apoplexy affects only one side of the body, and that the side opposite to the side of the brain injured. This is due to the fact that the nerves arising from the "brain on one side cross to the other side to be distributed, as has already been described in the chaptei on the Brain and Nerves. The object sought in the treatment of apoplexy is the diminution and checking of the bleeding. Direct treatment of the bleeding point being impossible, general measures for quieting the heart's action and assist- ing the formation of a clot must be adopted. Anything which would be likely to increase bleeding should be strictly avoided, such as admin- istering wines or liquors, lifting the patient into an erect posture, moving the limbs, or rubbing the skin. Apoplexy has often been confounded with less serious troubles. " Drunk 01 Dying," has been a frequent newspaper head-line to articles reflecting upon the police who have imprisoned a man suffering from a paralytic stroke, under the impression that he was " dead drunk." Apoplexy may be distinguished from Drunkenness (i) by the fact that the heat of the body is raised in the former and lowered in the laticr; (2) vomiting is common in drunkenness, and (3) the subject can be aroused to a greater or less extent by pinching, etc., while in apoplexy 206 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS there is no odor of liquor on the breath — this circumstance cannot be positively relied upon, however, since the subject himself may have taken a drink just before the attack, or the odor may arise from liquor which an officious bystander may have spilled in the effort to make him drink. Apoplexy may be distinguished from Opium Poisoning (i) by the fact that the pupils of the eyes in the latter are contracted uniformly to fine points; (2) there is no paralysis, and (3) the patient may be aroused by shouting at him, while (4) there is a characteristic odor of opium upon his breath. Apoplexy may be distinguished from Fits or Epilepsy (1) by the absence, in the latter, of one-sided paralysis, (2) by the foaming at the mouth, (3) by the spasmodic movement, and (4) by the short duration of the attack. One form of sunstroke is actually congestive apoplexy, and should be treated like apoplexy. Other varieties of unconsciousness may be differentiated from apoplexy by a careful comparison of their symptoms with those of that affection. Cases are liable to occur of most all of these affections which are so much like apoplexy as to deceive experts. In such a case the treat- ment should be that suitable to the most serious affection — an apo- plectic stroke. Drunkenness. — Definition : A state of more or less com- plete unconsciousness, resulting from drinking alco- holic liquor. Intoxication. Inebriation. Symptoms : These vary from a simple state of exhilaration to a condition of profound stupor, when the patient is " dead drunk." The symptoms given refer to the latter stage. Complete unconsciousness, from which the patient can be partially aroused. Face flushed and bloated. Eyes reddened and bloodshot ; the pupils equally dilated and fixed : if the eyeball be touched, the patient will attempt to close the eye. The lips are livid, and the breathing is slow and redolent with the odor of liquor. The temperature of the body is lowered two or three degrees. Treatment : Cold water dashed in the face often proves a most satisfactory awakener. DRUNKENNESS AND SUNSTROKE 2QJ Cause vomiting by tickling the pharynx with a feather or something of the kind ; by administering a table- spoonful of salt or mustard in a cup of warm water. Aromatic spirits of ammonia is very efficient in sobering a drunken man — a teaspoonful in half a cup of water. A cup of hot coffee after vomiting will aid to settle the stomach and clear the mind. Lay the subject in a comfortable position, applying hot, dry fomentations, if there is marked coldness. While intoxication is particularly noteworthy, because of its liability to be confounded with apoplexy, — from which it is distinguished by the signs noted in connection with that affection, — it is a condition fraught with danger in itself. Every one knows the effect of long-continued and often-repeated inebriation. The weak stomach, the enfeebled hand, the muscular trembling, and the shambling gait of the habitual drunkard are all familiar. But it is not so well known that alcoholic liquors taken in large quantities will cause fatal shock, — death occurring sometimes at once and sometimes within a few hours. These cases should be treated on the principles laid down for the treatment of shock. The system of an inebriated person is particularly subject to the influ- ence of cold. Nothing is more dangerous than to permit a man in such a condition to be subject to the influences of inclement weather, by lying exposed to rain, snow, or severe cold. The practice of confining a profoundly intoxicated man in a chilly and damp cell is very objec- tionable, for the same reason, — a fatal pneumonia or congestion of the brain is very likely to follow. It is sometimes very difficult to distinguish between drunkenness and apoplexy, and where the shadow of a doubt exists apply the treatment for apoplexy. In such a case never cause the patient to vomit. The treatment for apoplexy is not ill-adapted to drunkenness, and certainly will not be harmful ; while that for the drunkard might prove fatal to the apoplectic. Sunstroke. — Definition : Unconsciousness, due to exposure to the heat, usually of the sun. Heatstroke. Heat- exha ms t ion . Insolation . Causes : Exposure to long-continued heat — usually of the sun, but often to artificial heat in factories, etc., — is the chief cause ; but bad air, excessive clothing, fatigue, and in particular intemperate habits are im- portant accessories. 208 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Symptoms: (i) Preliminary. In many cases .the attack is preceded by giddiness, weakness, and nausea ; the eyes becoming bloodshot, and the skin hot and dry. (2) Preceded by these symptoms or not, the subject falls unconscious, the skin becomes exceedingly dry and hot, the breathing is quick and noisy, the pupils are contracted, and the heart is rapid and tumultuous. Treatiiient : Place the patient on his back, with his head raised, in the coolest immediately available spot. The chief object of all treatment is to reduce the excessive heat of the patient. After removing his clothing, pour a stream of cold water over his body, holding the vessel four or five feet above him. First pour on the head, then on his chest and abdomen, and last on his extremities. Repeat until the patient becomes conscious. Cold may be applied in other ways. Bags of cracked ice to the head and armpits should be used when available. The patient may be wrapped in cold sheets, or laid in a bath-tub which is then to be filled with cold water. Continue the cold applications until the patient be- comes conscious, or the heat is greatly diminished. Renew it again at once if the symptoms arise again. Heat-stroke seems to be an accident most common in the heated season in comparatively cool latitudes, or to persons who have not become acclimated in warm countries. Dampness seems also to have an important influence on the production of heat-stroke, the percentage of such accidents being greatly increased by an increase in the amount of moisture in the atmosphere. Fatigue is another important factor in the causation of heat-stroke. Soldiers upon a long march on a hot day are extremely subject to it. Heavy clothing should be avoided in hot weather, although, on account of their favoring the evaporation of sweat from the body, woollen garments are preferable. Any cause which weakens the system permanently or temporarily will favor the production of heat-stroke, and confinement in illy ventilated rooms and the use of intoxicating liquors are conspicuous among these. INSENSIBILITY FROM POISONING 209 The heat may cause merely a form of exhaustion, without insensi- bility, the patient complaining of great weakness and headache, while others are incoherent and stupid. These cases are to be treated with cold applications, and rest on the general lines laid down for severer cases, but less energetically. Another variety, however, is more serious and demands entirely different treatment. In these cases the attack seems to direct itself upon the heart. The skin is comparatively cool, the face is very pale, and the breathing is sighing or gasping, while the pulse is rapid and hardly perceptible. The attack comes on with great rapidity, and the subject falls to the ground, gasps, and sometimes expires almost instantly. In these cases the shock of cold applications should be strictly avoided; warmth should be applied externally and stimulating drinks internally. The treatment which would save life in one case would be fatal in the other. The treatment of the ordinary cases, however, is very simple, and consists in efforts to reduce the temperature of the over-heated blood. If the patient is in a close room, he should be laid near an open window ; if he is in the open air, he should be placed in the shade where a breeze can reach him. All tight clothing should be loosened and as much as possible removed. If in a dwelling-house, it will be very convenient to place him in a bath-tub ; out of doors, he can be laid on the grass, or the best available substitute for it. In drenching him, the water may be gathered in a hat or bucket, or anything else that will hold water. A watering-pot is an excellent instru- ment for applying the water. After the heat has been reduced, the patient should be watched with the utmost care, and any rise in 1 tem- perature should be promptly met by a renewal of the treatment. An attack may be fatal at once, or it may last from a few minutes to 'forty-eight hours. Recovery is apt to be followed by permanent effects upon the system ; the mind may be permanently weakened, or the patient may become a confirmed epileptic. A liability to frequent head- aches and muscular spasms is a not infrequent result. Insensibility from Poisoning. — Definition : Loss of con- sciousness from taking sleep-producing drugs. Causes : Taking opium — including laudanum, morphine, paregoric, and its other preparations — chloral and anodyne mixtures. Symptoms : Unconsciousness progressively increasing. The pupils of the eyes are contracted to the size of a pin's point in opium poisoning. The breathing grows progressively slower. 2IO EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS The smell of opium or chloral on the breath. Traces of the poison, or the bottle from which it has been taken may often be found. Treatment : Arouse the patient by slapping, pinching, and similar irritating proceedings When aroused sufficiently to swallow, give the patient an emetic of mustard or alum, a tablespoonful to a glass of warm water. Continue the vomiting by repeated doses given again and again. Make the patient drink freely of strong coffee. Keep the patient awake by slapping him with wet towels, pinching him, talking to him, and even making him walk up and down until he no longer feels the intense desire for sleep. The subject of opium and chloral poisoning is again referred to in the chapter on Poisons. Insensibility from Freezing. — Definition : Loss of con- sciousness due to exposure to extreme cold. Symptoms: Paleness and coldness of the frozen parts. Sluggishness of the pulse, slowness of the breathing, etc. Treatment : Rubbing with cold applications in a cool but gradually warmed room,, Stimulants and hot drinks as soon as the patient is able to swallow. Rest in warm clothing. The subject of freezing in all its details has been fully discussed in the chapter on Bruises, Burns, and Freezing. I FITS 211 CHAPTER XXIII FITS Epileptic Fits. — Definition ; Periodical convulsions, due to disease of the brain. Epileptic convulsions. Falling sickness. Symptoms : Patient often utters a peculiar cry just before falling. Immediately becomes absolutely unconscious. Falls in violent convulsions, jerking the arms, legs, and body. Foaming at the mouth, grinding of the teeth, and biting of the tongue or lips are common. Face becomes livid, the eyeballs roll, and the pupils are unaffected by light. Fit lasts from five to ten minutes. Fit generally followed by drowsiness or deep sleep, sometimes by headache and debility. Treatment : Nothing can be done to stop a fit. Place the patient so that he cannot strike his head or limbs against anything likely to injure them. Loosen the clothing about the neck and body to make the breathing and circulation as free as possible. Tie a handkerchief between the teeth and about the back of the head to prevent the teeth closing upon the tongue. Give the patient an abundance of fresh air. Favor his tendency to rest after the fit has ceased. Epilepsy is a disease of the brain which manifests itself in fits or con- vulsions, recurring at more or less frequent intervals, sometimes as often as two or three times daily. The victims generally experience premoni- tory symptoms, such as headache, dizziness, terror, or a peculiar creep- ing sensation like that of a current of air or a stream of water, beginning in a hand or foot and extending toward the trunk. Warned by these sensations, the subjects often attempt to place themselves in a situation favorable to the attaoKv 212 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS On account of the suddenness of the onset, however, it is often im- possible for the epileptic to remove himself from dangerous locations. He may tall across a railway track, or down a flight of stairs, into a fire, or under water. In such cases, injuries of various kinds are likely to complicate the fit, and demand the treatment suited to them. If in a situation where his movements are likely to bring him into danger, it goes without saying that he should be removed. Epilepsy is rarely cured. As life advances, the mind is likely to be affected to a greater or less degree. Nevertheless, a number of the great men of history have been subject to epilepsy. Caesar and Napo- leon, Petrarch and Byron, Mahomet and Paul, were victims of the dis- ease, and achieved greatness in spite of it. Hysterics. — Definition : Paroxysms, varying in extent from an uncontrollable fit of laughing or sobbing to convul- sions similar to epileptic fits. Sytnptoms : The subject is usually a weak girl or young woman. May simply be affected with uncontrollable laughing or crying. May fall suddenly to the ground, with clenched hands, grinding of teeth, and jerking of limbs, in imi- tation of epilepsy. Partial unconsciousness is assumed, not real, as is shown by muscular resistance on attempting to open the eyelids. The convulsions are never so directed as to hurt the patient, nor does she fall uncomfortably, nor bite her tongue, as in epilepsy. There is no one-sided paralysis, no snoring breathing, nor flapping of the cheeks, as in apoplexy. Treatment: No treatment is necessary. A patient will promptly recover, if left alone. It is essential that no sympathy be shown. A dash of cold water in the face, repeated if neces- sary, will complete recovery in most cases. Hysterics must not be confounded with hysteria, which is an actual disease of the nervous system, demanding medical skill of the highest order for its treatment, and manifesting itself in a multitude Qf various* symptoms. HYSTERICS AND CHILDREN S FITS 213 Convulsions from Kidney Disease. — Definition : Parox- ysms, due to blood poisoning, from the failure of the kidneys to cast off waste products. Symptoms : Dropsy, particularly of the feet and lower limbs, existing some time previously* Patient presents convulsions, varying from twitch- ings of the face and fingers to general severe jerk- ings of all the muscles of the body, with complete unconsciousness . The breath and skin have a clammy odor. The paroxysms may be preceded and followed by delirium. Treatment : Summon a physician instantly, notifying him of the exact character of the trouble. Place the patient in a comfortable position. Apply cold, moist fomentations to the head — wet cloths or ice bags. Apply a mustard plaster across the small of the back. A previous history of kidney disease will exist in almost all cases of this kind and will help to distinguish it. It is not uncommon in women during the months preceding childbirth, and in this case it is fraught with great danger. These convulsions are usually directly due to an alteration of the kidney by disease in which the excreting power of the urinary tubules is diminished, and the poisonous waste products, not able to be thrown off, are retained in the blood. Children's Fits. — Definition: Paroxysms, due to irritation of the nervous system in children. Convulsions of children . Causes : Constipation, indigestion, worms, eruption of teeth, fright, and similar irritating things. Convul- sions are not as serious in children as in adults. Symptoms : Before a fit, fretfulness, restlessness, and gritting of the teeth in sleep. In a fit, the child is absolutely unconscious. The muscles of the face twitch, the body stiffens at first and then passes into a series of jerking motions — the head and neck are drawn ba violently bent and straightened. 214 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS The pulse is very rapid and weak, the breathing hurried and labored, and the skin is wet with perspira- tion, often cold and clammy. After a few minutes the child usually recovers in a quiet sleep, but the fits may be repeated with short intervals between them. The first fit may be fatal, or later ones ; or recovery may be prompt and permanent. Treatment : A bath of water as hot as it can be borne should be prepared, a teaspoonful of mustard dissolved in it, if available, and the child should be set into it for several minutes, repeating the operation if the fit recurs. Follow this with an injection of a little oil or a great deal of soapsuds to clear out the bowels, in case the cause of the trouble may lie there. Then tickle the roof of the mouth with a feather, or use other means to produce vomiting, since the cause may lie in the stomach. Summon a physician without delay. CHAPTER XXIV SMOTHERING Smothering, suffocation, or asphyxia is a state of uncon- sciousness due to cutting off the supply of oxygen to the lungs. Smothering may be due to a number of causes. The most common is drowning, where the water prevents the access of air to the lungs. Hanging and strangling, where the pas- sage of air through the windpipe is prevented by compres- sion of that tube, are well known. Anything which will close the air-passage will produce smothering ; such are bits of food and other articles diverted from their proper channels in the attempt to swallow ; a variety of croup, in which the windpipe is stuffed up by secretions, comes into this class. Pressure upon the chest sufficiently to prevent iis movement in RESTORING THE BREATHING IN SMOTHERING 215 breathing is another cause. The methods of Othello and Richard III., causing smothering by pressing a pillow tightly down upon the face, are classical. Smothering is the cause of death in persons who have been buried under avalanches of snow or sand, grain falls, and the like. Another variety of smothering is that produced when the atmosphere is so filled with other gases that the proper amount of oxygen cannot find its way into the blood. Smothering by breathing air filled with illuminating gas is a common accident in cities where the victims from carelessness or ignorance have failed to turn off the gas in extinguishing a light. The gases formed by burning coal and decaying sew- age, and the smoke of burning buildings, produce insensibility from the same cause. The restoration of the function of breathing is the chief aim in treating cases of smothering — by this means carrying off the waste, poisonous products from the blood and giving new life to the system by an abundant supply of oxygen. Restoring the Breathing. — The act of breathing is restored by causing the chest walls to expand and contract in the same manner as in the normal acts of inspiration and expiration. Fig. 132. — Restoring. the breathing by Sylvester's method — Inspiration. This is called artificial respiration and is performed in sev- eral ways. One of the most convenient and useful is Sylves- ter's method, which is as follows : — Lay the smothered person on his back, with a pillow of folded clothing or other articles under his shoulders. 2l6 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Take a position at the head of the patient, grasp his arms just below the elbow, and draw them slowly and steadily up over the head, holding them there long enough to deliberately count four. Then push the arms down upon the chest, bending the elbows as they come down, and press them strongly, but gently, against the chest long enough to again count four. Repeat these movements until the patient begins to breathe naturally, or until it is evident that life is beyond recall. Fig. 133. — Restoring the breathing by Sylvester's method— Expiration. The first sign of returning breathing is a change in the color of his face ; if white, it becomes red ; and if red, it changes to white. With this a faint fluttering breath may be seen passing the lips. Drawing the arms up over the head pulls upon certain muscles which expand the chest, creating a vacuum which the air rushes in to fill. Pushing the arms down upon the chest again compresses it and forces the air out of the lungs. Air is thus drawn into and forced out of the lungs in the same manner as breathing. The blood is gradually purified by the oxygen brought into contact with it, and the system is again inspired with life. Marshall Hall's method was long the most popular method of restor- ing the breathing, and is still described at length and illustrated, in many works, in connection with the resuscitation of the drowning. It consists ill laying the body on one side and rolling it on to the chest so as DROWNING 217 to compress its walls and produce expiration, and on to the back, to permit the chest walls to spring out to their normal position, producing inspiration. The method is clumsy in requiring several assistants, and incomplete in that the amount of contraction and expansion of the chest is slight. Either Sylvester's or Satterthwaite's methods are vastly preferable to it. Howard's method is better than Hall's. The patient is laid flat on his back with a roll of clothing under his shoulders thick enough to allow the head to be thrown well back, and his hands are tied together above his head. Then kneeling beside or astride of the patient, the operator places his hands upon the lower ribs, grasping the waist, and presses them in by throwing his weight upon his hands, at the same time pressing upward. Then he lets go with a push that brings him back to the kneeling position, the pressure producing expiration, and its removal, inspiration. Drowning. — Definition : Suffocation through the stoppage of the air-passages by fluid. Causes : The stoppage of the air-passages by fluid. Any amount of fluid will cause the accident, provided that it is sufficient to prevent the passage of air to the lungs. Men have been drowned in a basin of water and a tankard of beer, as well as in water fathoms deep — the immersion of the face being enough. Symptoms : The chief symptom is the fact of the patient having been immersed in water. Upon being taking out, the face is swollen and purple. The lips are livid and the eyes bloodshot. The mouth, windpipe, and lungs contain a frothy fluid, and there is considerable water in the stomach. The tongue may be swollen and bluish, and grasped by the teeth. The feet and hands also are often swollen and discolored. The body is cold. Treatment : 1 . Summon a physician as soon as possible without leaving the patient in danger. 2. The treatment should be applied in the open air unless prevented by inclement weather. 218 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS 3. The clothing should be rapidly removed, cutting with knife or scissors for the sake of haste, and the body quickly wiped dry. 4. (a) Wedge open the mouth and keep it open by tying a handkerchief or bandage through it like a gag. This will also help to keep the tongue in place. (b) Get rid of the water that is in the body, by rolling the person over on to his face, with his head a little lower than the body, if possible, and (c) then, getting astride of the patient, gently raise his middle by the hands clasped under the abdomen ; in a few seconds the water will have run out sufficiently to permit the next step. Fig. 134. — Emptying the water from the lune 5. Restoring the Breathing, (a) Turn him on to his back, placing him on level ground, and keeping the mouth wedged open as before, (a) Place the left forefinger on the tongue to keep it in place, and (c) with the right hand press upon the abdomen, DROWNING 219 making the pressure toward the back and head of the patient. Press gently at first, but increase the pressure until as much air as possible has been forced out of the chest, (d) Then withdraw the hand so that the lungs may fill with air. (e) Repeat these movements, at first making them three or four times a minute, increasing to ten or fifteen, and persisting at that rate until breathing has been re-established, or it is evident that the patient is dead This is Satterthwaite's ?nethod of restoring the breathing. Fig. 135. — Restoring the breathing by Satterthwaite's method. Where several persons are present to assist. Sylves- ter's method may be used in addition to this. The arms should be pressed upon the chest at the same time that the abdomen is pressed upon. When the hand is withdrawn from the abdomen, the arms should be brought up by the side of the head. 6. Wrap him in warm, dry clothing, blankets and overcoats, or other articles of clothing which can he borrowed. Then rub the limbs and body briskly under the clothino; to assist in restoring the circulation. 220 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS 7. A good healthy reaction of the system having been obtained, the patient may be carried to a com- fortable room and placed in a warm bed. Hot dry fomentations, such as hot-water bottles, hot bricks, and the like should be applied to the body. 8. When the patient is able to swallow, warm fluids may be fed to him with a spoon. Stimulants to a moderate extent may also be given, and he should be encouraged to pass into a restful sleep. The symptoms of drowning described are developed by suffocation, which the patient has fought as long as life held out, and more or less water has found its way into the lungs. In a few cases, the patient faints at once — the heart-beat and breathing stopping immediately, and the windpipe being closed by the epiglottis so that the water cannot pass through. Here the face of the patient is pale and flabby, and there is no frothy matter in the mouth and no water in the lungs. The treat- ment of both varieties is the same, but the prospect of recovery in this case is much better than the other. The importance of emptying the water out of the lungs and stomach has always been recognized. It is accomplished with perfect ease by the method given here. The plans of rolling upon a barrel or hanging up by the heels occasionally practised are barbarous and liable to cause harm rather than do good. They should NEVER be employed! The diaphragm or midriff is the chief factor in the methods of restor- ing the breathing. Satterthwaite's method is directed especially toward utilizing its function in breathing. In pressing toward the patient's back and head, he presses the diaphragm directly upward and pushes the air out through the windpipe. When he withdraws his pressure, the diaphragm returns to its ordinary position, and the air is sucked into the lungs to fill the increased space. When Sylvester's method is added to it, we have the breathing act still further imitated by the addi- tion of the chest movements to those of the diaphragm. Artificial respiration, as performed by the combination of these methods, is the most perfect substitute for the natural breathing possible. When the person has not been long in the water, it is often possible to restore breathing by irritating the nostrils with snuff, smelling salts, or ammonia, or tickling the throat with a feather, and rubbing the body briskly. But these methods are not to be relied upon, and too much delay in resorting to artificial respiration will endanger the life of the patient. Where there are several persons present to assist, one of these may apply these procedures in addition. It is difficult to decide just how long a person can be under water RESCUING THE DROWNING 221 without dying. In some cases, it has been impossible to resuscitate persons after but a few minutes' submersion, while in others life i.as not been extinct after hours have been passed in the water. Hope, then should not be abandoned even if an hour or two has elapsed since the patient sunk. The time required for artificial respiration to restore the breathing is also very variable, some cases responding in a few moments, while with others it is a matter of hours. Efforts then should be employed with great persistence, and discontinued only after hours of faithful labor have demonstrated their uselessness. Rescuing the Drowning. — Swimming is an art that is easily acquired with a little self-confidence, and when once learned is never forgotten. The main point for one to re- member — who does not know how to swim, and who has accidentally fallen into the water, or who is learning to swim — is, that the human body will float if properly managed. Even a very small article, such as an oar or a small board, will make it easy to keep the head above water, if the chin be rested upon it. And this can be done without an) assistance. It is possible, however, to float without any assistance. The secret of success is a willingness to sink on the back so that the face alone will be out of water. Throwing the arms out of the water or attempting to get the head and shoulders above the surface will cause the entire body to sink. But if a person lies back, with his hands above his head, and allows the water to arise nearly to his mouth and lips, he may float for an indefinite period. The conduct of a bystander, in case of a drowning person, should vary according to his acquaintance with the art of swimming. If none of the bystanders can swim, and the person has sunk within reaching distance, they should hold an oar, a fish-pole, or something of the kind to him, that he may grasp it as he arises, as almost invaria- bly occurs at least once and often several times. If there is nothing else at hand, a coat should be taken off, and, holding it by one sleeve, the other or the skirts should* be thrown to the unfortunate. Esmarch was told by an old sea-captain that he had saved many lives in that way. When life-preservers are available, their use will occur to any one in the presence of a drowning person. But it should be remembered that anything that will float may be substituted for it, such as boards, boxes, logs, sticks of wood, etc. If one is not a good swimmer, he may throw a float of this kind to the drowning person, and then obtaining one himself, paddle by its aid to the one whom he is trying to save. 222 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Fig. 136. — Grasping the drowning person. When one is a good swimmer, and the drowning person is at some distance, he should throw off as much clothing as possible and swim out to him, taking great care to avoid his clutch, for the death of a would-be rescuer has often resulted from being grasped at an inconvenient point, hampering him so that he could neither save himself or the one whom he hoped to rescue. i. Swim behind him and grasp him, preferably, by the hair — or if that be too short, by the collar — with the left hand, and with the right hand grasp his right shoulder; he can thus be kept harmless, with his face above water. Hold him at arm's length, and " tread water." 2. Watching the right arm of the drowning per- son until a favor- able opportunity appears, seize it at the wrist, and draw it behind the head. Then prepare to swim to shore. 3. Having the right arm held behind his head, take a few strokes so as to float on the back and draw the drowning man on to the chest, gaining his con- fidence if possi- ble, and swim Fig. 138. — Drawing the drowning person on to the chest. toward the Fig. 137. — Controlling the right arm. SMOTHERING BY GASES 223 shore, not attempting to keep the head of either high above the water. 4. If the drowning person be unconscious, the work is made much easier, for he can then be drawn upon the chest without an effort either to avoid his clutch or to render him harmless. Fig. 139. — Swimming to shore. Breaking through the Ice. — A person who has become apparently drowned by breaking through the ice should be treated according to the methods prescribed for drowning in general. To rescue such a person, it is not wise to attempt to walk out to him, for the ice may give way, and involve the would-be rescuer also. But if a person's weight is spread out upon the ice by creeping on all-fours, or, better still, by working his way fiat on his abdomen, he may go where the ice would not bear the weight of a person erect. Or he may push a long board, a plank, or a pole out to the unfortunate, who may pull himself out upon it. Whoever attempts the rescue of a person who has broken through the ice, should attach to himself a long rope of some kind, with the other end made fast to the shore, for his own protection in case the ice gives way. Smothering by Gases. — The gas which is particularly liable to affect life is carbonic acid. It is present in nearly every form of noxious vapor, whether in the so-called sewer- gas, the coal gas used for lighting houses, the choke-damp of the mines, the bad atmosphere of crowded rooms, vaults in which the fermentation of wine or beer is in process, or in the smoke of burning buildings. Symptoms : The symptoms of smothering by gases are those of smothering in general — a swollen and purple face, livid lips, and bloodshot and staring eyes. 224 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Treatment : In case a man is overcome by noxious gases, the main thing is to get him out into the open air. Rapidly loosen and, if possible, remove his clothing. Hold him in a half-sitting posture, with his head higher than his feet — just the opposite of the attitude advised for fainting. Rub the whole body briskly with flannel, or other fabric and restore the breathing by performing artificial respiration. From time to time dash mod- erate quantities of cold water over the body. Caves and underground passages are liable to contain a greater or less quantity of carbonic acid gas. It is of frequent occurrence in mines, where it is known as " choke-damp," and in cellars containing ferment- ing beer or wine ; it is found in sewers and drains intermingled with the sulphuretted hydrogen — which gives the offensive odor to rotten eggs — and still more noxious vapors. For this reason all unused underground places should be entered with caution. If a lighted candle burns all the way to the bottom, when let down into a pit, no dangerous amount of carbonic acid is present; still there may be other dangerous gases by which visitors may be overcome. The first person to enter a pit or drain should carry tied to his person the end of a rope by which he can occasionally signal his safety to those remaining outside. Upon his failure to reply to any signals he should promptly be drawn out into the fresh air by the rope. Upon the dis- covery of noxious air in an excavation, it should be purified by violently agitating the air, by firing guns into it, by lowering and raising open umbrellas, by pouring water or quick-lime into it. When lowering a lighted candle, or firing a gun into a pit, precautions should be taken against injury by the possible explosion of inflammable gases. If it be necessary to enter a poisoned shaft to rescue persons already insensible, the rescuer should have his nose and mouth covered with a cloth wet with vinegar, and, as previously stated, should be connected with the outer world by a signal rope. If a room be filled with poisonous gas from any source, it is easily and rapidly cleared by opening the doors and windows from the outside. The victim should then be promptly carried out of the room and treated for smothering. The gaseous products of fire are a frequent cause of death in burning buildings, and it is worth while to remember that in a room full of smoke from such a cause, the purer air is to be found near the floor. Hence it is often best to creep into a room in a burning house on the hands and knees. Moreover, the flames are an indication of oxygen, and air can be found to breathe wherever flames are seen. SMOTHERING BY STRANGLING OR HANGING 225 They may burn one, but they indicate air to breathe. If these facts be known and remembered, many lives may be saved both of the occu- pants of burning buildings and of those who would save them. Smothering by Pressure on the Chest.— Caused by earth or other debris falling on the affected person. Treatment: Remove the weight and treat the smothering as before stated. Other injuries which are liable to complicate the trouble add ma- terially to the danger. Smothering by Strangling or Hanging.— Caused by suicidal efforts or by accidental entanglement, as in the reins of a runaway horse, etc. Treatment: (i). Cut the person down. Support him with one arm while cutting to relieve immediately the compression of the neck. (2). Loosen first the noose and then the clothing (3). Place in a half lying-down position. (4). Rub briskly with flannel, towels, etc. (5). Apply artificial respiration, with occasional dashes of cold water. (6). Summon a surgeon at once. Smothering by Electric Shock. — Caused by touch of a "live wire," electric machinery, or lightning. Symptoms: Unconsciousness; slow breathing; weak, ir- regular or absent pulse; burns and blisters of the affected part. Treatment: Remove the person from the electric contact, but do not touch him or the wire or machinery unless the hands are covered with a non-conductor, such as sheet rubber, rubber clothing, or sheeting, etc. Rub well, dash water, and if nec- essary, apply artificial respiration. 226 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS CHAPTER XXV POISONS Poisons. — Definition : A poison is any substance which taken into the system in small quantities will produce death or serious disorder. Varieties : Poisons may be general, affecting the entire system, or local, affecting some particular part pri- marily, and the whole system only secondarily. Symptoms : The symptoms of the various poisons differ according to the individual drug. But certain of them possess enough characteristics in common to enable them to be grouped and to render it easy to distinguish them. They are : — i . Locally irritating poisons in which the symptoms are due entirely to the location of the poison. 2. General poisons, causing local irritation in which the poison affects the system at large in addition to producing local irritation. 3. Sleep-producing or narcotic poisons. 4. General poisons in which there is no local irri- tation. Treatment: In the first class never cause vomiting. Give dilute acids to neutralize alkalies, and dilute alka- lies to neutralize acids. Follow with soothing drinks of oil, raw eggs, and flour and water. Give opiates to quiet pain, and whiskey or brandy to relieve the weakness. In the second class, except in case of arsenic, no emetic should be- given, but the effect of the poison should be counteracted by bland doses of oil, flour and water, white of egg, and the like, while stimulating drinks should be given to counteract depression. The treatment of arsenic is peculiar to itjelf and should be studied individually in the tables. POISONS 22) In the third class, sleep-producing poisons, give an emetic ; after producing repeated vomiting make the patient drink strong coffee and other stimulating drinks, and use every available means to keep him awake. In the fourth class, general poisons, always give an emetic, follow with stimulating drinks to relieve weak- ness ; give opiates to relieve pain, and put the patient to rest. The individual poisons may best be considered in the form of a table, where they can moreover more quickly be found in an emergency. i. Locally Irritating Poisons. Poison. Symptoms. Treatment. Acids : — Muriatic. Nitric (aqua fortis). Oxalic. Sulphuric (vitriol). Excessively severe burn- ing pain in the mouth, throat, and stomach. Difficult swallowing. Great depression. Ex- tremities cold and clammy. Convulsions. (Death.) No emetic. Alkali (bak- ing soda, saleratus, magnesia, chalk, lime, plaster) — 3 or 4 tea- spoonfuls in a glass of water. Drink soothing fluids, like oil. Stimu- lating drinks, if neces- sary. Opiates to re- lieve pain. Acid, Carbolic: — Creosote. Vomiting of frothy mucus. Lining membrane of mouth white, hardened, and benumbed. Severe pain in belly. Cold, clammy skin ; insensi- bility. Snoring breath- ing. Odor of carbolic acid. No emetic. White of eggs. Milk, or flour and water. Rest. Opi- ates. Alkalies : — Ammonia (hartshorn). Lye. Pearlash. Potash, Caustic. Soda, Caustic. Painful burning in mouth, throat, and stomach. Difficult swallowing. Bloody vomiting and purging. Great depres- sion, etc., like acids. No emetic. Dilute acids (vinegar or lemon juice). Soothing fluids, like oil, melted fat, thick cream, etc. Stimulat- ing drinks. Opiates to relieve pain. Silver: — Nitrate (Lunar caustic) . Same as above. No emetic. Copious draughts of salt and water. Soothing drinks. Opiates. 228 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS 2 Ceneral Poisons, causing Local Irritation. Poison. Symptoms. Treatment. Mercury:— Corrosive sublimate. Calomel. Vermilion. Burning pain in throat, stomach, and bowels. Metallic taste. Vomit- ing and purging — fre- quently bloody. In- crease of saliva. Sleep- iness. Convulsions. Stupor. No emetic. Raw eggs, milk, or flour and water. Castor oil. Stimulating drinks. Arsenic:— Fowler's solution. Green coloring matter. Paris green. Rough on Rats. Scheele's green. Burning pain in stomach and bowels. Tender- ness of belly on pres- sure. Retching. Vom- iting. Dryness of throat. Clammy sweat. Convulsions. Cause repeated vomit- ing. Give hydrated oxide of iron made by adding 8 parts of am- monia water to io parts of solution of tersulphate of iron. Then castor oil. Rest, and stimu- lating drinks if needed. Copper:— Verdegris. Blue vitriol. Food cooked in copper vessels. Similar to those of arsenic. Coppery taste in mouth. Tongue dry. Colic. Bloody stools. No emetic. White of eggs, if obtainable, — if not, flour and water. Ice. Opiates to relieve pain and excitement. Iron:— Copperas. Green vitriol. Burning pain in throat, stomach, and bowels. Colic. Vomiting. Purg- ing. Cold skin. Weak pulse. No emetic. Baking-soda in water. Then raw eggs and milk. Opiates for pain. Stimulating drinks for depression. 3. Sleep-producing or Narcotic Poisons. Poison. Symptoms. Treatment. Chloral: — A white, crystalline sub- stance, with an acrid taste. Profound sleep. Breath- ing slow and shallow. Pulse weak, rapid, and irregular. Remains of poison near by. Cause vomiting. Stimu- lating drinks. Heat. Motion. Opium: — Laudanum. Morphine. Paregoric. Sleeping mixtures in general. Giddiness. Heaviness of the head. Sleepiness. Stupor. Pupils of eyes contracted to fine point. Signs of the poison near by. Cause vomiting. Stimu- lating drinks — strong coffee. Keep up breath- ing. Warmth. Keep patient awake by whip- ping, if necessary. Mo- tion. POISONS 229 4. General Poisons. Poison. Symptoms. Treatment. Aconite:— Wolfsbane. Monkshood. Great depression. Ex- treme weakness. Cold sweat. Numbness of extremities. Weak and slow pulse. Cause vomiting. Stimu- lating drinks. Belladonna:— Atropia. Deadly nightshade. Eyes very bright, and pu- pils enlarged. Dryness of throat. Paralysis of excretory organs. De- lirium. Convulsions. Cause vomiting. Opi- ates to relieve nervous excitement. Rest. Lead:— Red lead. Sugar of lead. White lead. Metallic taste in mouth. Cramps. Paralysis. Vomiting. Increase of saliva. Giddiness. Convulsions. Stupor. Cause vomiting. Large doses of Epsom or C lau- ber's salts. Stimulating drinks. Phosphorus:— Matches. Pain in stomach and bow- els. Vomiting. Purg- ing. Signs of poison near by. Cause vomiting. Mag- nesia in water. Soap suds. Rest. Warmth. Prussic acid:— Cyanide of potash. Oil of bitter almonds. Laurel water. Death may occur instant- ly in ordinary doses. In very small doses, giddiness, blindness, convulsions, fainting. Death may occur from smelling the odor only. No emetic. Stimulating drinks (strong) without delay. Strychnine:— Nux vomica. Slight shuddering. Feel- ing of constriction of throat. Starting s. Paleness. Intermittent jerkings. Convulsions. Ghastly grin. Cause vomiting once or twice. Rest. Opiates. Chloral. Tannin. Vegetable poisons:— Berries (Bitter-sweet, Deadly nightshade, Mountain ash, Poke, Potato). . Hellebore, Hemlock, Horse chest- nut, Indian tobacco, Jamestown weed, Wild lettuce, Wild parsley, Rhubarb leaves, Toad- stools, Tobacco plant. Nausea. Depression. In- toxication, Stupor, etc., varying somewhat with the poison. Cause vomiting. Stimu lating drinks. Rest. 23O EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Emetics. — In the majority of cases of general poisoning, the first step to be taken is to cause the patient to disgorge as much of the poison as possible by vomiting. Articles producing these acts are called "emetics. 1 ' . 1 . Vomiting can be induced frequently by thrusting the finger back in the mouth to the pharynx ; where another person's mouth is in question a feather, or some other soft object, may be used. 2. Drinking large quantities of warm water will often cause the desired effect. A little salt added to the water will in- crease the effect. 3. Chewing and swallowing tobacco in considerable quan- tities will cause the stomach to rebel. The tobacco itself in this case is poisonous, but by inducing 1 vomiting it acts as its own antidote. 4. Drinking mustard or salt and water, made by adding a tablespoonful of common salt, or powdered mustard, to a tumblerful of lukewarm water, makes an excellent emetic. Medical men will administer ipecac, apomorphine, sulphate of zinc, tartar emetic, and other drugs. But the readily available means of inducing vomiting here given should be employed while awaiting their arrival. Weakness and shock following poisoning and its treatment should be treated by stimulation and warmth as already pre- scribed for those conditions. Poison Ivy, Oak, Sumac. — Certain plants produce a painful rash when they merely touch the skin. In some cases the eruption has followed a near approach only to the plant, without direct contact, the poisonous effect being prob- ably due to a noxious emanation from it. The more common of these plants belong to the rhus family, and are commonly known as the " poison ivy," or " poison vine," the " poison oak," and the " poison sumac." The poison ivy or poison vine {Rhus radicans) is a climb- ing plant growing luxuriantly upon trees and rocks, and somewhat resembles the woodbine or Virginia creeper. But the poison ivy is three-leaved (Fig. 140), while the harm- less variety is five-leaved. The poison ivy has a hairy POISON PLANTS AND POISONED WOUNDS 23 1 trunk and often has little white berries from the axils of the leaves. The " poison oak" {Rhus toxicodendron) is an erect plant twelve to eighteen inches in height, with a leaf like that of the poison vine, consisting of three smaller leaflets (Fig. 140). The "floison sumac " {RJnis venenata) is very similar to the ordinary sumac, except that, like the poison ivy, it has small, slender clusters of white berries growing from the axils of the leaves. In all other sumacs the berries Fig ' l4 °- ~ Leaf of the poison ivy or poison vine. are red and in close bunches at the ends of the branches, and these are not only harm- less, but have an agreeable and wholesome acid taste. Symptoms : A painful rash, sometimes uniformly red, and at other times consisting of collections of small eleva- tions, surrounded by a greatly reddened surface. It is rather more frequent on the hands, face, and neck, but is often seen on and about the thighs. It may last from two or three days in mild cases to one or two weeks in the more severe. Treatment : A very strong solution of bicarbonate of soda {baking-soda) will frequently check the trouble in the beginning. Any soothing ointment such as vaseline or petrolatum is also useful, and in the ab- sence of these lathering the part with a soft shaving- brush will diminish the itching and burning. Poisoned Wounds. — Certain poisons may be introduced directly into the circulation through wounds. Wounds may become poisoned in three ways : (1) By the development and multiplication of germs which induce death and decay of the tissues in an otherwise healthy wound. This variety of poisoned wounds has been fully discussed- in connection with the germ theory, and rules have been given for its prevention 232 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS and treatment. (2) Wounds may become poisoned by the introduction of a poison after they have been inflicted. And (3) wounds may become poisoned by being inflicted with some poisoned instrument. 1. Poisons in common with most medicinal substances are readily absorbed through wounds with which they may come in contact. This is occasionally seen when, through the injudicious use of poisonous antiseptic agents in the treat- ment of wounds, or for other reasons, enough carbolic acid, corrosive sublimate, or iodoform has been absorbed to pro- duce serious and even fatal poisoning. Wounds into which the poison has been introduced after the infliction of the injury should be treated, prior to the arrival of a surgeon, by removing the source of the poisoning and then employing the measures ordinarily applied to healthy wounds. Great care should be taken to avoid the introduction of poisons by the prompt application to wounds of clean dressings. 2. Wounds may be poisoned by being inflicted by some poisoned instrument, such as a poisoned arrow or dagger, or the teeth of an animal, the fangs of a reptile, or the sting of an insect. Poisoned weapons are rarely used at the present time even by savages. If shallow, these wounds should be treated like bites of rabid animals ; but if deep, such treatment would be of little avail, and ordinary wound treatment must suffice until the advice of a surgeon can be obtained. Dog Bites, and wounds inflicted by the teeth of other animals, are usually simple wounds, unless the animal be mad. In this case the saliva of the animal contains a poison which is carried into the wound by the teeth, to pass into the circu- lation and produce a similar disease in man. Treatment: Absolute safety to a person who has been bitten by a mad animal can only be secured by imme- diately and entirely cutting or burning the wound out of the body. While preparations are being made for doing this a bandage or handkerchief should be bound tightly about the limb — the Spanish windlass (page 151) is excellent for this purpose — above the wound, to BITES OF ANIMALS AND INSECTS 233 prevent the poison being carried into the circulation. The wound should be sucked to extract as much as possible of the poison, it being remembered that there is no danger from the poison being taken into the mouth, although it should be expectorated, not swal- lowed. Then with a sharp knife cut the bite out completely, or burn it out with a red-hot iron, or by filling it with powder and tiring it. The patient should then be quietly laid to rest and given alcoholic drinks in large quantities to counteract the effects of shock. Snake Bites. — This injury is most commonly due in this country to the rattlesnake, the copperhead, and the moccasin. Symptoms : Following a bite, swelling and discoloration of the wound ; headache, chills, and great weakness. If fatal, death may occur in from a few hours to several days. Treatment : The bites of poisonous snakes may be treated in the same way as those of mad dogs. Suck the wound, — after having put a tourniquet about the limb above the bite, — taking care to expectorate the poi- son. Then cut or burn the bite and administer whiskey or other alcoholic drinks to the patient in large quantities. Insect Stings. — Under this head are included the bite of the so-called tarantula, as well as the stings of the centipede and scorpion, the wasp, hornet, and bees. The bite of the tarantula is sometimes fatal, and in Eastern countries the same result is said to follow the sting of the scorpion. But in this country the scorpion, as well as the centipede, does not produce fatal results, although the latter may inflict a painful and annoying injury. The bite of the tarantula and the stings of the centipede and scorpion should be treated in the same way as snake bites. Insects in stinging usually leave their stings in the wound. It should first be extracted and the wound then treated with a solution of baking-soda. Clay made up into a paste with saliva is a favorite application which may be used in the absence of soda. The sting can usually be forced out by 234 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS pressing upon the skin by its side, or if a watch-key, or some- thing with an open centre be pressed down upon it, the sting will be pressed out. CHAPTER XXVI DEATH Death is the permanent cessation of all the functions which taken together constitute life. i . The lungs cease drawing in and throwing out air — pass- ing oxygen into the blood and extracting carbonic acid. 2. The heart ceases throwing the blood into the system and into the lungs. 3. The blood stops carrying its freight of oxygen into the tissues and its load of carbonic acid out of it. 4. The muscles cease acting and moving the body. 5. The nerves stop carrying telegraphic messages from the mind in the brain and spinal ganglia. 6. The viscera cease their digestive and excretory action. 7. Heat and motion depart.' 8. The eyes become glazed and half open. 9. There is no feeling in the body. 10. The teeth are clenched, and froth often forms about the mouth. 1 1 . The inciting power of all these actions, the soul, de- parts, and — 12. The process of decay sets in. When all these conditions have been fulfilled, death has occurred without a doubt, but in some cases the functions are carried on so imperceptibly as not to be readily perceived. Cases have occurred where, owing to a temporary diminution of these vital phenomena, death has been simulated so suc- cessfully that persons have been buried alive. This is, how- DEATH 235 ever, by no means as frequent as is often supposed, as is shown by the experience of certain foreign cities where pro- visions have been made for keeping bodies unburied until advancing decomposition places death beyond a doubt, sur- rounding them meanwhile with every appliance available for assisting resuscitation. Not a case is on record, however, of revival from trance or any other supposed counterfeit of death during all these years. There are a number of more or less positive proofs of death : — 1 . The breathing has stopped : there is no movement of the chest ; the sound of the air passing in and out is absent, and there is no watery vapor proceeding from the mouth. 2. The heart has stopped: there is no pulse; the move- ments and sounds of the heart have ceased, and the veins do not become swollen upon making pressure between them and the heart. 3. The blood in the veins becomes clotted. 4. The red color in semi-transparent parts disappears. 5. The warmth of the body is replaced by coldness. 6. The muscles of the body relax at first and then become stiff usually in from five to six hours, remaining so for from sixteen to twenty-four hours. 7. There are no signs of rusting on a bright steel needle after plunging it deeply into the tissues. 8. Electricity has no effect upon the contraction of the muscles. 9. Decomposition of the tissues sets in, as is shown by the odor and the greenish blue discoloration, usually appearing first on the abdomen. The fact of the breathing having stopped may be deter- mined in two ways : (a) If the movements of the chest have absolutely ceased, there will be no movement in a glass of water, or better, a cup of quicksilver set upon the chest. (d) The absence of watery vapor proceeding from the mouth may be shown by holding a looking-glass or a bit of brightly polished metal, such as a razor-blade, over the mouth ; if any breath proceeds from the lungs, it will be shown by the 236 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS collection of some drops of moisture upon the reflecting surface. The cessation of the heart's action may be shown by tying a string rather tightly around a finger ; if the person is living, the end of the finger will become reddened by the collection of blood beyond the string, and the removal of the string will leave a white line about the finger at that point. When the body has become cold and, beyond all question, when decomposition has set in, death has occurred. CHAPTER XXVII THE EMERGENCIES OF THE BATTLE-FIELD In no place is the demand for prompt attention to emergen- cies greater than on the battle-field. And with the progress of civilization, efforts to meet this demand have grown more systematic, until at the present time aid to the injured on the battle-field is rendered by thoroughly organized corps con- sisting of four classes: (1) Medical officers, (2) the hospital corps, (3) civilian assistants, including female nurses, the vari- ous volunteer organizations for first aid, etc., and (4) the soldiers themselves, each one of whom is taught the applica- tion of the elements of first aid to himself and his comrades. The medical officers comprise all those connected with an army, and include (1) the surgeons and assistant-surgeons attached to regiments, and (2) the medical officers of the general staff, who administer the field- and permanent hos- pitals, etc. In the organization of the army, the work of the hospital corps was formerly assisted by " company bearers," or privates detailed — four to each company — from the line. This feat- ure of first aid work has now been abandoned, the training of the entire command in extemporaneous wound treatment be- SANITARY SOLDIERS 237 ing substituted. Each company is allowed two litters, and a certain amount of litter drill also forms a part of the training of every soldier. The hospital corps is a distinct organization, consisting of men whose duties are limited entirely to sanitary work, and is consequently of much greater importance in the care of the sick and wounded. Its members are selected because of their conspicuous adaptability to the peculiar duties of the corps. They must be brave and active, strong and gentle, and pos- sessed of presence of mind and inventive faculty sufficient to meet the varying emergencies of succor to the injured. The uniform of the hospital corps is similar to that of other enlisted men, the trimmings being of maroon. They wear a caduceus em- broidered in maroon silk, with a white border on both sleeves mid- way between the elbow and shoulder, and the cap ornament is a caduceus in gilt metal. The articles of the Geneva Convention prohibit the bearing of arms by those who come under its provisions ; consequently the hospital corps is unarmed except when engaged with an enemy who does not recognize the Geneva Convention, in which case the men carry re- volvers. The titles of the enlisted men of the hospital corps were by Act of Congress in 1903 changed to (1) sergeant, hospital corps, first class ; (2) sergeant, hospital corps ; (3) corporal, hospital corps ; (4) private, first class, hospital corps ; (5) private, hospital corps. The proper chevrons are worn to indicate the several grades. In case of active hostilities, the hospital corps is present with the troops in the proportion of five per cent of the a gg re g ate strength of the command — a proportion which experience has shown to best supply the needs of the removal and care of the injured. To every ten privates of the hospital corps there should be a hospital corporal, and to every thirty privates there should be a hospital sergeant. The privates of the hospital corps are divided in the field into ambulance companies and hospital companies with the full company organization of an infantry company. The am- bulance companies have to do principally with the transpor- tation of the disabled by litter and by wheeled vehicles ; while the hospital companies are attached to the brigade or division hospitals, and are concerned principally with the nursing of the sick, police of the grounds, and other work demanded in hospital. The ambulance companies habitually 238 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS encamp near the field hospital, with the ambulance and wagon train in the immediate vicinity. The hospital companies form a part of the hospital itself. The companies are com- manded by officers of the medical department, assigned to that duty. In addition to those who are formed into com- panies, each regiment is allowed a detachment of four non- commissioned officers and twelve privates. 1 To the hospital corps is committed the care of the sick and wounded after they are brought to the first dressing-stations, and except by special assignment of competent military authority no others are permitted to take or accompany sick men to the rear, either on the march or upon the field of battle. They perform all the duties connected with their corps at various points, under the direction of their officers, and after an action or upon the completion of any special duty, they rendezvous at the camp near the division hospital. The non-commissioned officers are mounted in the field, and all the men are mounted when serving with mounted commands. A mounted private of the hospital corps, carrying, slung over his left shoulder, an orderly pouch consisting of a canvas bag containing the articles inven- toried on page 301, together with a canteen of water, and such other dressings and appliances as may be considered necessary, accompanies every medical officer in the field. The medical officer carries, slung across his shoulder, a field case of instruments sufficient with ingenuity and intelligence to perform almost any operation that may be required. The equipment of the privates of the hospital corps in the field, aside from the orderlies, consists of a hospital corps pouch, the contents of 1 In connection with the National Guard and State Forces it is often imprac- ticable to organize a distinct hospital corps, and in this case the company bearers may be utilized in the formation of a corps, which may not only form the nucleus of a hospital corps in case of active hostilities, but also provide for the safety of the community a body of men well instructed in meeting ordinary medical emer- gencies. This should be formed by the detail of four men from each company, of whom a proper proportion should be non-commissioned officers. For a regiment of ten companies the sanitary corps should be formed (1) from the regimental staff by the Surgeon, the Assistant-Surgeon, and the Hospital Sergeant, who will act in the capacity of first sergeant ; (2) from the companies, by one sergeant, four corporals, and thirty-five privates. For a regiment of twelve companies, the sanitary corps should be formed (1) from the regimental staff by the Surgeon, the Assistant Surgeons, and the Hospital Sergeant, who will act in the capacity of first sergeant ; (2) from the companies, by two sergeants, four corporals, and forty-two privates. Such an organization, when properly instructed in anatomy and physiology, in aid in medical and surgical emergencies, and in the carriage of the disabled, will form a very satisfactory peace substitute for a hospital corps. SANITARY ORGANIZATION IN BATTLE 239 which are detailed upon page 300, a webbing litter sling, and a canteen of water, to which is added the blanket and shelter tent, suitably rolled, when in heavy marching order. The work of the hospital corps in the field is attended with some immunity by the provisions of the Articles of the Geneva Convention, which have been adopted by nearly all civilized nations. The articles provide for the neutrality of field and permanent hospitals, of all their attendants, and of members of the hospital corps, — not of company bearers, — and permit the staff of hospitals to continue their labors after the occupation of the country by an enemy, or to pass unmo- lested to their own commands. The sick are protected, those caring for them are rewarded by protection, and wounded prisoners, when cured, are returned to their own country on parole. A flag having a red cross on a white field insures the safety of hospitals, while a white brassard on the left arm, also bearing a red cross, protects the members of the sanitary corps. During an engagement, the regimental hospital corps de- tachments, together with such privates of the line as may be designated to assist them, render first aid to the injured on the line of battle, under the supervision of the medical officer on duty at that point. Here the regimental detachments, with the details from the ambulance and hospital corps companies, when they shall have arrived, take measures to prevent immediate danger from wounds, not, however, attempting any operations. To each case is affixed a diagnosis tag, consisting of a white centre, with a red stripe on one edge and a blue stripe on the other, the stripes being attached to the centre by perforations so that they can be easily torn off. The centre contains space for writing the diagnosis upon one side, and the treatment given upon the other. The removal of both stripes indicates that the patient is able to walk ; if the blue stripe only is left, the patient requires to be carried away, and if only the red stripe remains, the patient must not be moved. In order to save time, certain characters are prescribed to abbreviate the notes upon the tags, which, in time of battle, is naturally very essential. If the case requires immediate action, a tag with "urgent " in blue letters is also attached. Immediate danger having been temporarily forestalled by the attention given on the line of battle, the bearers — of the hospital corps, or of the company, if the former have not arrived, or both, if the demand is too great to be satisfied by the hospital corps alone — place the wounded upon litters, if 240 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS they are unable to walk, and carry them back to the next point. If the injured are able to walk alone or with the assist- ance of a single helper, they are not carried. Fig 14 . — The Work of the First Line. From a photograph taken on board the United States Hospital Ship Missouri. The next point of relief, as well as all the remaining points, is to be located by the medical director of the army corps, or the senior medical officer present. It is the first dressing- station, and is situated as near the line of battle as possible, consistent with safety. When the troops are fighting behind fortified works, it may be on the line of battle itself. In any case no attempt is made to place it beyond the range of artillery fire, but it should be so placed as not to be affected by ordinary rifle fire, and in as sheltered a spot as possible. To this point are brought or sent all wounded men. Here are performed all urgent operations, and here the wounded are prepared for conveyance to the field hospitals. The. importance of this station is recognized by the sur- geons of the present day, among whom the character of the first dressing is considered to be of paramount importance. Whence the necessity of surgical assistance at this point, ample both in amount and in skill, will be evident. The first dressing-station is established early during the FIRST AID ON THE BATTLE-FIELD 2/j.I engagement by men of the hospital corps under the direction of the medical officers, care being taken not to locate it at a point where it will be in the way of the manoeuvres of the combatants-. This having been done, the men provide water and straw, prepare the dressings, and when required assist in the removal of the wounded. This is the point beyond which the company bearers cannot pass. After depositing their charges they are required to return to the front. When the line of battle is of considerable length and large bodies of troops are engaged, there are a number of these stations, varying according to the necessities of the case, certainly not less than one to each brigade. The wounded having received proper immediate treatment, they are now to be transported to the field hospitals. At a point as near the first dressing-station as possible the ambu- lances rendezvous for this purpose. This point is the ambu- lance station, and the injured are borne to this point upon hand-litters. Where the character of the country is such as to permit it, the ambulances may be driven directly to the first dressing-station, thus obviating the necessity of having a separate station. In removing a man, care is taken to send with him his arms and accoutrements, always seeing that his piece is discharged before placing it in the ambulance. At the ambulance station tents are pitched and arrangements made for the temporary accommodation of the wounded as they are brought in from the first dressing-stations. Attend- ants are at hand with hot drinks and other means of relieving suffering. Medical officers are present to inspect the patients and make it sure that they are in a suitable condition to be forwarded ; dressings are altered if necessary, and other at- tentions, the need of which may have been overlooked at the first dressing-station, are given. The three points now enumerated all lie near the line of battle, and are all included in the phrase the first line of medical assistance. The combination is also known as the service of the front. An important part of the duty of the hospital corps stationed at the front is the careful examination of the field after an CARE OF WOUNDED IN BATTLE 243 engagement, to see if any wounded men remain uncared for, or to ascertain if any men supposed to be dead still show signs of life. If there is simply a cessation of hostilities due to the nightfall, the search is greatly facilitated by the use of the electric search-light (Fig. 142), and where one is not present, lanterns must be used. The fourth point is the field hospital or division hospital, still further to the rear. The field hospitals form the second hue of medical assistance. They are located by the medical director at points decided upon in consultation with the com- manding general. A field hospital should, be two or three miles to the rear of the dressing-stations, and should be more permanently organised. The duties of the hospital corps here are multifarious, and consist in arranging the beds for the wounded, assisting the surgeons in operating and in applying dressings, administering stimulants to this man, and sedatives to that one, caring for the belongings of the patients, and maintaining order in the hospital — meeting all the innu- merable emergencies which necessarily arise at such a time. The hospital sergeant in charge of the stores will have estab- lished his kitchen at a suitable point, and his cooks will be engaged in preparing not only the necessaries for the sick, but the food for the attendants. The hospital sergeant in charge of the medicine wagon will have abundant occupation in putting up such medicines as may be demanded, while those to whom is assigned the care of instruments and dressings will have no time to spare. A guard is mounted and the hospital property patrolled to prevent injury to its occupants or loss of property. The field hospitals are necessarily temporary in character, and the sick and wounded require more permanent quarters for their ultimate treatment. These are found in the third line of medical assistance, which consists of the stationary hospitals in the extreme rear, and includes the general hospi- tals located in the vicinity of the base of operations, and still farther to the rear, and includes hospital boats and hospital railway trains. The nursing and attendance at these points, as at others, falls upon the hospital corps with the assistance of volunteer male and female nurses. 244 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS In this way is provided a complete system of treatment for the sick and wounded, covering the entire period from their fall upon the battle-field to their recovery and discharge from the general hospital. CHAPTER XXVIII CARRYING THE DISABLED In carrying the disabled for short distances, a manufactured litter is to be used where practicable, consisting essentially of a bed long enough and wide enough to hold a man lying upon his back, and having along either side a pole projecting at each end for handles. The authorized litter of the United States Army, the result of the most careful experiment and prolonged experience, is shown in Figs. 170 to 180. The bed is of canvas, six feet long and twenty-two inches wide, with side poles seven and a half feet long, and four stirrup-shaped fixed strap-iron legs four inches high. This litter is described in detail on page 279. To the injured man the slightest movement may be preg- nant with excruciating agony. The least jar is productive of actual torture. A mere touch may cause him to shriek with pain. The chief aim, then, in carrying him is to move with such gentleness and care as to render the motion as nearly imperceptible as possible and certainly free from any jar. In order to accomplish this, there must be a perfect understand- ing among the several bearers, as to the course to be taken and the method to be adopted, and all must unite in perform- ing the movements in perfect unison. A well-defined uniform system of manipulating the injured, which may be perfectly understood by all participating in the movements, is then a prime requisite for success. The system of the United States Army is the result of a long series of experiments and care- ful comparison of the work of others during many years of study in peace and war by the entire medical and hospital corps, y and is the best yet devised. MILITARY DEFINITIONS 245 HOSPITAL CORPS DRILL REGULATIONS. Alignment. — A straight line upon which several men or bodies of troops are formed, or are to be formed. Base. — The element on which a movement is regulated. Center. — The middle point or element of a command. Column. — A formation in which the elements are placed one behind another. Deploy. — To extend the front. Depth. — The space from head to rear of any formation, including the leading and rear elements. Disposition. — The distribution of the fractions of a body of troops, and the formations and duties assigned to each, for the accomplish- ment of a desired end. Distance. — Space in the direction of depth. Drill. — The exercises and evolutions taught on the drill ground. Echelon. — A formation in which the subdivisions are placed one behind another, extending beyond and unmasking one another, either wholly or in part. In battle formation, this term is also employed to designate the dif- ferent lines. Example: The first echelon, the firing line; the second echelon, the support. Element. — A file, squad, platoon, detachment, company, or larger body. Evolution. — A movement executed by several battalions, or larger units, for the purpose of passing from one formation to another. Facing distance. — Fourteen inches, i. e., the difference between the front of a man in ranks including his interval, and his depth. File. — Two men; the front-rank man and the corresponding man of the rear rank. The front-rank. man is the file leader. A file which has no rear-rank man is a blank file. The term "files" applies also to individual men in single-rank formation. File closers. — Officers and noncommissioned officers posted in rear of the line. Flank. — The right or left of a command in line or column; also, the element on the right or left of a line. In speaking of the enemy one says, " his right flank," " his left wing," •to indicate the flank or wing which the enemy would so designate. Flank attack. — A movement made against the enemy's flank. Flankers. — Men so posted or marched as to protect the flank of a column. Flank march. — A march, whatever the formation, by which troops move along the front of the enemy's position. Formation. — Arrangement of the elements of a command. The placing of all fractions in their order in line, in column, or for battle. 246 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Front. — The space, in width, occupied by a command, either in line or column. Front also denotes the direction of the enemy. Guide. — An officer, noncommissioned officer, or private, upon whom the command or fraction thereof regulates its march. Head. — The leading element of a column. Interval. — Space between elements of the same line. Left. — The left extremity or element of a body of troops. Line. — A formation in which the different elements are abreast of each other. Maneuver. — A movement made according to the nature of the ground with reference to the position and movements of the enemy. Order, close. — The normal formation in which soldiers are regularly arranged in line or column. Order, extended. — The formation in which the soldiers, or the sub- divisions, or both, are separated by intervals greater than in close order. Pace. — Thirty inches; the length of the full step in quick time. Ploy. — To diminish front. Point 0} rest. — The point at which a formation begins. Rank. — A line of men placed side by side. Right. — The right extremity or element of a body of troops. Scouts. — Men detailed to precede a command on the march and when forming for battle, to gather and report information concerning the enemy and the nature of the ground. Tactics. — The art of handling troops in the presence of the enemy. Turning movement. — An extended movement around the enemy's flank for the purpose of threatening or attacking his flank or rear. Wing. — The portion of a command from the center to the flank; the battalion is the smallest body which is divided into wings. GENERAL PRINCIPLES. 1. The interval between men in a rank is 4 inches; the distance between ranks is 40 inches in both line and column. The allowance for the front of a man is taken at about 26 inches, including the interval; the depth, about 12 inches. To secure uniformity of interval between files, when falling in and in alignments, each man places the palm of the left hand upon the hip, fingers pointing downward. In the first case the hand is dropped by the side when the man next on the left has his interval; in the second case, at the command front. 2. Distance is measured from the back of the man in front to the breast of the man in rear. The distance between subdivisions in column is measured from guide to guide. MILITARY GENERAL PRINCIPLES 247 The distance between commands in column is measured from the rear guide of the preceding to the leading guide of the following com- mand. 3. The interval between men is measured from elbow to elbow; between companies, detachments, squads, etc., from the left elbow of the left man, or guide, of the group on the right to the right elbow of the right man, or guide, of the group on the left. 4. Movements that may be executed toward either flank are ex- plained as toward but one flank, it being necessary to substitute the word "left" for "right," and the reverse, to have the explanation of the corresponding movement toward the other flank. The commands are given for the execution of the movements toward either flank. The substitute word of the command is placed within parentheses. 5. In movements where the guide may be either right, left, or center, it is indicated in the command thus: Guide (right, left, or center). 6. Any movement may be executed either from the halt or when marching, if not otherwise prescribed. 7. Any movement not specially excepted may be executed in double time. If the movement be from the halt, or when marching in quick time, the command double time precedes the command march; if march- ing in double time, the command double time is omitted. To hasten the execution of a movement begun in quick time the command: 1. Double time, 2. March, may be given; only those units that have not completed the movement take up the double time. 8. There are two kinds of commands: The preparatory command, such as forward, indicates the movement that is to be executed. The command of execution, such as March, Halt, or Arms, causes the execution. Preparatory commands are distinguished by italics, those of execu- tion by Capitals. Where it is not mentioned in the text who gives the commands pre- scribed, they are to be given by the instructor. The preparatory command should be given at such an interval of time before the command of execution as to admit of its being properly understood; the command of execution should be given at the instant the movement is to commence. The tone of command is animated, distinct, and of a loudness pro- portioned to the number of men under instruction. Each preparatory command is enunciated distinctly and pronounced in an ascending tone of voice, but always in such a manner that the command of execution may be more energetic and elevated. The command of execution is firm in tone and brief. When giving commands to troops it is usually best to face toward them. 248 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Indifference in giving commands must be avoided, as it leads to laxity in execution. Commands should be given with spirit at all times. 9. To secure uniformity, officers and noncommissioned officers should be practiced in giving commands. 10. The signals should be frequently used in instruction, in order that the officers and men may readily recognize them. 11. In the different schools the posts of the officers and noncom- missioned officers are specified, but as instructors they go wherever their presence is necessary. As file closers it is their duty to rectify mistakes and insure steadiness and promptness in the ranks. 12. To revoke a preparatory command, or, being at a halt, to begin anew a movement improperly begun, the instructor commands: As You Were, at which the movement ceases and the former position is resumed. 13. To stay the execution of a movement, when marching, for the correction of errors, the instructor commands: 1. In place, 2. Halt, when all halt and stand fast. To resume the movement he commands: 1. Resume, 2. March. 14. The instructor always maintains a military bearing, and by a quiet, firm demeanor sets a proper example to the men. 15. Short and frequent drills are preferable to long ones, which ex- haust the attention. SIGNALS. 16. Forward. — Raise the arm until horizontal, extended to the front; at the same time move to the front. Right oblique. — Raise the arm until horizontal, extended obliquely to the right; at the same time move in that direction. Left oblique. — Same to the left. By the right flank. — Raise the arm until horizontal, extended to the right; at the same time move to the right. By the left flank. — Same to the left. To the rear. — Face to the rear, raise the arm until horizontal, ex- tended to the rear; at the same time move to the rear. To change direction to the right (left). — Raise the left (right) arm until horizontal, extended toward the marching flank, carry the arm to the front; at the same time turn and move in the direction to be taken. Halt. — Raise the arm vertically to its full extent. Assemble. — Raise the arm vertically to its full extent and slowly describe small horizontal circles. SCHOOL OF THE SOLDIER 249 SCHOOL OF THE SOLDIER. 17. The instructor briefly explains each movement, at first executing it himself if practicable. He requires the recruits to take by themselves the proper positions and does not touch them for the purpose of correcting them, except when they are unable to correct themselves; he avoids keeping them too long at the same movement, although each should be understood before passing to another. He exacts by degrees the desired position and uniformity. 18. As the instruction progresses the recruits are grouped according to proficiency, in order that all may advance as rapidly as their abilities permit. Those who lack aptitude and quickness are separated from the others and placed under experienced drill masters. 19. A few recruits, usually not exceeding four, are placed in a single rank, facing to the front and about 4 inches apart, arranged according to height, the tallest man on the right. 20. To teach the recruits to assemble, the instructor requires them to place the palm of the left hand upon the hip, below the belt when worn; he then places them on the same line so that the right arm of each man rests lightly against the left elbow of the man next on his right, and then directs the left hands to be replaced by the side. 21. When the recruits have learned how to take their places, the instructor commands: Fall In. They assemble rapidly, as above prescribed, at attention, each man dropping the left hand as soon as the man next on his left has his interval. POSITION OF THE SOLDIER, OR ATTENTION. 22. Heels on the same line, and as near each other as the conforma- tion of the man permits. Feet turned out equally, and forming with each other an angle of about 60 degrees. Knees straight without stiffness. Body erect on the hips, inclined a little forward; shoulders square and falling equally. Arms and hands hanging naturally, backs of the hands outward; little fingers opposite the seams of the trousers ; elbows near the body . Head erect and square to the front; chin slightly drawn in without constraint; eyes straight to the front. -THE RESTS. 23. Being at a halt, the commands are: Fall Out; Rest; At Ease; and, 1. Parade, 2. Rest. 250 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS At the command fall out, the men may leave the ranks, but remain in the immediate vicinity. They resume their former places at atten- tion, at the command fall in. At the command rest, each man keeps one foot in place, but is not required to preserve silence or immobility. At the command at ease, each man keeps one foot in place and pre- serves silence, but not immobility. 1. Parade, 2. Rest. Carry the right foot 6 inches straight to the rear, left knee slightly bent; clasp the hands without constraint, in front of the center of the body, fingers joined, left hand uppermost, left thumb clasped by thumb and forefinger of right hand; preserve silence and steadiness of position. 24. To resume the attention: 1. Squad, 2. Attention. The men take the position of the soldier and fix their attention. TO DISMISS THE SQUAD. 25. Being in line at a halt: Dismissed. EYES RIGHT OR LEFT. 26. 1. Eyes, 2. Right (Left), 3. Front. At the command, right, turn the head to the right so as to bring the left eye in a line abcut two inches to the right of the center of the body, eyes fixed on the line of eyes of the men in, or supposed to be in, the same rank. At the command front, turn the head and eyes to the front. PACINGS. 27. To the flank: 1. Right {Left), 2. Face. Raise slightly the left heel and right toe, face to the right, turning on the right heel, assisted by a slight pressure on the ball of the left foot; place the left foot by the side of the right. Left face is executed on the left heel. " To face in marching" and advance, turn on the ball of either foot and step off with the other foot in the new line of direction; to face in marching without gaining ground in the new direction, turn on the ball of either foot and mark time. To the rear: 1. About, 2. Face. SCHOOL OF THE SOLDIER 251 Raise slightly the left heel and right toe, face to the rear, turning to the right on the right heel and the ball of the left foot; replace the left foot by the side of the right. Officers execute the about face as follows: At the command about, carry the toe of the right foot about 8 inches to the rear and 3 inches to the left of the left heel without changing the position of the left foot. At the command face, face to the rear, turning to the right on the left heel and right toe; replace the right heel by the side of the left. Enlisted men out of ranks may use the about face prescribed for officers. SALUTE WITH THE HAND. 28. 1. Right (Left) hand, 2. Salute. Raise the right hand smartly till the tip of the forefinger touches the lower part of the head-dress (if un- covered, the forehead) above the right eye, thumb and forefingers extended and joined, palm to the left, forearm inclined at about 45 degrees, hand and wrist straight. (Two) Drop the arm smartly by the side. The salute for officers is the same; the left hand is used only when the right is engaged. Offi- cers and men, when saluting, look toward the person saluted. SETTING-UP EXERCISES. 29. All soldiers are regularly practiced in the following exercises, which may be supplemented by those in authorized calisthenic manuals. The instructor places the men three paces apart. In these exercises it is advisable to remove blouses and caps. As soon as the exercises are well understood, they may be continued without repeating the Fig. 143 (Par. 28).— commands. For this purpose the instructor Salute with the gives the commands as prescribed, then Hand, adds: Continue the exercise, upon which the motions to be repeated are continuously executed until the com- mand halt. At the command halt, given at any time, the position of the soldier is resumed. 252 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS First exercise. i. Arm, 2. Exercise, 3. Head, 4. Up, 5. Down, 6. Raise. At the command exer- cise, raise the arms lat- erally until horizontal, palms upward. Head: Raise the arms in a circu- Fig. 144 (Par. 29). — First Exercise. Fig. 145 (Par. 29).— First Exercise. lar direction over the head, tips of fingers touching top of the head, backs of fingers in con- tact their full length, thumbs pointing to the rear, elbows pressed back. Up: Extend the arms upward their full length, palms touching. Down: Force the arms obliquely back and gradually let them fall by the sides. Raise: Raise the arms lat- erally as prescribed for the second command Continue by repeating head, up, down, raise. Second exercise. :'•' 1. Arms vertical, palms to the front, 2. Raise, 3. Down, 4. Up. At the command raise, raise the arms laterally from the sides, extended to their full length, till the hands meet above the head, palms to the front, Fig. 146 (Par. 29).— fingers pointing upward, thumbs locked, right First Exercise. thumb in front, shoulders pressed back. Down: SCHOOL OF THE SOLDIER 253 •Second Fig. 147 (Par. 29).- Second Exercise. Bend over till the hands, if possible, touch the ground, keeping the arms and knees straight. Up : Straighten the body and swing the extended arms (thumbs locked) to the vertical position. Continue by repeating down, up. Third exercise. 1. Arm, 2. Exercise, 3. Front, 4. Rear. At the command exercise, raise the arms laterally until horizontal, palms upward. Front: Swing the ex- tended arms horizontally to the front, palms touch- ing. Rear: Swing the ex- tended arms well to the rear, inclining them slightly downward, raising the body upon the toes. Continue by repeating front, rear, till the men, if possible, are able to touch the backs of the hands be- hind the back. Fig. 148 (Par. 29). Exercise Fig. 149 (Par. 29). Exercise. Fourth Exercise. 1. Leg, 2. Exer- cise, 3. Up. At the command ex- ercise, place the palms of the hands on the hips, fingers to the front, thumbs to the Fig. rear, elbows pressed back. Up: Raise the left leg to the front, bending and elevating the knee as much as possible, leg from knee to instep vertical, toe depressed. L t p: Replace the left foot and raise the right leg as prescribed -Third for the left. Execute slowly at first, then gradually in- 150 (Par. 29).— Fourth Exercise. 254 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS crease to the cadence of double time. Continue by repeating up when the right and left legs are alternately in position. Fifth exercise. i. Leg, 2. Exercise, 3. Left (Right), 4. Forward, 5. Rear; or 5. Ground. At the command exercise, place the hands on the hips, as in fourth exercise. Forward: Move the left leg to the front, knee straight, so as to advance the foot about 15 inches, toe turned out, sole nearly horizontal, body balanced on right foot. Rear: Move the leg to the rear, knee straight, toe on a line with the right heel, sole nearly hori- zontal. Continue by repeating forward, rear. When the recruit has learned to balance himself, the command forward is followed by Ground: Throw the weight of the body for- ward by rising on the ball of the right foot, advance and plant the left heel 30 inches from the right, and advance the right leg quickly to the position of forward. Continue by repeating ground when the right and left legs are alternately in the position of forward. Sixth exercise. 1. Lung, 2. Exercise, 3. Inhale, 4. Exhale. At the command exercise, place the hands on the hips, as in fourth exercise. Inhale: Innate the lungs to full capacity by short, suc- cessive inhalations through the nose. Exhale: Empty the lungs by a continuous exhalation through the mouth. Continue by repeating inhale, exhale. STEPS AND MARCHINGS Quick time. 30. The length of the full step in quick time is 30 inches, measured from heel to heel, and the cadence is at the rate of one hundred and twenty steps per minute. * . 31. To march in quick time: 1. Forward, 2. March. At the command forward, throw the weight of the body upon the right leg, left knee straight. At the command march, move the left foot smartly, but without jerk, straight forward 30 inches from the right, measuring from heel to heel, sole near the ground; straighten and turn the knee slightly STEPS AND MARCHINGS 255 out; at the same time throw the weight of the body forward and plant the foot without shock, weight of body resting upon it; next, in like manner, advance the right foot and plant it as above; continue the march. The cadence is at first given slowly, and gradually increased to that of quick time. . The arms hang naturally, the hands moving about 6 inches to the front and 3 inches to the rear of the seam of the trousers. 32. The instructor, when necessary, indicates the cadence of the step by calling one, two, three, four; or left, right, the instant the left and right foot, respectively, should be planted. This rule is general. Double time. 33. The length of the full step in double time is 36 inches; the cadence is at the rate of one hundred and eighty steps per minute. 34. To march in double time: 1. Forward, 2. Double time, 3. March. At the command forward, throw the weight of the body on the right leg. At the command march, raise the hands until the forearms are hori- zontal, fingers closed, nails toward the body, elbows to the rear; carry forward the left foot, knee slightly bent and somewhat raised, and plant the foot 36 inches from*the right; then execute the same motion with the right foot; continue this alternate movement of the feet, throw- ing the weight of the body forward and allowing a natural swinging motion to the arms. If marching in quick time, the command forward is omitted. At the command march, given as either foot strikes the ground, take one step in quick, and then step off in double time. To resume the quick time: 1. Quick time, 2. March. At the command march, given as either foot strikes the ground, advance and plant the other foot in double time, resume the quick time, dropping the hands by the sides. Recruits are also exercised in running, the principles being the same as for double time. When marching in double time and in running, the men breathe as much as possible through the nose, keeping the mouth closed. Distances of 100 and 180 yards are marked on the drill ground, and noncommissioned officers and men practiced in keeping correct cadence and length of pace in both quick and double time. 35. To arrest the march in quick or double time: 1. Squad, 2. Halt. 256 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS At the command halt, given as either foot strikes the ground, advance and plant the other foot; place the foot in rear by the side of the other. If in double time, drop the hands by the sides. The halt, while marking time, and marching at the half step, side step, and back step, is executed by the same commands. To mark time. 36. Being in march: 1. Mark time, 2. March. At the command march, given as either foot strikes the ground, advance and plant the other foot; bring up the foot in rear, and con- tinue the cadence by alternately raising and planting each foot on line with the other. The feet are raised about 4 inches from the ground and planted with the same energy as when advancing. To resume the full step: 1. Full step, 2. March. Hal} step. 37. Being in march: 1. Half step, 2. March. At the command march, given as either foot strikes the ground, take steps of 15 inches. To resume the full step: 1. Full step, 2. March. The length of the half step in double time is 18 inches. Side step. 38. Being at a halt: 1. Right {Left) step, 2. March. Carry and plant the right foot 10 inches to the right; bring the left foot beside it and continue the movement in cadence of quick time. The side step is used for small intervals only and is not executed in double time. Back step. 39. Being at a halt: 1. Backward, 2. March. At the command march, step back with the left foot 15 inches straight to the rear, then with the right, and so on, the feet alternating. At the command halt, bring back the foot in front to the side of the one in the rear. The back step is used for short distances only, and it is not executed in double time. ARMY HOSPITAL CORPS MARCHINGS 257 To march by the flank. 40. Being in march: 1. By the right {left) flank, 2. March. At the command march, given as the right foot strikes the ground, advance and plant the left foot, then face to the right in marching, and step off in the new direction with the right foot. To march to the rear. 41. Being in march: 1 . To the rear, 2 . March. At the command march, given as the right foot strikes the ground, advance and plant the left foot; then, turning on the balls of both feet, face to the right-about and immediately step off with the left foot. If marching in double time, turn to the right-about, taking four steps in place, keeping the cadence, and then step off with the left foot, Change step. 42. Being in march: 1. Change step, 2. March. At the command march, given as the right foot strikes the ground, advance and plant the left foot; plant the toe of the right foot near the heel of the left and step off with the left foot. The change on the right foot is similarly executed, the command march being given as the left foot strikes the ground. Covering and marching on points. 43. The instructor selects two points and requires the recruits, in succession, to place themselves upon the prolongation of the straight line through these points and then to march upon them in both quick and double time. It should be demonstrated to the recruits that they can not march in a straight line without selecting two points in the desired direction and keeping them covered while advancing. A distant and conspicuous landmark is next selected as a point of direction; the recruit is required to choose two intermediate points in line with the point of direction and to march upon it by covering these points, new points being selected as he advances. ^ EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS EQUIPMENT. 44. Hospital Corps, personal equipment: For privates first class and privates: — Hospital Corps pouch. Waist belt and knife, first-aid packet. Canteen. Haversack and field mess furniture. Shelter half, poles and pins. Blanket roll. Pouches are worn with all uniforms, suspended from the left shoulder to the rear over the right hip. In the field, medical officers' orderlies carry orderlies' pouches, and not hospital corps pouches. The rear sling of the pouch is passed under the belt. The field equipment includes all the articles listed above. The haversack and canteen are sus- pended from the right shoulder to the rear over the left hip, and the tin cup hung from the flap strap of the haversack. The knife is hung from the belt on the left side. The first-aid packet is attached to the belt. The blanket is worn over the shoulder. If required, a revolver is car- ried at the belt on the right and a cartridge pouch on the left. The field equipment for non- commissioned officers is the same as that of privates first class and privates, except that they carry emergency cases instead of pouches. BLANKET ROLL. Fig. 151 (Par. 44).— 45- The following articles, to- Fig. 152 (Par. 44).— Private with gether with the overcoat, are Private with Equipment.* packed in the blanket roll, which Equipment.* is carried in the manner used by the infantry. When desirable the rolls may be carried in a wagon or even in an ambulance. When the soldier is mounted, the saddle is packed as described in par. 49. * Blanket roll not shown. ARMY HOSPITAL CORPS EQUIPMENT 2 59 Contents. — One flannel shirt, one undershirt, one pair drawers, two pair socks, one towel, piece of soap, comb, hairbrush, toothbrush, five shelter-tent pegs, two shelter-tent poles. The roll is packed as follows: Each man with his shelter half smoothly spread on the ground, with buttons up and triangular end to the front, folds his blanket once across its length and places it upon the shelter half; fold toward the bottom, edge \ inch from the square end, the same amount of canvas uncovered at the top and bottom. He then places the parts of the pole on the side of the blanket next the square end of the shelter half, near and parallel to the fold, end of pole about 6 inches from the edge of the blanket; nests the pins similarly near the opposite edge of the blanket and distributes the other articles carried in the roll; folds the triangular end and then the exposed portion of the bottom of the shelter half over the blanket. The two men 'in each squad roll and fasten first the roll of number one and then of num- ber two. The file closers work similarly, two and two. Each pair stands on the folded side, rolls the blanket roll closely and buckles the straps, passing the end of the strap through both keeper and buckle, back over the buckle and under the keeper. With the roll so lying on the ground that the edge of the shelter half can just be seen when looking vertically downward, one end is bent upward and over beneath the other, a clove hitch is taken with the guy rope, first around the end to which it is attached and then around the other end, adjusting the length of rope between hitches so suit the wearer. ♦Blanket roll not shown. Fig. 153 (Par. 44).— Medical Officer's Orderly with Equipment.* Fig. 154 (Par. 44) — Medical Officer's Orderly with Equipment.* 260 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS METHOD OF PACKING PERSONAL EQUIPMENT ON SADDLE. To roll the overcoat. 46. Spread the overcoat with the inside down, fold the sleeves square across, the cuff touching at the back seam; turn the tail under about 9 inches, the folded edge perpendicular to the back seam; fold over the front edges of the coat and skirt, to form a rectangle no more than 34 inches across, according to the size of the coat; roll tightly from the collar with the hands and knees, and bring over the whole roll that part of the skirt which was turned under, thus binding the roll. To roll the bed blanket and shelter tent. 47. The blanket measures 72 by 84 inches. Spread the shelter tent and turn under one end about 10 inches. Fold the blanket to three thicknesses across the shorter edge; the fold then measures 24 inches wide; place the blanket thus folded across the middle of the shelter tent, the end of the folded blanket about one inch above the folded edge of the tent; fold the side parts of the tent over the blanket; roll tightly from the exposed end of the blanket with the hands and knees and bring over the whole roll the part of the tent that was turned under, thus binding the roll. On account of the inelasticity of the canvas it will be found neces- sary, just before turning over the part which binds the roll, to spread the canvas a little where it folds inside, at the end of the roll. Articles 0} Horse equipment. 48. Saddle, curb bridle, watering bridle, halter, saddle blanket, saddlebags, currycomb, horse brush, surcingle, picket pin, lariat, lariat strap, horse cover, nosebag, spurs, link straps, and hook. To pack the saddle. 49. Overcoat rolled as prescribed, and strapped on the pommel; blanket, with change of underclothing inside, is rolled in the shelter tent (the roll not to be less than 24, nor more than 28 inches in length, according to bulk); nosebag slipped over the roll outside of the shelter tent on the near end and the strap buckled over the off end; side lines when carried, to be spread over the blanket roll, the leather ends being brought together and the whole secured by the cantle straps; lariat rolled around the picket pin and snapped into the near cantle ring; canteen with cup on strap attached to off cantle ring; tin plate or meat can, knife, fork, and spoon in near saddlebag; currycomb, brush, and watering bridle in off saddlebag. ARMY HOSPITAL CORPS EQUIPMENT 26 1 Fig. 155 (Par. 49). — Hospital Corps Equipment, Mounted. Fig. 156 (Par. 49). — Hospital Corps Equipment, Mounted. 2^2 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Rations to be divided so as to equalize the weight in the saddlebags; also extra horseshoes (fitted) and nails (pointed) when on active service and separated from transportation. \\ hen the haversack is carried, the change of clothing may be placed in the saddlebags, and the haver- sack, with the rations, meat can, etc., will be carried on the near side and secured by passing the haversack strap over the blanket roll and under the off end; in this case the tin cup will be attached to the haversack. For field service, the lariat should be coiled and fastened with a thong to the near cantle ring (passing under the left stirrup strap), the free end snapped into the halter ring. Generally in field service, especially when the horse is low in flesh, the bed blanket should be folded and placed over the saddle blanket. Fig. 157 (Par. 50).- " Draw." Fig. 158 (Par. 50).— "Saber " — first movement. Fig. 159 (Par. 50).— " Saber " — second movement. MANUAL OF THE SABER FOR OFFICERS 50. 1. Draw, 2. Saber. At the command draw, unhook the saber with the thumb and first two fingers of the left hand, thumb on the end of the hook, fingers lifting the upper ring; grasp the scabbard with the left hand at the MANUAL OF THE SABER FOR OFFICERS 263 upper band, bring the hilt a little forward, seize the grip with the right hand, and draw the blade 6 inches out of the scabbard, pressing the scabbard against the thigh with the left hand. At the command saber, draw the saber quickly, raising the arm to its full extent to the right front, at an angle of about 45 degrees, with the horizontal, the saber, edge down, in a straight line with the arm; make a slight pause and bring the back of the blade against the shoulder, edge to the front, arm nearly extended, hand by the side, elbow back, third and fourth fingers back of the grip; at the game time hook up the scabbard with the thumb and first two fingers of the left hand, thumb through the upper ring, fingers supporting it; drop the left hand by the side. This is the position of carry saber dismounted. Officers unhook the scabbard before mounting; when mounted, in the first motion of draw saber, they reach with the right hand over the bridle hand and, without the aid of the bridle hand, draw the saber as before; the right hand at the carry rests on the right thigh. On foot, officers carry the scabbard hooked up. 51. When publishing orders, the saber is held suspended from the right wrist by the saber knot; when the saber knot is used, it is placed on the wrist before drawing saber, and taken off after returning saber. 52. Being at the order or carry: 1. Present, 2. Saber (or Arms). At the command present, raise and carry the saber to the front, base of the hilt as high as the chin and 6 inches in front of the neck, edge to the left, point 6 inches farther to the front than the hilt, thumb extended on the left of the grip, all the fingers grasping the grip. At the command saber (or arms), lower the saber, point in prolongation of the right foot, and near the ground, edge to the left, hand by the side, thumb on left of grip, arm extended. If mounted, the hand is held behind the thigh, point a little to the right and front of the stirrup. x j ■ 1 -.i j. «- Fig. 160 (Par. 52) — In rendering honors with troops, officers execute the first motion of the salute at the command pre- sent, the second motion at the command arms; enlisted men with the sword execute the first motion at the command arms and omit the second motion. 53. Being at a carry: 1. Order, 2. Saber (or Arms). 264 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Drop the point of the saber directly to the front, point on or near the ground, edge down, thumb on back of grip. Being at the present saber, should the next command be order arms, officers order saber; if the command be other than order arms, they execute carry saber. When arms are brought to the order, the of- ficers or enlisted men with the saber or sword drawn order saber. 54. The saber is held at the carry while giv- ing commands, marching, at attention, or chang- ing position in quick time. When at the order, sabers are brought to the carry when arms are brought to any position ex- cept the present or parade rest. 55. Being at the order: 1. Parade, 2. Rest. " Order Saber." Take the position of parade rest except that the left hand is uppermost and rests on the right hand, point of saber on or near the ground in front of the center of the body, edge to the right. At the command attention, resume the order saber and the position of the soldier. 56. In marching in double time, the saber is carried di- agonally across the breast, edge to the front; the left hand steadies the scabbard. 57. Officers on all duties under arms draw and return saber without waiting for command. All com- mands to soldiers under arms are given with the saber drawn. 58. Being at a carry: 1. Return, 2. Saber. At the command return, carry the right Fig. 163 (Par. 56).— hand opposite to and 6 inches from the left Position of Saber shoulder, saber vertical, edge to the left; in "Double Time." at the same time unhook and lower Fig. 162 (Par. 55).— "Parade Rest." HOSPITAL CORPS DETACHMENT DRILL 265 the scabbard with the left hand, and grasp it at the upper band. At the command saber, drop the point to the rear and pass the blade across and along the left arm; turn the head slightly to the left, fixing the eyes on the opening of the scabbard, raise the right hand, insert and return the blade; free the wrist from the saber knot (if inserted in it), turn the head to the front, drop the right hand by the side, hook up the scabbard with the left hand, drop the left hand by the side. Officers, mounted, return saber without using the left hand; the scabbard is hooked up on dismounting. 59. At inspection, enlisted men, with the sword drawn, execute the first motion of present saber, and turn the wrist to show both sides of the blade, re- suming the carry when the inspector has passed. SCHOOL OF THE DETACHMENT. 60. The senior medical officer of the detachment is held responsible for the theoretical and practical instruction of the officers, noncommissioned officers, privates first class, and privates, when their instruc- tion is not otherwise provided for by Army Regula- tions and General Orders. He requires the officers and noncommissioned officers to study and recite these regulations so that they can explain thoroughly every movement. The detachment, when formed, is in single rank, graduated in size, the 'tallest man on the right. Companies of instruction may be formed, maneuvered, mustered and inspected in accordance with Infantry Drill Regulations. Fig. 164 (Par. 58).— " Return." POSTS OF OFFICERS AND NONCOMMISSIONED OFFICERS. 61. The medical officer commanding is three paces in front of the center of the detachment; the junior medical officers, according to rank from right to left, are two paces in rear of the rank, in the line of file closers, and at equal intervals; if only one, he is opposite the center; if two, one is opposite the center of each half of the detachment; if three, one is opposite the center, the others as with two. The senior noncommissioned officer is two paces in rear of the second file from the right, on the right of the line of file closers. The second noncommissioned officer is on the right of the rank, and is right guide of the detachment. 266 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS The third noncommissioned officer is on the left of the rank, and is the left guide. The remaining noncommissioned officers are distributed along the line of file closers from right to left, according to rank. If necessary, a suitable private may be designated to act as right or left guide. TO FORM THE DETACHMENT. 62. At the signal for the assembly, the senior noncommissioned officer takes his position six paces in front of where the center of the detachment is to be, and facing it, commands: Fall In. The second noncommissioned officer, or a designated private, places himself, facing to the front, where the right of the detachment is to rest, and at such a point that its center will be six paces from and opposite to the senior noncommissioned officer. The men assemble rapidly at attention, securing the proper interval between files as described in par. 20. The other noncommissioned officers then take their posts. The senior noncommissioned officer calls the roll, each man answering "Here," as his name is called. TO SIZE THE DETACHMENT. 63. The men being in line as described, the senior noncommissioned officer faces them to the right and arranges them according to height, tall- est man in front; he then faces them to the left into line. The detach- ment being sized, habitually forms in the same order. 64. The senior noncommissioned officer commands: 1. Count, 2. Twos. At the command twos, all except the right file execute eyes right, and beginning on the right the men count one, two; and so on to the left. Each man turns his head and eyes to the front as he counts. The guides do not count. An odd man is ordinarily placed in the line of file closers. The senior noncommissioned officer then faces about, salutes the officer commanding, and reports " Sir, all present or accounted for," or the names of the unauthorized absentees, and without command takes his post, passing around the right flank. The officer command- ing places himself twelve paces in front of the center of and facing the detachment in time to receive the report of the senior noncommissioned HOSPITAL CORPS DETACHMENT DRILL 267 officer, whose salute he returns. The junior medical officers take their posts when the senior noncommissioned officer has reported. ALIGNMENTS. 65. The officer commanding having received the detachment com- mands: 1. Right {Left), 2. Dress, 3. Front. At the command dress, the men place the palm of the left hand upon the hip, execute eyes right, and dress up to the line; the officer commanding verifies the alignment. At the command front, each man turns the head and eyes to the front and drops the left hand by his side. In all alignments, excepting of the file closers, the left hand is placed upon the hip, and at front dropped to the side. The detachment is aligned whenever necessary. To take intervals. 66. Being in line at a halt: 1. To the right {left) take intervals, 2. March, 3. Detachment, 4. Halt. At the first command, the file closers step back to four paces distance from the rank; at the command march, all face to the right and the leading man of each rank steps off; the other men step off in succession so as to follow the preceding man at four paces. At the command halt, given when all have their intervals, all halt and face to the front. To assemble. 1. To the right {left) assemble, 2. March. The front rank man on the right stands fast, the file closer on the right closes to two paces. The other men face to the right, close by the shortest line and face to the front. MARCHINGS. To march in line. 67. Being in line at a halt: 1. Forward, 2. Guide right (or left), 3. March. The men step off, the guide marching straight to the front. 268 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS The instructor sees that the men preserve the alignment and the intervals toward the side of the guide. The men yield to pressure from that side and resist pressure from the opposite direction; by slightly shortening or lengthening the step they gradually recover the alignment, and by slightly opening out or closing in they gradually recover the interval, if lost; while habitually keeping the head to the front, they may occasionally glance toward the side of the guide to assure themselves of the alignment and interval, but the head is turned as little as possible for this purpose. To change the guide: Guide left (cr right). To march backward. 68. Being at a halt: i. Backward, 2. Guide right (or left), 3. March. To march to the rear. 69. Being in march: 1. To the rear, 2. March, 3. Guide right (or left). To march faced to the flank. 70. Being in line at a halt: 1. Right (Left), 2. Face, 3. Forward, 4. March. If marching: 1. By the right (left) flank, 2. March. The leading man is the guide. The other men follow at facing distance. To halt the detachment: 1. Detachment, 2. Halt; and to face to the front: 3. Left (Right), 4. Face; or, to march again to the front without halting: 1. By the left (right) flank, 2. March, 3. Guide right (or left). The oblique march. 71. Being in line: 1. Right (Left) oblique, 2. Mar«ch. Each man steps off in a direction 45 degrees to the right of his original front. He preserves his relative position, keeping his shoulders parallel HOSPITAL CORPS DETACHMENT DRILL 269 to those of the man next on his right, and so regulates his steps as to make the rank remain parallel to its original front. At the command halt, the men halt, faced to the front. To resume the original direction: 1.. Forward, 2. March, 3. Guide right (or left). The men half face to the left in marching and then move straight to the front. At half step or mark time while obliquing, the oblique march is resumed by the commands: 1. Full step, 2. March. In the oblique march the guide is, without indication, always on the side toward which the oblique is made. On resuming the direct march in line, the guide is announced. These rules are general. The column of files obliques by the same commands and means. To march in double time. 72. Being in line at a halt: r. Forward, 2. Guide right (or left), 3. Double time, 4. March. To pass from quick to double time and the reverse. 73. 1. Double time, 2. March. To resume quick time: 1. Quick time, 2. March. Marching in line, to effect a slight change of direction. 74. The command is: INCLINE TO THE RIGHT (LEFT). The guide gradually advances the left shoulder and marches in the new direction; all the files advance the left shoulder and conform to the movements of the guide, lengthening or shortening the step, according as the change is toward the side of the guide, or the side opposite. TURNINGS. To turn on fixed pivot. 75. Being in line at a halt: 1. Detachment right (left), 2. March, 3. Detachment, 4. Halt; or, 3. Full step, 4. March, 5. Guide right (or left). 270 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS At the second command, the right guide stands fast; the right file marks time turning to the right in his place; the other men, by twice obliquing to the right, place themselves successively abreast of the pivot and mark time. At the third command, the right guide places himself on the right of the rank. The fourth command is given when the last man arrives in his new position; the command halt I may be given at any time after c=££i / \ \ I f I' I ( Fig. 165 (Par. 75).— "Detachment Right." the movement begins, only those halt who are in the new position. All align themselves to the right without command. Being in march, the movement is executed by the same commands and in the same manner; the right guide halts and stands fast at the second command. To turn on moving pivot. 76. Marching in line: 1. Right {Left) turn, 2. March, 3. Full step, 4. March, 5. Guide right (or left) . At the second command, the right guide faces to the right in march- ing and takes the half step; the other men oblique to the right until opposite their places in line, execute a second right oblique and take the half step when abreast of the right guide. All take the full step at the fourth com- mand, which is given when the last man arrives in his f , ' , ' , ' , new position. s ,' ,' ''''*". Being at a halt, „ ^ ' , ^ " "- /-/-'/' the movement is ' , x ^ x ^ ^ " . -", -% * - '/ executed by the / .**'„',.'.'.''. V "- -_,'- - same commands .'■ ■ - ■ » and in the same Fig. 166 (Par. 76).— " Right Turn." manner. At the second command, the right guide faces to the right as in marching and steps off, taking the half step. Right (Left) half turn is executed in a similar manner. The right guide makes a half change of direction to the right and the other men make quarter changes in obliquing. S>S>S>S>^ □=) O m □ Fig. 168 (Par. 85).— " On Right into Line. detachment distance in the new direction, it halts and dresses to the right; the other twos successively halt and dress upon arriving in line. The command front is given when all are aligned. If the movement is executed toward the side opposite the file closers, each follows the two nearest him, passing in front of the following two. 86. To the front: i. Right (Left) front into line, 2. March 3. Detachment, 4. Halt, 5. Front. At the command march, the leading two moves to the front, dressing to the left; the guide in front places himself on its left; the other twos oblique to the right until opposite their places in line, when each marches to the front. At the command halt, given when the leading two has advanced detachment distance, it halts and dresses to the left. The other twos halt and dress to the left upon arriving in line; the rear guide takes his place on the right when the rear two arrives on the line. 274 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS IS1 1 | | I I I I | I I I I iso □ J Q' i lzk The command front is given when all are aligned. If the movement is toward the side of the file closers, they dart through the column as the oblique commences. If marching in double time, or in quick time and the com- mand be double time, the com- mand guide left is given im- mediately after the command march; the leading two moves to the front in quick time; the other twos move in double time, each taking the quick time and dressing to the left upon arriving in line. Being in line, to face or march to the rear. 87. 1. Twos right {left) about 2. March, 3. Detachment, 4 Halt; or, 3. Full step, 4 March, 5. Guide right (or left) Each two executes the about par. 83; the file closers dart through the nearest intervals. 88. The detachment at a halt may be moved a few paces to the rear by the commands: 1. About, 2. Face, 3. Forward, 4. Guide right (or left), 5. March. No other movement is executed until the line is faced to the original front. Marching in column of twos to form column of files. 89. 1. Right {Left) by file, 2. March. At the command march, the right files move forward; the left files mark time until disengaged, when they oblique to the right in full step and each follows the right file of his two at facing distance; the guides taking the same distance. A column of twos or files at a halt may be faced to the rear, or flank, and marched a short distance. No other movement is executed until the column is faced to the original front. The offi- cers and file closers face with the column and maintain their relative positions. Fig. 169 (Par. 86).^-" Right Front into Line." HOSPITAL CORPS DETACHMENT DRILL 275 Marching in column of files to form column of twos. 90. This movement is always executed away from the file closers. 1. Twos, 2. Left (Right) front into line, 3. March, 4. Full step, 5. March. At the third command, the leading file of each two takes the half step; the rear file of each two obliques to the left in full step until un- covered, moves up abreast of the leading file of his two and takes the half step. At the fifth command all resume the full step. To dismiss the detachment. 91. Being in line at a halt, the officer commanding directs the senior noncommissioned officer: Dismiss the detachment, and returns his salute. The officers fall out; the senior noncommissioned officer salutes, steps three paces to the front and two paces to the right of the detachment, faces to the left, and commands: Dismissed. MOVEMENTS BY PLATOONS. 92. Movements by platoons may be used by large detachments. This formation is often required for Hospital Corps detachments ap- pearing in parades and reviews, and on the march. If the rank is composed of less than twenty files the division into platoons is usually not necessary. When platoon movements are to be executed, the senior noncom- missioned officer makes the division into platoons immediately after twos are counted. The guides are assigned as follows: The second noncommissioned officer is the right guide of the first platoon, the third noncommissioned officer is the left guide of the second platoon, the fourth noncommissioned officer is the left guide of the first platoon, and the fifth noncommissioned officer is the right guide of the second platoon. If more than two platoons are formed, the third noncommissioned officer is the left guide of the platoon on the extreme left of the detach- ment, and the necessary number of noncommissioned officers are posted as guides, according to rank, from right to left. The division is so made that the platoons may be of nearly equal strength. At the formation of the detachment the platoons are num- bered consecutively from right to left; these designations are permanent and do not change when, by any movement, the right becomes the left of the line, or the head becomes the rear of the column. The senior noncommissioned officer always remains with the first platoon; when in line he is in rear of the second file from the outer flank, taking a corresponding position when the platoons unite in column of twos. 276 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS In movements by platoons, each chief repeats such preparatory commands as are to be immediately executed by his platoon; the men execute the commands, march and halt, if applying to their platoons, when given by the commanding officer. Each chief repeats the com- mands prescribed for him, so as to insure execution of the movement by his command at the proper time. These rules are general. Being in line, to form or march in column 0} platoons to the right or left. 93. 1. Platoons right {left), 2. March, 3. Detachment, 4. Halt; or, 3. Full step, 4. March, 5. Guide right (or left). Executed by each platoon; the right man of each platoon is the pivot. The left guide of the right platoon places himself on the left of his platoon as soon as practicable. At the first command, each chief of platoon cautions, Platoon right; and at the second command takes his post two paces in front of the center of his platoon, passing around the right flank. At the third command, the right guide of each platoon places him- self on the right of the pivot man of his platoon. The guide of the rear platoon preserves the trace, step, and a dis- tance equal to the front of his platoon. When a detachment is formed in line of platoons in column of twos, the guides in the line of file closers take their new posts as soon as prac- ticable; when platoons are about to unite in line or in column of twos, guides at the center take their posts in the line of file closers. In column of platoons, the officer commanding is three paces in front of the chief of the leading platoon. These rules are general. The column of platoons is put in march, halted, obliques, and re- sumes the direct march by the same commands as a detachment in line. Marching in column of platoons, to change direction. 94- 1. Column right {left), 2. March. At the first command, the chief of the leading platoon commands: Right turn. At the command march, the leading platoon turns to the right on moving pivot; its chief commands: 1. Full step, 2. March, on completion of the turn. The rear platoon marches squarely up to the turning point, and changes direction by command of its chief. Column half right {left) is similarly executed; each chief gives the preparatory command: Right {Left) half turn. HOSPITAL CORPS DETACHMENT DRILL 277 To put the column of platoons in march and change direction at the same time. 95. 1. Forward, 2. Guide right {left), 3. Column right (left); or 3. Column half right (left), 4. March. At the third command, the chief of the leading platoon commands: - Right (Right half) turn. The movement is executed as in the preceding paragraph. 96. In changing direction in column of subdivisions, each chief, on the completion of the movement by his subdivision, announces the guide on the side it was previous to the turn. This rule is general. Being in column of platoons, to face or march to the rear. 97. 1. Twos right (left) about, 2. March, 3. Detachment, 4. Halt; or, 3. Full step, 4. March, 3. Guide right (or left). Each set. of twos executes the about. If one platoon be smaller than the other, the guide of the rear platoon regains the trace and distance on the march. To form line from column of platoons. 98. Before forming line to the right or left, or on the right or left, the officer commanding requires the guide of the rear platoon on the flank toward which the movement is to be executed to cover; if march- ing, he announces the guide on that flank, if not already there. 99. To the right or left: 1. Platoons right (left), 2. March, 3. Detachment, 4. Halt; or, 3. Full step, 4. March, 5. Guide right (or left). Each platoon executes right turn on fixed pivot. At the second command, each chief of platoon takes his post in rear of his platoon, passing around its left flank. 100. On right or left: 1. On right (left) into line, 2. March, 3. Detachment, 4. Halt, 5. Front. The chief of the leading platoon commands: Right turn. The leading platoon turns to the right on moving pivot. The command halt is given when the leading platoon has advanced detachment distance in the new direction; its chief commands: Right dress, and passes around the right flank to his post. The rear platoon marches straight to the front, changes direction by command of its chief, when opposite the right of its place in line; and, when the right file has arrived on the line, is halted by its chief, 278 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS who also commands: Right dress, and passes around the left flank to his post. The officer commanding verifies the alignment and commands Front. Being in column of platoons, to march by the flank. 101. 1. Twos right (left), 2. March, 3. Full step, 4. March, 5. Guide right (or left). Each platoon marches in column of twos to the right; each chief cf platoon takes post on the left of his leading guide; the leading guide of the platoon on the flank announced is the guide of the detachment; the leading guide of the other platoon marches abreast of him, and preserves the interval necessary to form front into line. The post of the officer commanding is three paces in front of the line of leading guides and opposite the center of the interval between the platoons. To form or march again in column of platoons.^ 102. 1. Twos right (left), 2. March, 3. Detachment, 4. Halt; or 3. Full step, 4. March, 5. Guide right (or left). Being in line of platoons in column of twos, to form line to the front. 103. 1. Platoons, 2. Right (Left) front into line, 3. March, 4. De- tachment, 5. Halt, 6. Front. Each platoon forms right front into line; each chief of platoon takes post in rear of his platoon, passing around its left flank. The command lialt is given when the leading twos have advanced detachment distance. If the movement is executed in double time, the officer commands: Guide left (or right), after the command march. Being in line of platoons in column of twos, to form column of twos, to the right or left. 104. 1. Platoons, 2. Forward, column right (left), 3. March. The chiefs of platoons take their posts, passing around the heads of their platoons, as they are about to unite in column of twos. If marching the command forward is omitted. Being in column of twos, to form column of platoons. 105. 1. Platoons, 2. Right (Left) front into line, 3. March, 4. De- tachment, 5. Halt. THE AMERICAN ARMY LITTER 279 At the second command each chief of platoon places himself near the head of his platoon. At the command, march, each platoon forms right front into line. The command halt is given when the leading two has advanced detachment distance; each chief of platoon verifies the alignment of his platoon, commands: Front, and takes his post. If marching in double time or in quick time, and the command be double time, the command: Guide left {right), is given after the com- mand march. Being in column of twos, to march in line of platoons in column of twos to the right or left. 106. 1. Platoons, 2. Forward, column right {left), 3. March, 4. Guide right (or left). Each platoon changes direction to the right; each chief of platoon takes his post by the side of his leading guide. If marching, the command forward is omitted. LITTER DRILL. 107. The purpose of this drill is to teach the most useful methods of handling sick and wounded, to secure concerted action, and for the disciplining effect which follows drill in prompt obedience to the word of command. When the men have thoroughly mastered it, litter squads should work in- dependently, as in actual service. 108. The regulation hand litter consists of a canvas bed 6 feet long and 22 inches wide, made fast to two poles 7I feet long, and stretched by two jointed braces. The ends of the poles form the handles, 9 inches long, by which the litter is carried. The fixed iron legs are stirrup-shaped, 4 inches high and if inches wide. On the left front and right rear handles a half-round iron ring is fixed, /\\ inches from the end; be- tween this and the canvas plays the movable ring of the sling. Two cross straps, each with a ring at one end and a snap at the other, play through staples fastened to the bottom of each pole beneath the canvas, and near its free edges. When the litter is open the straps lie transversely under the canvas; when the litter is closed they are passed around it, through the 280 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS free loop of the slings and fastened to the snaps, thus securely closing the litter. One pair of regulation slings is permanently attached to each litter. They are made of khaki -colored webbing, 2 \ inches wide, with a leather-lined loop at one end and a leather strap (with buckle) at the other, the strap passing through a steel swivel, itself attached to the movable ring of the handle. 109. When the detachment is formed for drill or instruc- tion, officers, if in service uniform, wear belts. The in- structor will require that the clothing of the men be clean and neatly adjusted; that the privates first class and privates of the Hospital Corps fall in equipped with pouch, belt, knife, and first-aid packet. Noncommissioned officers wear the belt, knife, first-aid packet, and emergency case. no. For purposes of litter drill each set of two is a litter squad. The litter squad is marched by the commands applicable to a set of twos, substituting "litter" for "two." No. 2 is the squad leader. He commands his squad and is responsible for it. When practicable he should be a private first class. in. The litter is said to be strapped when folded, the canvas doubled smoothly on top, the slings placed parallel to each other thereon, and all secured by the cross straps. It is said to be closed when unstrapped, the two loops of the front sling upon the left handle, and of the rear sling upon the right, the bight of each sling embracing the opposite handle. MANUAL OF THE LITTER. 112. Having assigned the medical officers and the non- commissioned officers to appropriate duties, the instructor commands: 1. Count, 2. Twos, 1. Count, 2. Squads, i. Procure litter, 2. March. At march the Nos 2 step one pace to the front and proceed by the nearest route to the (strapped or closed) litters. They each take one, placing it on the right shoulder at a slope of at AMERICAN ARMY LITTER DRILL 28l least 45 degrees, canvas down, and promptly return, each man resuming his place by passing through his interval one pace to the rear, facing about, and stepping forward with the left foot into line. The march may be supervised by a non- commissioned officer, and may be execu- ted in double time. 113- At the shoulder the litter is held canvas down upon the shoulder, supported by the right arm, the right hand grasping the left pole; the left hand is dropped to the side. 114. In all motions from the shoulder, or to the shoul- der, the litter should invari- ably be brought to the verti- cal position against the right shoulder, one pole in front of the other, canvas to the left, both hands grasping the front pole, the left above the right, and the left fore- arm horizontal. This position should be taken by the bearer when passing through his interval to resume his place in the line (par. 112), and in any formation or movement in which there may be danger of the lower or upper handles of the litter striking neighboring men ; after which the shoulder is resumed without command. 115. A stack consists of three litters, to which more may be added. Being in line at the shoulder, the instructor designates the center squad or squads, and commands: 1. Stack, 2. Litters. Fig. 170 (Par. 113) — Shoulder Litter. Fig. 171 (Par. 114).— Vertical -Position. 282 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS At litters, each No. 2 brings his litter to the vertical posi- tion; No. 2 of the designated squad steps one pace to the front and stands fast; the Nos. 2 next on the right and left step two paces to the front and facing each other, close in and lock the handles of their litters together; No. 2 of the designated squad locks the upper handles of his litter between those of the other two squads, when all lower stack to the ground, spreading its feet sufficiently to make it stand securely. As soon as the stacks are formed any additional litters are laid on, and the bearers take their posts. 116. Being at the stack: 1. Take, 2. Litters. At litter, the Nos. 2 close in on the center as in the previous AMERICAN ARMY LITTER DRILL 283 paragraph, advancing to the stack, and grasping their re- spective litters, break the stack, and resume their position in line. 117. Being in line, litters at the shoulder: 1. Carry, 2. Litter. At litter, each No. 2 brings his litter to the vertical position; Fig. 173 (Par. 115).— Litters Stacked. he drops the upper handles forward and downward until the litter is in a horizontal position, canvas to the left; meanwhile No. i steps directly to the front until he is op- posite the front handles, which he seizes with his left hand. Nos. i and 2 take hold by passing the left and right hands, respectively, outside the handles and grasping the lower one, the handles resting against the hip. The guides EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Fig. 174 (Par. 117).— Carry Litter. Fig. 175 (Par. 118) —Ground Litter. AMERICAN ARMY LITTER DRILL 285 step forward and place themselves in line with the front bearers. 118. Being at the carry: 1. Ground, 2. Litter. At litter, the bearers face inward, grasping the handles with both hands; they stoop and lower the litter to the ground, canvas up, and standing erect, face to the front. 119. Being at the ground: 1. Carry, 2. Litter. At litter, the bearers face inward, stoop, grasp the handles with both hands and raise the litter from the ground to the carry. 120. Being at the carry: 1. Shoulder, 2. Litter. At litter, No. 2 reaches forward with his left hand and grasping the litter near its center brings it to the vertical position and then to the shoulder; meanwhile No. 1 steps backward and aligns himself upon No. 2. 121. Being at the carry, litter strapped: 1. Open, 2. Litter. At litter, both bearers face the litter, unfasten the straps and slip the free loop of each sling upon the ring handle, the bight embracing the opposite handle; they grasp the right (upper) handles with their right hands. This leaves the litter suspended longitudinally, canvas to the left. They then extend the braces, and supporting the litter horizontally by the handles, canvas up, lower it to the ground and resume the attention, standing between the handles, facing the front. If the litter be merely closed, at litter, the bearers face the litter and grasp the upper handles with the right hands. They drop the left pole, extend the braces, lower the litter, and take positions as before. 122. To secure slings, the litter being lowered: 1. Secure, 2. Slings. 2 86 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS At slings, each bearer slips off the bight of his sling, drops the doubled end over the free handle and brings it up around ■the handle, slipping the doubled end through the sling and over the end of the handle. The slings will be se- cured when it is de- sired to prevent them from dragging on the ground, or from being in the way when .passing obstacles, loading ambulances, etc. 123. . Being at the open: 1. Close, At litter, Nos. right front and left rear handles, and face inward; they stoop, and with their right hands raise the litter by the right handles; they then and 2. Litter. respectively, step outside the Fig. 177 (Par. 122).— Slings Secured. fold the braces, and bringing the lower pole against the upper, face to the front and support the litter at the carry. 124. The litter being closed: 1. Strap, 2. Litter. At litter, the bearers face the litter, fold the canvas by doubling it smoothly on the poles, release free loops of slings, and place slings lengthwise of the litter on the canvas, buckles out, and neatly secure all by the cross strap at each end, passed around poles and through loops of slings, when all take posts at the carry. In the field the litter should habitually be carried strapped or closed, and only opened on reaching the patient. AMERICAN ARMY LITTER DRILL 287 Fig. 178 (Par. 123).— Close Litter. Fig. 179 (Par. 124).— Strap Litter. 288 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS The litter may in like manner be closed and then strapped, being at the open, at the command strap litter, when the motions begin with those described under close litter. 125. To bring the squad into line, the litter being at the ground, or the open, with the men at litter posts: 1. Form, 2. Rank. At rank, No. 1 advances one pace and No. 2 aligns himself Fig. 180 (Par. 126).— Litter Posts. upon No. i. Original positions at the litter are resumed at the command litter posts (par. 126). This movement permits the marching of the squad, without litter, to any desired point. 126. Posts at the litter may at any time be recovered by the commands: 1. Litter, 2. Posts. If at the ground, the numbers take posts, No. 1 on the right of the front handles, No. 2 on the left of the rear handles and close to them, facing the front (Fig. 1.75). If at the open, Nos. AMERICAN ARMY LITTER DRILL 289 i and 2 take posts between the front and rear handles, respec- tively, facing the front. 127. The foot, or front, of a grounded or opened (unloaded) litter is the end farthest from the approaching squad, unless otherwise designated. The foot of a loaded litter is always the end corresponding to the feet of the patient. 128. Being at the open: 1. Prepare to lift, 2. Lift. At the first command Nos. 1 and 2 stoop and seize each the free loop and bight of sling, No. 1 with the left and fight hands, No. 2 with the right and left hands, respectively; slip them off the handles, change hands, retaining hold, and each places the sling over the shoulders, slips the loop upon the free handle and grasps both handles. They adjust the slings, lengthen- ing or shortening them as necessary, and at lift rise slowly erect. 129. At the command: 1. Forward, 2. March, the bearers step off, No. 1 with the left and No. 2 with the right foot, taking short, sliding steps of about 20 inches, to avoid jolting and to secure a uniform motion to the litter. The cadence is at the rate of about 100 steps per minute. 130. Being at the lift: 1. Lower, 2. Litter. At litter, the bearers slowly lower the litter to the ground. Each number then seizes the free loop and bight of his sling, No. 1 with the right and left hands, and No. 2 with the left and right hands. Each slips off loops and removes slings from shoulders and places the loop upon the right handle, avoiding any twist in the sling. 131. When the litter is to be moved but a few paces, it may be lifted and marched without slings by prefixing without slings to the commands: Prepare to lift, Lift. 132. The open litter should be lifted and lowered slowly and without jerk, both ends simultaneously, the rear bearer moving in accord with the front bearer, so as to maintain the 290 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS canvas horizontal. In fact, the open litter should be handled for purposes of drill as if it were a loaded litter, and as soon as the men are familiar with its manual the drill should, when- ever practicable, be with loaded litter. 133. Being in line at the shoulder: 1. Return litter, 2. March. At march, the Nos. 2 bring the litter to the vertical position and step one pace to the front, bringing the litter to the shoulder; they then proceed by the nearest route to the place designated for the litters, where they leave them, resume their positions by passing through their intervals, one pace to the rear, facing about, and stepping into line. This movement may be supervised by a noncommissioned officer, and may be executed in double time. MARCHINGS WITH THE LITTER. 134. The interval between litters in line is four paces. In column the distance is one pace. 135. Being in line of litters at the carry: 1. To the left (or right) take intervals, 2. March, 3. Front. At march, the right squad stands fast. The other squads side step to the left until they have gained the proper intervals. All dress to the right and at front, turn the head and eyes to the front. 136. Being in line of litters at the carry, with intervals taken: 1. To the right (or left) close intervals, 2. March, 3. Front. At march, the right squad stands fast. The other squads side step to the right until the interval between litters is two paces and at front, cast their eyes to the front. 137. To align a line of litters at a halt, the litters being at the carry or lift, the commands are: 1. Right {Left), 2. Dress, 3. Front. At dress, all execute eyes right, the Nos. 1 aligning themselves on the right guide, or on No. 1 of the first squad; all promptly recover their intervals, if lost. At front, all turn the head and eyes to the front. 138. The line or column of litters is marched by the commands already given (par. 67 and following), substituting litters for twos. Whenever the squad is marching the litter should be at the carry. The following movements require special notice or description: MARCHINGS WITH THE LITTER 291 To turn on fixed pivot. 139. 1. Detachment right (left), 2. March, 3. Detachment, 4. Halt; or. 3. Full step, 4. March, 5. Guide right (or lejl). The first litter halts and, taking the short step, wheels to the right on its own ground; the other litters half wheel to the right and place themselves successively upon the alignment established by the right litter (par. 75). To turn on moving pivot. 140. 1. Right {Left) turn, 2. March, 3. Full step, 4. March, 5. Guide right (or left). The first litter takes the short step and wheels to the right on a movable pivot, followed by the others, as in par. 76. BEING IN LINE OF LITTERS, TO MARCH BY THE FLANK IN COLUMN OF LITTERS. 141. 1. Litters right {left), 2. March. At the command march, No. 1 steps off to the right and No. 2 to the left, each describing a quarter of a circle, so as to make the litter revolve horizontally on its center until both face to right, when they take the full step in the new direction. The right guide plares himself one pace in front of the first litter, and the rear guide one pace in rear of the last litter. BEING IN LINE OR COLUMN TO MARCH TO THE REAR. 142. 1. Litters about, 2. March. At march, Nos. 1 and 2 step off as in par. 141, but continue the move- ment until both face to the rear. The about with the litter is always to the right. 143. A platoon of litters consists of four litter squads in line, with intervals taken. The distance between platoons of litters in column is equal to the front of a platoon. 144. The line or column of platoons is marched by the commands already given (par. 92 and following), substituting litters for twos. 145. The advantage of this formation is that it permits the shorten- ing of the column -at the carry without increasing its front by the ccm- mands: 1. Platoons, 2. Close, 3. March, when the platoons clcse up to one pace, and the litters oblique toward each other until there is an interval of one pace between litters. In this formation each chief of platoon takes post on the left of his left guide. 146. The normal formation. is resumed by the commands: 1. Platoons, 2. Extend, 3. March. line is re-formed by the same commands used to form column. 292 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS ROUTE STEP. 147. The column of strapped litters at the carry is the habitual column of route. The rate is 3 to 3 J miles per hour. Marching in quick time: 1. Route step, 2. March. The men are not required to preserve silence, nor keep the step. The litter squads preserve their distance. 148. If from a halt: 1. Forward, 2. Route step, 3. March. 149. To resume the cadence step: 1. Detachment, 2. Attention. At the command attention, the cadence step in quick time is resumed. Upon halting while marching in route step, the men come to the rest at the ground (par. 118). 150. To march at ease. 1. At ease, 2. March. The detachment marches as in route step, except that silence is preserved THE LOADED LITTER. TO LOAD AND UNLOAD THE LITTER. 151. For drill in loading the litter, the " patients" are directed to lie down at suitable intervals near the line of litters, first with head and later with feet toward it, and lastly in any position. Each squad may be separately exercised under its leader, or an instructor, or several squads simultaneously. 152. The litter being at the open, the patient, with two bearers, must always be carried to it. This may be done in either of two ways. I 53- (a) The litter being at the open, the instructor com- mands: It Right (Le ^ side ^ 2 p 0STS> If the command is right side, posts, the bearers go to right side of patient and take positions, No. 1 at the right thigh and No. 2 at the right shoulder, facing the patient. If the com- mand is left, they take similar positions on the left side. 1. Prepare to lift, 2. Lift. LOADING THE LITTER 2 93 At the first command the bearers kneel on the knee nearest the patient's feet. No. i passes one arm under the hips and the other beneath the knees; No. 2 passes one hand under the pa- tient's shoulders to the further armpit, and the other arm be- neath the small of the back. At lift, they lift together, slowly and carefully, raising the patient upon their knees, then readjusting their hold, rise to their feet and carry the patient by the shortest route to the side of the litter, when the squad is halted and the commands are given: 1. Lower, 2. Patient. At patient, the bearers kneel and place the patient on their knees; they stoop forward and lower him gently upon the litter; they then Fig. 181 (Par. 153).— Side, Fosts. 294 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Fig. 183 (Par. 154).— Hips, Posts. emergencies to use three bearers, this may be done with similar commands, by having the third bearer placed at the patient in such a way that he may support the knees and legs. *54« (P) i. Hips, 2. Posts. At posts, No. i proceeds to the patient's right hip and No. 2 to the left hip, facing the patient. i. Prepare to lift, 2. Lift. At the first command, the bearers kneel on the knee nearest the patient's feet; they then raise him to a sit- ting postion, pass each one Fig. 184 (Par. 154).—" Prepare to Lift " at Hips. LOADING THE LITTER 2 95 hand and arm around his back, while the other hands are passed under the thighs, grasping each other. The patient, if able, clasps his arms around the bearers' necks. At lift, they lift the patient, both rising together, patient's legs remain- ing unsupported, and carry him over the near end of the litter, when the squad is halted and the com- mands are given: i. Lower, 2. Pa- tient. At patient, the bearers stoop and carefully lower the patient upon the litter; and, without com- mand, resume po- sition at litter posts. JSS- To unload, posts are taken and the patient lifted in the same way and by the same commands. The bearers move backward if at side posts, and sidewise if at hips posts, until clear of the litter, when they halt and lower patient. 156. In the field, the squad having reached the patient and its numbers having taken positions on their respective sides, secure his arms and accouterments, loosen his clothing and examine him to determine the site and nature of the injury, applying such first-aid treatment as may be necessary. The drill should be made as nearly as possible like service in actual warfare. For this purpose, a diagnosis tag having Fig. 185 (Par. 154).—' Lower Patient " at Hips. 296 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS been attached to the clothing of the " wounded" indicating the site and character of the injury to be dressed, before load- ing, they are directed to take positions at variable distances, in or out of sight, such as they would occupy on the battlefield. The litter being at the carry, at the command Squad leaders, take charge of squads, each No. 2 assumes charge of his squad, which proceeds independently. When a patient is discovered the litter is halted and opened (by No. 2's commands) in the most convenient position, near the patient. The injury hav- ing been dressed, No. 2 commands: 1. Right {Left) side, 2. Posts; or, 1. Hips, 2. Posts, as may be most convenient, and the patient is lifted and lowered upon the litter, as de- scribed in pars. 154-5. The arms and accouterments of the patient are carried on the litter, when practicable. At the signal or order for assembly, the squads re-form in line, lower litters and come to rest, when the patients, if still upon the litters (the dressings, if any, having been removed), are directed to rise and resume their posts, after which the litters are strapped. POSITION OF PATIENT ON THE LITTER. 157. The position of a patient on the litter depends on the character of his injury. An overcoat, blanket, or other suitable and convenient article should be used as a pillow to give sup- port and slightly raised position to the head. If the patient is faint, the head should be kept low. Difficulty of breathing in wounds of the chest is relieved by a sufficient padding un- derneath. In wounds of the abdomen the best position is on the injured side, or on the back if the front of the abdomen is injured, the legs in either case being drawn up, and a pillow or other available object placed under the knees to keep them bent. In an injury of the upper extremity calling for litter trans- portation, the best position is on the back, with the injured arm laid over the body or suitably placed by its side, or on the uninjured side with the wounded arm laid over the body. GENERAL RULES FOR CARRYING A LITTER 297 In injuries of the lower extremity the patient should be on his back, or inclining toward the wounded side; in case of fracture of either lower extremity, if a splint can not be applied, it is always well to bind both limbs together. GENERAL DIRECTIONS. 158. In moving the patient, either with or without the litter, every movement should be made deliberately and as gently as possible, having special care not to jar the injured part. The command steady will be used to prevent undue haste or other irregular movements. 159. The loaded litter should never be lifted or lowered without orders. 160. The rear bearer should watch the movements of the front bearer, and time his own by them, so as to insure ease and steadiness of action. 161. The number of steps per minute will depend on the weight carried and other conditions affecting each individual case. 162. The handles of the litter should be held in the hands at arm's length and supported by the slings. Only under most exceptional conditions should the handles be supported on the shoulders. 163. The bearer should keep the litter level, notwithstand- ing any unevenness of the ground. 164. As a rule, the patient should be carried on the litter feet foremost, but in going uphill his head should be in front. In case of fracture of the lower extremities, he is carried uphill feet foremost, and downhill head foremost, to prevent the weight of the body from pressing down on the injured part. TO PASS OBSTACLES. 165. A breach should be made in a fence or wall for the passage of the litter. If there is no gate or other opening, or should it be necessary to surmount the obstacle, the latter EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Fig. 186 (Par. 165).— At Sides of Litter Before Passing Obstacle. being not over 3 feet high, the litter is halted and lowered and slings secured, when the commands are given: 1. At sides of litter, 2. Posts. At posts, Nos. 1 and 2 take posts on the right and left of the litter, respectively, at the center and facing it F-ig. 187 (Par. I65).-Passing Obstacle. PASSING A LITTER OVER AN OBSTACLE 299 i. Prepare to lift, 2. Lift, 3. March. At the first command the bearers stoop and seize their re- spective poles with both hands; at lift, the litter is lifted, and at march, it is advanced to the obstacle and passed over until the front legs have cleared it. The litter is there rested, while No. 2 steps around between the rear handles, which he sup- ports, No. 1 getting over the obstacle; No. 1 takes the front handles, facing the litter, and together the bearers pass the litter over until the rear handles rest on the ob- stacle, when No. 2 gets over, tak- ing left front handle; and both resuming at sides of litter posts, move the litter forward until free of the obstacle, when they halt and lower litter, and resume litter posts without command. 166. The pas- sage of a cut or ditch not over 3 feet deep is effected in a similar manner, but without special command. The litter being halted and lowered at its edge, No. 1 descends into the ditch and takes hold of the front handles, facing the litter. Both bearers then support and advance the litter until only the rear feet or handles rest upon the edge, when No. 2 de- scends and the litter is carried across. These directions are general. Fig. 188 (Par. 165).- -At Sides of Litter After Passing Obstacle. 300 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS BEARER WORK WITH INCREASED NUMBERS. 167. Under exceptional circumstances, as in ascending or descending stairs, when the patient is very heavy, the ground difficult, or an obstacle over 3 feet high has to be surmounted, it may be necessary to use additional bearers. 168. When three bearers are available, the third bearer gives aid where most needed; in loading and unloading he usually places the litter under the patient or removes it, but he may assist in supporting a fractured limb. In litter bear- ing he acts as a relay, or assists in supporting either end of the litter as directed. 169. When necessary to use two squads, the first squad being at litter posts, the commands are given : 1. Second squad, 2. Litter, 3. Posts. The posts of the second squad are on the left of the litter; one pace from it and facing to the front, No. 1 at the front handle and No. 2 at the rear handle. No. 2 of the first squad is in command. If the first squad is at posts, litter at the carry or ground, No. 2 steps to the right side of the litter when the second squad takes posts. 170. To change bearers, the litter being lowered: 1. Change, 2. Posts. At posts the free squad relieves the bearers, No. 1 relieving No. 1 and No. 2 relieving No. 2. 171. To carry the litter by four bearers, the litter' being lowered and the squads at litter posts: 1. Four bearers, 2. Posts. At posts, the first squad takes position outside the handles on the right and the second squad outside the handles on the left, all facing the litter. 1. Prepare to lift, 2. Lift. At the first command all stoop and, grasping their handles with both hands, at lift they slowly rise. PASSING A LITTER OVER AN OBSTACLE .301 3° 2 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Four bearers, posts, may also be taken from position in line, the bearers going directly to their posts. Fig. 190 (Par. 171).— Prepare to Lift with Four Bearers. 172. To surmount an obstacle over 3 feet high, the litter being lifted by four (two squads), the commands are given: 1. Raise, 2. Litter, 3. March. At the second command the litter is carefully raised to the level of the obstacle, and at march it is carried over until the front legs have cleared, where it is rested. The front bearers cross the obstacle and resume hold of the handles on the other side; the litter is then advanced until only the rear handles rest on the obstacle, when the rear bearers get over and resume hold of their handles; the litter is then halted and lowered. TO CARRY A LOADED LITTER UPSTAIRS. 173. The loaded litter is usually carried upstairs head first, and downstairs feet first. To carry loaded litter upstairs. Two squads are required for this movement. The litter is marched to the foot of the stairs in the usual manner, wheeled about, halted, lowered, and PASSING A HIGH OBSTACLE 3°3 Fig. 191 (Par. 172).— Raise Litter Fig. 192 (Par. 172).— Passing a High Obstacle. 3°4 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS slings secured. It is then lifted by four bearers (par. 171) and carried up, the rear bearers keeping the litter as level as possible by raising it. They must carefully watch the patient. Fig. i93 (Par. 173).— Carrying a Loaded Litter Upstairs. TO CARRY A LOADED LITTER DOWNSTAIRS. 174. The litter is carried downstairs in the same manner as it is carried upstairs, except that it is not wheeled about. 175- When for any reason it is necessary to use three bearers, the commands i. Three bearers, prepare to lift, 2. Lift, are used. At the first command the additional bearer takes post outside the left handle at the foot of the litter, opposite No. 1, who steps outside the right handle. Both face the CARRYING A LITTER UPSTAIRS 3°5 litter, stoop, and grasp their respective poles. No. 2 faces about, stoops, and grasps his handles. At lift, the litter is lifted and carried up (or 1 down) the stairs. If the litter is to be carried downstairs by three bearers, No. 2 does not face about. FROM LITTER TO BED. 176. The litter is placed at the foot of the bed, as nearly as possible in line with it, and the patient is transferred to the bed, as described in par. 153. Often it is simpler, after the Fig. 194 (Par. 175). — Carrying a Loaded Litter Upstairs with Three Bearers. patient is lifted, to roll the bed in front of the bearers, who then lower the patient upon it. If there is no fracture or other contra-indication the litter may be brought to the side of the bed and level with it, and held there, while the patient is directed 306 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS to roll over on to the bed. If a third man is available, as he usually is in hospitals, the litter may be halted and lowered at the side of the bed when, after the patient is lifted, the litter is drawn out by the third bearer, the other two stepping for- ward and lowering the patient upon the bed. 177. From litter to litter is executed in the same manner as from litter to bed. IMPROVISATION OF LITTERS. 178. Many things can be used for this purpose: Camp cots, window shutters, doors, benches, ladders, etc., properly padded. Litters may be made with sacks or bags of any description, if large and strong enough, by ripping the bottoms and pass- ing two poles through them and tying cross pieces to the poles to keep them apart; two, or even three> sacks placed end to end on the same poles may be necessary to make a safe and comfortable litter. Bedticks are used in the same way by slipping the poles through holes made by snipping off the four corners. Pieces of matting, rug, or carpet trimmed into shape, may be fastened to poles by tacks or twine. Straw mats, leafy twigs, weeds, hay, straw, etc., covered or not with a blanket, will make a good bottom over a frame- work of poles and cross sticks. Better still is a litter with bottom of ropes or rawhide strips, whose turns cross each other at close intervals. 179. But the usual military improvisation is by means of rifles and blankets. Each bearer should be supplied with a rifle carried at the order. They assure themselves that the rifles are unloaded. The blanket, rolled up, is carried by No. 2 over the right shoulder. 1. Prepare, 2. Blanket Litter. At the second command the bearers lay their rifles on the ground and face each other; No. 2 slipping off his blanket roll, IMPROVISED LITTERS 307 gives one end of the blanket to No. 1, and together they spread it out lengthwise on the ground. No. 1 then places his rifle across the center of the blanket, the butt toward the original front of the squad and trigger guard in. Both bearers (No. 1 at the left front, No. 2 at the left rear corner) fold the blanket over the rifle. No. 2 then places his rifle over the center of the new fold and the blanket is folded over the second rifle, as over the first. The bearers then take position at litter posts, without command. When available, four bearers should be used for carrying this litter. 180. When no longer required, the commands are given: 1. Take apart, 2. Blanket Litter. At the second command the litter is taken apart, the blanket rolled up and placed over the right shoulder of No. 2, after which the bearers take their rifles and resume their original position in line. 181. Should it be desirable, the following method may be used: One-half of the blanket is rolled lengthwise into a cylinder, which is placed along the back of the patient, who has bejen turned carefully on his side. The patient is then turned over upon the blanket, and the cylinder unrolled on the other side. The rifles are then laid down and rolled tightly in the blanket, each a like number of turns, until the side of the body of the patient is reached, when they are turned trigger guards up. 182. A litter may also be prepared with two rifles and two or three blouses, by turning the blouses lining out, and buttoning them up, sleeves in, when the rifles are passed through the sleeves, the backs of the blouses forming the bed. METHODS OF REMOVING WOUNDED WITHOUT LITTER. BY THE RIFLE SEAT. 183. A good seat may be made by running the barrels of two rifles through the sleeves of an overcoat, buttoned as in para- 3 o8 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS graph 182, so that the coat lies back up, collar to the rear. The front bearer rolls the tail tightly around the barrels and takes his grasp over them; the rear bearer holds by the butts, trigger guards up. 184. A stronger seat is secured in the following manner: A blanket being folded once from side to side, a rifle is laid trans- versely upon it across its center, so that the butt and muzzle project beyond the edges; one end of the blanket is folded upon the other end and a second rifle laid upon the new center, in the same manner as before. The free end of the blanket is folded upon the end containing the first rifle, so as to project a couple of inches beyond the first rifle. The litter is raised from the ground, with trigger guards up. BY ONE BEARER. 185. A single bearer may carry a patient in his arms or on his back. In instructing a detachment in these movements, the detachment being in line, the patients having been directed to lie down in front of the bearers: 186. 1. In arms, 2. Lift. At lift, each bearer, turning patient on his face, steps astride his body, fac- ing toward the patient's head, and with hands under his armpits lifts him to his knees; then, clasping hands over abdomen, lifts him to his feet; he then with his left hand seizes the patient by the left wrist and draws left arm around his (the bearer's) neck and holds it against his left chest, the patient's left side resting against his body, and supports him with his right arm about the waist. From this position the bearer, with his right arm upon th^ Fig. 195 (Par. 186).— Pre Ihiinary Position in Lift ing by One Bearer. CARRYING BY A SINGLE BEARER 3°9 patient's back, passes his left under thighs and lifts him into position, carrying him well up. 187. 1. Across back, 2. Lift. At lift, the patient is first lifted erect, as described in previous paragraph, when the bearer, with his left hand seizes, the right wrist of the patient and draws the arm over his head and down upon his left shoulder; then shifting himself in front, stoops and Fig. 196 (Par. 187).— Lifting Across Back. Fig. 197 (Par. 187).— Patient Lifted Across Back. clasps the right thigh with his right arm passed between the legs, his right hand seizing the patient's right wrist; lastly, the bearer with his left hand grasps the patient's left and steadies it against his side, when he rises. 1 88. i. Astride of back, 2. Lift. At lift, the patient is lifted erect (as described), when the bearer shifts himself to the front of the patient, back to patient, stoops, and grasping his thighs, brings him well upon his back. 3 10 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS Fig. 198 (Par. 188).— Patient Car ried Astride of Back. 190. By the ex- tremities: 1. Head and feet, 2. Posts. At posts, bearers take position at pa- tient, No. 1 between the patient's legs and No. 2 at his head, both facing toward his feet. 1. Prepare to lift, 2. Lift. At the first com- mand, the rear bear- er, having raised the As the patient must help himself by placing his arms around the bearer's neck , this method is imprac- ticable with an unconscious man. 189. In lowering the patient from these positions the motions are reversed. Should the patient be wounded in such a manner as to require these motions to be conducted from the right side in- stead of left, as laid down, the change is simply one of hands — the motions proceed as directed, substi- tuting right for left, and vice versa. BY TWO BEARERS. Besides the methods (already de- scribed) for carrying patient to litter. Fig. 199 (Par. 190).— Patient Carried by the Ex- tremities. CARRYING ON HORSEBACK 3 11 patient to a sitting posture, clasps him from behind around the body under the arms, while the front bearer, standing between the legs, passes his hands from the outside under the flexed knees. At lift, both rise together. This method requires no effort on the part of the patient; but is not applicable to severe injuries of the extremities. Fig. 200 (Par. 191).— Mounting a Patient on Horseback. TO PLACE A PATIENT ON HORSEBACK. 191. The help required to mount a disabled man will de- pend upon the site and nature of his injury; in many cases he is able to help himself materially. The horse, blindfolded, if necessary, to be held by an attendant. To load from the near side, the commands are: 1. Left side, 2. Posts, i. Prepare to lift, 2. Lift, 3. Mount. The patient having been lifted, at mount, is carried to the horse, patient's body parallel to that of the horse and close 312 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS to its side, his head toward the horse's tail. He is then care- fully raised and carried over the horse until his seat reaches the saddle, when he is lifted into position. No. i goes to the offside and puts the patient's right foot into the stirrup. No. 2 puts the left foot in the stirrup. When necessary to load from the offside, the bearers take posts right side. When a patient is entirely helpless two squads may be used, three bearers on one side, while the fourth goes to the offside of the horse. 192. To dismount, the commands are: 1. Left side, 2. Posts, i. Prepare to dismount, 2. Dismount. At prepare to dismount, the patient's feet are disengaged from the stirrups and his right leg swung over the pommel, No. 1 going to the offside for the purpose, and then resuming his post at the left side. At dismount, the patient is brought to a horizontal position, gently lifted over the saddle, and car- ried backward until free of the horse, when the squad halts and lowers patient. 193. The patient, once mounted, should be made as safe and comfortable as possible. A comrade may be mounted behind him and guide the horse; otherwise a lean-back may be pro- vided, made of a blanket roll, a pillow, or a bag filled with leaves or grass. If the patient be very weak, the lean -back may be made of a sapling bent into an arch over the cantle of the saddle, its ends securely fastened; or of some other framework, to which the -patient is bound. THE TRAVOIS. 194. The travois is a vehicle intended for transporting the sick or wounded when the use of wheeled vehicles or other means of transpor- tation is impracticable. It consists of a frame, having shafts, two side poles, and two crossbars, upon which a litter may be rested and partly suspended. When in use a horse or a mule is attached to the shafts and pulls the vehicle, the poles of which drag on the ground. One pole is slightly shorter than the other, in order that in passing an obstacle the shock may be received successively by each and the motion dis- tributed. THE TRAVOIS 3 X 3 . 195. To assemble the travois. — Pass each shaft through the collar on the travois pole from rear to front, pulling until snugly home. Then pass the front crossbar over the ironed ends on the front cf the travois poles, driving it home until its collars strike the frcnt cellar of each pole; ^ e REAR CrtOSSBAH Fig. 201 (Par. 194).— Elements o» the Travois) after which pass the rear crossbar (keeping uppermost the surface on which are the flat bolts) over the rear ends of the poles, pushing it forward until it reaches the squared places beyond the bolt slots, when the front bolts are thrown into place. 196. To harness the travois. — The animal is placed between the Fig. 202 (Par. 195).— Travois Assembled. shafts. If he has an ordinary wagon harness, the rings on the front end of the shafts are put over the iron hook on the hames, and the toggle of each trace chain is fastened to the ring of the corresponding travois pole. If he is saddled, the rings on the front of each shaft are 314 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS fastened to that on the pommel of the saddle by means of the straps that belong there, and the shafts are secured by a surcingle passed over all. 197. To place the litter on the travois. — If the litter is loaded, it is wheeled so that the head of the patient is toward the rear of the travois and two paces from it; it is then halted and lowered. The flat bolts on the rear travois bar are thrown back and slings are secured. The squad takes posts at the side of the litter, as in loading ambulance, and the litter is then carried lengthwise over the travois until the front of the litter rests upon the rear crossbar, when the handles are passed through the leather loops, the legs set in the mortises and secured by the bolts. 198. A travois may be improvised by cutting poles about 16 feet Fig. 203 (Par. 197).— Patient on the Travois. long and 2 inches in diameter at the small end. These poles are laid parallel to each other, large ends to the front, and 2% feet apart; the small ends about 3 feet apart, and one of them projecting about 8 or 1 o inches beyond the other. The poles are connected by a crossbar about 6 feet from the front ends, and another about 6 feet back of the first, each notched at its ends and securely lashed at the notches to the poles. Between the crosspieces the litter bed, 6 feet long, is filled in with canvas, blankets, etc., securely fastened to the poles and cross- bars; or with rope, lariat, rawhide strips, etc., stretching obliquely from pole to pole in many turns, crossing each other to form the basis for a light mattress or an improvised bed; or a litter may be made fast between the poles to answer the same purpose. The front ends of the poles are then securely fastened to the saddle of the animal. A breast THE AMERICAN ARMY AMBULANCE 315 sti;ap and traces shculd, if possible, be improvised and fitted to the horse. On the march the bearers shculd be ready to lift the rear end cf the travois when passing over obstacles, crossing streams, or going up hill. THE AMBULANCE. 199. The ambulance is a four-wheeled vehicle, ordinarily drawn by two animals in garrison, and four in the field. It provides transportation for eight men sitting, or four recumbent on litters; or four sitting and two recumbent. It is fitted with four removable seats, which, when not used as such, are hung, two against each side. The arrangements for supporting the upper tier of litters (upper berths) consist of two litter-support- ing posts and four straps. The litter-supporting posts are two uprights, placed 73 inches apart. The one in front is stationary, being secured to the roof and floor; the one at the rear is hinged at the top, and when the upper berths are not to be used it is strapped to the roof. When the upper berths are to be used, it is unstrapped and swung into a vertical posi- tion, when its lower end is secured to the floor by a slot and bolt. Fastened to each of the litter-supporting posts, 27I inches from the floor, is a socket for the inside handles of the litter; and opposite each socket, attached to the side of the ambulance, is a strap to hold the outside handles. The floor is 7^ feet long and 4 feet wide. Under the body of the ambulance, in front of the rear axle, are two ambulance boxes, which consist of two double tin boilers, with fire grates. One box contains hospital stores, and the other surgical dressings. (See Manual for the Medi- cal Department.) Spare parts and additional articles are also carried by each ambulance. (See Manual for the Medical Depart- ment.) In the field there should be an orderly with each ambulance, who rides on the seat beside the driver. When the orderly is present, it is his duty to open and close the tail gate, raise and lower the curtain (when necessary) ; and, as far as practicable, 316 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS to prepare the interior of the ambulance before the patients arrive. He may also assist in loading and unloading. AMBULANCE DRILLS. 200. The litters are said to be packed when they are strapped and placed upon the brackets. The seats are said to be pre- pared when they are horizontal, supported by the legs; and packed when they are hooked against the sides of the wagon. TO TAKE POSTS AT AMBULANCE. 201. The squad, being in the vicinity of the ambulance: 1. Ambulance, 2. Posts. At posts, No. 1 takes position one pace behind the left rear wheel, and No. 2 one pace behind the right rear wheel, both facing the ambulance. In case of a litter lowered in rear of an ambulance prepara- tory to loading, head of patient toward it, at the command posts each bearer faces about and proceeds directly to his post. This is the invariable position of the squad at ambulance posts; it may be taken from any position (the litter, if used, being grounded or lowered); and when disarranged, from what- ever cause, the squad may be reassembled by these commands for service at the ambulance. 202. The ambulance, having seats packed and the squad being at ambulance posts: 1. Prepare, 2. Seats. At seats t Nos. 1 and 2 raise the curtain, if necessary, open the tail gate, and enter the ambulance, No. 1 facing the front and No. 2 the rear seat of their respective sides. Each man seizes the lower edge of his seat about 6 inches from the ends with both hands, and lifts it to free the hooks from the upper slots and then slips them into the lower slots; he then lowers the AMBULANCE DRILL 317 Fig. 204 (Par. 201).— Ambulance, Posts. legs and adjusts them to the floor, and tries the seat for firm- ness before leaving it. He then prepares in like manner the opposite seat. No. 2 unfastens the litter-supporting post and swings it to the front of the ambulance, where it is grasped by No. 1, who lifts it to its place and straps it. Nos. 2 and 1 now resume their positions at ambulance posts, and close the tail gate. 203. The ambulance, having seats prepared, the squad being at ambulance posts: 1 Pack, 2. Seats. 318 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS At seats, Nos. i and 2 raise the curtain, if necessary, and open the tail gate. (In case of a litter lowered in rear of the ambu- lance, preparatory to loading, the tail gate is not closed.) They then enter the ambulance and face the front and rear seats of their respective sides; each man releases the legs and secures them against the seats; then, seizing the front of the seat with both hands, raises the seat to clear the hooks from the lower slots and slips them into the upper slots; he then lowers the seat to the side of the ambulance, and packs in like manner the opposite seat. No. 1 unfastens the strap which holds the litter-supporting post to the roof of the am- bulance and swings it to No. 2, who places it firmly in its socket. Nos. 2 and 1 now resume their positions at ambulance posts and close the tail gate. 204. Seats may be prepared or packed on one side only (leaving room on the packed side for two recumbent patients) by the commands: 1. Right (Left) prepare, 2. Seats. TO LOAD THE AMBULANCE. 205. The litter, being lifted, is marched to the rear of the ambulance, wheeled about so that the head of the patient is toward the step and one pace from it, when the litter is halted and lowered. If it be necessary to prepare the ambu- lance before loading, the squad by command takes positions at ambulance posts. 1. At sides of litter, 2. Posts. The tail gate having been opened, at posts Nos. 1 and 2 take positions on the right and left, mid-length of the litter,* facing it. 1. Lower (or Upper) berth, prepare to load, 2. Load. At the first command the bearers stoop, and each grasps a pole firmly with both hands. At load, the litter is lifted and pushed into the ambulance. No. 1 places the arms and accou- AMBULANCE DRILL 3 J 9 terments of the patient in the ambulance, when both close the tail gate. If the upper berth is to be loaded, the tail gate is left open. No. i runs to the front of the ambulance, climbs in, stepping over the seat, faces the litter, and grasps the head handles. No. 2 mounts the rear step and grasps his handles. The litter is Fig. 205 (Par. 205).— Loading Ambulance. then lifted, the inside handles being placed in the receiving sockets first, the outside handles then being secured by the straps. No. i steps over the front seat, jumps to the ground, and the squad takes position at ambulance posts and closes the tail gate, unless the ambulance is to be unloaded at once. 320 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS To unload the ambulance. 206. The squad being at ambulance posts: i. Lower (or Upper) berth, prepare to unload, 2. Unload. The tail gate having been opened, at the first command each bearer grasps the handle nearest him. At unload, the bearers partly withdraw the litter, then shifting their hands to their respective poles and facing each other, they continue to with- draw it until the head reaches the rear of the ambulance, when they lift the litter out, halt and lower it to the ground one pace in rear of the tail gate. The bearers having closed the tail gate, take positions at litter posts without command. If the upper berth is to be unloaded, at the first command No. 1 runs to the front of the ambulance, climbs in, stepping over the front seat, and stands between the handles of the litter facing the rear; No. 2 mounts the rear step, facing the front. Each bearer grasps his handles. At unload, the han- dles are lifted and freed from their fastenings, first from the straps and then from the sockets. The litter is then lowered to the floor of the ambulance, from which position it is with- drawn, as in the previous paragraph. The tail gate having been closed, the squad takes position at litter posts without command. 207. When, for any reason, it is necessary to use three bear- ers in loading or unloading, the commands at sides of litter, posts, are not given. At the commands three bearers, upper (or lower) berth, prepare to load, the additional bearer takes post outside the left handle, at the head of the litter opposite No. 2, who steps outside the right handle. Both face the litter, stoop and grasp their respective poles. No. 1 faces about, stoops and grasps his handles. At load, the litter is lifted and pushed into the ambulance. If the upper berth is to be loaded, the additional bearer now mounts the step with No. 2 and assists in lifting the litter into position. In un- loading, these movements are reversed. CARRYING ON ORDINARY WAGONS 321 208. The right side of the ambulance is always loaded or unloaded first, unless otherwise ordered. With but two re- cumbent patients, the lower berths only are loaded. 209. When necessary to load feet first, the litter is not wheeled about when it reaches the rear of the ambulance, but is halted and lowered with feet toward the tail gate, when the movements proceed as in previous paragraphs. 210. At the conclusion of the drill with ambulances the detachment is re-formed in line. ; ...... TO PREPARE AND LOAD ORDINARY WAGONS TO TRANSPORT WOUNDED. 211. In active service the use of ordinary army or other wagons for transporting the sick and wounded is of every- day occurrence, and it is important that bearers should be practiced in preparing, loading, and unloading such vehicles. Patients may be laid on straw, or other like material, spread thickly over the bottom of the wagon; or on hand litters placed on the bottom, or suspended by ropes or straps. The move- ments heretofore fully described, to load and unload, will, if thoroughly understood, meet the requirements of any emergency of this character. It must, however, always be re- membered that such work demands a far greater amount of care on the part of the bearers for the safety and comfort of their patients than when the proper appliances are at hand. INSPECTION AND MUSTER. Inspection 0} detachment. 212. Inspection is in such uniform as may be prescribed. The Hospital Corps pouch is worn with all uniforms, suspended from the left shoulder to the rear over the* right hip. 213. The detachment should frequently be inspected in field equip- ment (par. 44). 214. The detachment being formed, the senior noncommissioned officer salutes, reports, and takes his place on the right of the line of 322 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS file closers (par. 62). The junior officers take their posts and draw sabers as soon as the senior noncommissioned officer has reported. The officer commanding, standing in front of the center of the detachment, then draws saber and commands: 1. Prepare for inspection, 2. March, 3. Front. At the first command the junior officers place themselves on the right and left of the rank; the officer commanding then places himself facing to the left, three paces in front of the right of the detachment, and commands, march. At this command the junior officers take posts three paces in front of the detachment, distributing themselves equally along the line, in order of rank from right to left; the rank (the left hand upon the hip) dresses to the right. The officer commanding aligns the officers and the rank; the senior noncommissioned officers the file closers. The officers and file closers cast their eyes to the front as soon as their alignment is verified. At the command front, the men turn their heads and eyes to the front and drop the hands by the side. 215. The officer commanding takes post facing to the front, three paces in front of the right guide, and as the inspector approaches he faces to the left and commands: 1. Inspection, 2. Pouches, and, facing to the front, salutes him. At the second command the pouches are shifted under the right arm to the front, the flap opened and strap held by the left hand (fingers extended and joined, palm of hand and elbow against the Fig. 206 (Par. 215). body), so that the flap strap covers the line of but- —Inspection, tons, right hand at side. Pouches. As soon as inspected, the officer commanding returns saber and accompanies the inspector. When the latter begins to inspect the rank the junior officers face about and stand at ease, saber at the order. Commencing on the right, the inspector now proceeds to minutely inspect the pouch of each soldier in succession. After the inspector has passed, each>man closes and replaces the pouch . Accouterments and dress are then carefully inspected. The pres- ence and serviceable condition of the first-aid packet is always verified. If the pouches are not inspected they are replaced by the commands: 1. Close, 2. Pouches. HOSPITAL CORPS INSPECTION 323 216. The inspection being completed, the junior officers come to attention, carry saber, and face to the front; the officer commanding again takes his post on the right, and directs that the detachment be dismissed. 217. If the inspection is to include an examination of the blanket rolls the officer commanding, before dismissing the detachment and after inspecting the file closers, directs the junior officers to remain in place, takes intervals (par. 66) and commands: 1. Unsling, 2. Packs, 3. Open, 4. Packs. At the second command, each man unslings his roll and places it on the ground at his feet, rounded end to the front, square end of shelter half to the right. At the fourth command, the rolls are untied, laid perpendicular to the front with the triangular end of the shelter half to the front, opened, and unrolled to the left; each man prepares the contents of his roll for inspection and resumes the attention. The officer commanding then returns saber, passes along the rank and file closers as before, inspects the rolls, returns to the right, draws saber, and commands: x aDD OOOO^ jrc.o Common tents % JST.C Conical trail tents Picket Line Transportation Fig. 207 (Par. 245). — Plan for a Field Hospital. AMERICAN ARMY FIELD HOSPITAL 333 TO MARK OUT THE CAMP. 247. The site having been chosen and base line (front) decided upon, the hospital will be marked out as follows: Mark the right end of the base line (base point) with a flag, or other- wise measure off the distance required for the front of the camp, viz: for the field hospital, 200 feet, or 80 paces; mark the left end of the base line. The front of the camp being thus determined, the rear of the ground will now be marked. Place a flag or a man on the base line and 6 feet from the base point; place another flag or man 8 feet from the base point toward the rear, and 10 feet diagnoally from the first flag or man; the angle thus formed will be a right angle. Place a third marker in the same straight line as the 8-foot side of the triangle, and distant from the base point 200 feet, or 80 paces. The rear line of the camp will be equal in length and parallel to the base line, and will be similarly marked. The tents %ill now be pitched. The position of the door of each tent should be marked by pins properly aligned. The positions of these pins may be determined by pacing, or by using a cord or tape with distances marked on it. Ordinarily, it will be found most convenient to pitch first the center line of tents, including the office and the kitchen. With these tents pitched, the work of the hospital can proceed while the remainder of the tents are being pitched and the camp put in order. 248. HOSPITAL CORPS BUGLE CALL. ^a d" /^ Fig. 208.— Hospital Corps Bugle Call. POSITION OF THE MEDICAL DEPARTMENT ON THE MARCH AND IN CAMP. 249. The position of the medical department of a marching com- mand is immediately in rear of the rear company, troop, or battery of the organization to which it pertains, and in front of the rear guard. With each ambulance is a driver and an ambulance orderly. In camp the ambulances and medical department wagons are parked near the field or regimental hospitals, and not with the wagon train. 334 EMERGENCIES AND ACCIDENTS 250. SCHEME FOR PACKING HOSPITAL CORPS POUCH. Bear (in loops). Case with scissors, pins, etc. Roll of wire gauze. Flask with ammonia? spiritus aromaticus. Robber tourniquet knife. Fbont. Packet. Packet. Packet. Packet.' Packet. Packet. Packet. Packet, Bottom. Six gauze bandages. Spool plaster. THE PACKING OF POUCHES 335 251. SCHEME FOR PACKING ORDERLY POUCH. Rear (in loops). Chloro- form, in case. Roll wire gauze. Rubber bandage. Ammonia? spiritus aromaticus, in flask. Hypoder- mic syringe. Mist. chloroformi et opii, in case. Front. Two packets. Bp °^^ Ye Two P~*eto. Catheter, in case. Two packets. Pins. Pocket Diagnosis tags, and pencil. Two packets. Bottom. Four packages sublimated gauze. Six gauze bandages. Six packages catgut ligatures. Six packages silk ligatures. Part IV THE CARE OF THE HUMAN MACHINE CHAPTER XXIX SANITARY SUGGESTIONS The human body resembles other machines in requiring proper care to maintain it in good order. It must be suitably housed and protected, the effects of wear and tear must be removed and harmful extraneous matters must not be per- mitted to reach it, it must be kept clean and sufficient power- producing matter or fuel must be provided for it. Dwellings. — For privacy and protection, man is accus- tomed to build for himself shelters varying in extent from the wickyup of the savage to the palace of the prince. By so doing he introduces a fruitful source of disease. The con- finement of the air within the walls of a dwelling compels it to be breathed repeatedly until, by the extraction of all of its nourishing elements and the pollution derived from the em- anations of living bodies, it is not only no longer capable of supporting life, but is a direct cause of death. The process of supplying fresh air to dwellings is called ventilation. Ventilation . — The reasons for the necessity of an abun- dant supply of fresh air have already been considered (pages 69 and 70) . Ventilation is usually accomplished by the flow of air in and out of doors and windows. More than one per 1000 of carbonic acid in the air is injurious, and rooms should be of a sufficient size to permit the constant introduc- tion of enough fresh air and the prompt removal of enough contaminated air to keep the percentage continually below this point without the production of a draught. This can be accomplished by limiting the number of well persons in a room to such a degree that each one shall have about 800 cubic feet of air-space, or a portion measuring nine feet in each direction ; in this case the entire bulk of air would need to be renewed but once in twenty minutes, which can readilv 339 340 THE CARE OF THE HUMAN MACHINE be accomplished by the ordinary means of doors and win- dows. In case of the sick, the requisite air space is double the amount named. The presence of foul air in dwellings — whether due to the breath of persons crowding a room or to other causes — is a fertile source of certain diseases, such as consumption, mala- rial affections, typhoid and typhus fevers, and the like. For this reason homes should not only be provided with proper ventilation, but swampy surroundings, foul cellars, cesspools or pools formed by accumulations of slops, uncared-for water- closets, and sewer openings should be avoided as far as practicable and, when existing, should be rendered as harm- less as possible by disinfection. Disinfection. — Certain agents, when applied to disease- inducing matters, destroy their power. These agents are disinfectants, and the process of applying them is disinfection. The term disinfectant has popularly been applied to agents which counteract offensive odors — deodorizers — or arrest decay — antiseptics. This is an error, for many of these agents are entirely without effect upon disease germs. A large number of the proprietory " disinfectants " advertised in the public press are of this character. The more valuable agents for disinfection are four in number : i. Heat. — A temperature elevated to the boiling-point or higher is the most efficient of disinfectants ; it is also a deo- dorizer and an antiseptic. Boiling for half an hour destroys germs of the greatest vitality. Infected materials, which will not be harmed by it, may be treated either in this way or by the application of superheated steam. 2. Corrosive Sublimate. — Known also as bichloride of mercury, this is the most powerful chemical germicide, and consequently, for purposes where heat is not practicable, the most efficient germicide known. For Disinfection of Clothing. — Fifteen grains should be dissolved in a gallon of water, with one-half grain of permanganate of potassium. The clothing must be thoroughly soaked in this solution for at least two hours, after which it may be laundered in the ordinary way. DISINFECTION AND DISINFECTANTS 341 For Disinfection of Other Infectious Matter. — Two drachms each of corrosive sublimate and permanganate of potassium should be dissolved in a gallon of water. 3. Chloride of Lime. — Popularly known as "bleaching powder," this agent is especially useful in disinfecting the discharges from the body or foul soil of any kind. It is also a deodorant. For Ordinary Disinfection. — One part of chloride of lime with nine parts of dry earth is an excellent dis- infectant sprinkled copiously into privy vaults, cess- pools, etc. For Disinfection of Infectious Matter. — Four ounces of chloride of lime dissolved in a gallon of water form a solution into which should be passed the discharges from cholera, typhoid fever, and other affections hav- ing discharges of an infectious character. 4. Sulphur. — Sulphur may be used in the form of roll sulphur or brimstone or cast into sulphur candles. The disinfecting element is sulphurous acid gas, which is liberated by burning. To get the effect of this agent, every aperture in a room must be tightly closed to prevent its escape, and three pounds of sulphur used for every thousand cubic feet of air-space. The sulphur should be broken into small pieces and moistened with alcohol before lighting. To obviate the danger of fire, it should be placed in a shallow iron pan set upon a couple of bricks in a tub partly full of water. After twenty-four hours the doors and windows should be thrown wide open to permit the sulphurous acid gas to be blown out. The stools in cholera and typhoid fever, and probably in epidemic dysentery, consumption, diphtheria, and yellow, scarlet, and typhus fevers are infectious. The vomited matter in cholera, diphtheria, and yellow and scarlet fevers is liable to convey infection ; and the expectoration of consumption, diphtheria, scarlet fever, and infectious pneumonia is similarly dangerous. They should all then be discharged into vessels containing enough corrosive sublimate or chloride of lime solution to cover them. Clothing contaminated by small-pox, scarlet fever, and other con- tagious diseases may be disinfected by immediately boiling it or by soaking it in a corrosive sublimate solution. But clothing and bedding 342 THE CARE OF THE HUMAN MACHINE too bulky, or otherwise unsuited to such treatment, should be burned without delay. During the occupation of a room by a subject of infectious disease it cannot be disinfected except by free ventilation, — removing the con- taminated and introducing fresh air. To render this easier, the carpets, pictures, hangings, and all unnecessary furniture should be removed when the room is given to the patient. After the removal from a room, by death or recovery, of a subject of infectious disease, the walls, ceiling, and floor should be washed with a solution formed by the addition of a pint of the stronger corrosive sublimate solution to four gallons of water. All woodwork should be scrubbed with soap and water. After this the room may also be fumi- gated with sulphur. Centres of putrefaction, such as cesspools, drains, and privy vaults may be treated with the weaker sublimate solution, or with chloride of lime in solution or in powder, as may be convenient. Food and drink are readily and infallibly disinfected by cooking. Boiling or roasting for half an hour destroys the most active germs. In case of an epidemic of cholera or typhoid fever, nothing should be taken into the stomach that has not been so treated. Deodorization. — As already remarked, certain agents are of value in overcoming offensive odors, although not useful as disinfectants. Dry earth, wood ashes, and powdered charcoal belong to this class, and are to be applied by free sprinkling. Chloride of zinc, an ounce dissolved in a quart of water, is an effective deodorant. Chloride of lime, in solution and in powder, belongs to both classes. Cleanliness. — Nothing is a more efficient preventive of sickness than cleanliness of person, habitation, and surround- ings. Filth of every kind is a most favorable soil for the culture of disease. The surroundings of a dwelling, then, should be carefully cleaned, no piles of decaying matter — either vegetable or animal — being permitted. That the house itself should be kept clean goes without saying. The skin throws off every day two or three pounds cf ex- crementitious matters, both solid and liquid, and to insure its proper action, they must be removed. If they are permitted to remain, decomposition soon sets in, and the skin is then CLEANLINESS AND CLOTHING 343 covered with a layer of decaying matter which closes the pores and paves the way for much ill-health. When practi- cable, then, the entire person should be bathed daily with fresh water, or, better, with a solution of an ounce of car- bonate of soda to the gallon of water. Clothing. — The prime object of clothing being the pro- tection of the body from the harmful action of atmospheric heat, cold, and moisture, it follows that the clothing should be modified from time to time to suit the weather. The mate- rials should vary in weight, texture, and character, according to the season and the latitude, since both extremes of bodily temperature are equally dangerous to health. The fit of the clothing is of importance, for ill-fitting clothing is apt to be chafing to the body as well as to the spirit. Chafing occurs chiefly in the bends of the joints, such as the armpits, elbows, and knees, and between the thighs, but it may appear at any point where the clothing rubs the skin. The chafed parts should be carefully washed with soap and water and thoroughly dried ; they may then be dusted with a suitable bland powder, such as magnesia, fuller's earth, and even starch, meal, or flour, although the latter are objection- able on account of their liability to form with the perspira- tion a sour and irritating paste. Foot-soreness is chiefly due to ill-fitting shoes, although it may arise from other causes. It is a common complaint in marching. Soaking in hot salt water, or alum and water, the night before is said to reduce the liability to foot-soreness. Rubbing the feet with grease of any kind before starting is an advantage. In the German army there is sifted into the shoes and stockings, to prevent trouble with the feet, a pow- der composed of three parts by weight of salicylic acid, ten of starch, and eighty-seven of powdered soapstone. Blisters should be opened at the end of the march by pricking at either end and gently pressing the fluid out of the openings, taking care not to break the skin. Where the difficulty is due to inflamed corns, bunions, or ingrowing toenail, the surgeon should apply the treatment. 344 THE CARE OF THE HUMAN MACHINE Food. — The food forms an important part of the fuel of the human machine. The more easy the digestion, — the process of extracting the portions of the fuel utilizable in the machine, — the more easily the machine runs. The fol- lowing table, showing comparatively the time required for the digestion of some of the more common articles of diet, may serve as a guide to the selection of food for the body — fuel for the machine : — Rice, Boiled i hour. Beef, Roast Tripe, Boiled Mutton, Roast Oysters Eggs, Soft Eggs, Uncooked Tapioca Bread Barley or Sago • 2 hours. Butter Milk, Boiled Cheese Codfish Eggs, Hard Eggs, Fried Turkey, Roast Duck Lamb, Roast - 25 hours. Chicken Beans Potatoes Veal, Roast Pork, Roast 3 hours. 35 hours. 4 hours. 4\ hours. The amount of food required to maintain a healthful exist- ence varies according to the individual and his occupation. Physiologists have carefully worked out the proportion of the various elements required for this purpose. The ration of the United States soldier, while not absolutely complete as a dietary, perhaps approaches as nearly the amount needed daily by a healthy man as may be required. It contains — Fresh beef or other fresh meat or Salt beef or Salt pork or bacon, or canned beef or Codfish, dried or fresh or Pickled mackerel or canned salmon Potatoes or Potatoes ) and Onions f or Potatoes and Tomatoes (or other vegetables in cans) 14 or 18 or 1 • I 20 oz. 22 12 18 16 16 12.8 3-2 II. 2 4.8 food 345 Dried fruits 2 Sugar (or equivalent in molasses or syrup) . 2.4 Salt .64 Pepper .04 oz. Flour 18 or Soft bread 18 or Hard bread 16 or Corn meal 20 Beans or peas ....... 2.4 Rice or hominy 1.6 Coffee, green 1.6 or Coffee, roasted ....... 1.28 or Tea . .32 Baking powder ^f Vinegar • .04 qt. Soap .48 oz. Where illuminating oil is not furnished, .24 oz. candles ; and in the field, when necessary, .48 oz. yeast powder. Of equal if not greater importance than the amount of food is its proper preparation. As has been remarked in connection with the sense of taste, the rendering food savory and digestible, and serving it in a tempting manner, is a study worthy the attention of a higher grade of talent than is ordi- narily devoted to it. The art of cookery is still in its infancy. It is impossible, however, within the limits of this Manual to do more than to call attention to the deficiency and to urge a more general attention to the subject. Infection. — Infection is of two kinds, considered with respect to its relation to human beings — infection through insects and infection through vegetable micro-organisms direct. Injection by Vegetable Micro-Organisms. — The diseases which are carried by this means are numerous and many of them well known. Among these affections are cholera, consumption, diphtheria, dysentery, lockjaw and typhoid fever. In each of these diseases care should be taken to pre- vent the introduction of the micro-organism into the system from an infected source. Cholera and typhoid are spread chiefly by the micro-organisms from the stools of infected 346 THE CARE OF THE HUMAN MACHINE persons getting into food or drink ; in lockjaw the micro- organism is introduced through a wound, and in consump- tion and diphtheria it is inhaled. Injection Through the Medium of Insects. — The most con- spicuous instances of this form of infection are in the case of malaria and yellow fever, where the micro-organism is introduced by a peculiar variety of mosquito in each case, the Stegomyia fasciata in yellow fever and the anopheles in malaria. The discovery of this fact enabled the United States occupation of Cuba to banish yellow fever from that island, and to enormously reduce the amount of malaria prevalent by controlling the access of mosquitoes through the employment of screens and the reduction of stagnant water breeding places by drainage or by covering the surface of the water with a thin layer of coal-oil. INDEX INDEX Accidents, how to act in, 119. Acid, prussic, poisoning by, 229. Acids, poisoning by, 227. Aconite poisoning, 229. Adam's apple, 16. Adipose tissue, 6. Air supply, 305. Alimentary canal, 70. Alkalies, poisoning by, 227. Almonds, bitter, poisoning by oil of, 229. Ambulance corps, 238. Ambulance drill, 316. Ambulance station, 241. Ammonia poisoning, 227. Anatomy of man, see Human ma- chine, 1. Antisepsis, 89, 90. Antiseptic surgery, 107. Apoplexy, 204. Aqua fortis, poisoning by, 227. Arm, bleeding from arteries of, 155; broken, 183; slings for, 95, 103; triangular bandages for, 98. Army, first-aid organisation, 236. Arteries, 52. and veins, difference between, bleeding from, 146. of body, bleeding from, 158. of elbow, bleeding from, 157. of foot, bleeding from, 161. of forearm, bleeding from, 157. of hand, bleeding from, 1 58. of head, bleeding from, 153. of knee, bleeding from, 160. of leg, bleeding from, 161. of lower extremity, bleeding from, 158. of neck, bleeding from, 154. Arteries, of thigh, bleeding from, 160. of upper extremity, bleeding from, 155. principal, 57. pulmonary, 66. Arrows and fish-hooks, wounds by, 141. Arsenic poisoning, 228. Ash berries, poisoning by moun- tain, 229. Asphyxia, 214. Atropia poisoning, 229. Bacilli, 87. Back, triangular bandage for, 97. Bacteria, 87, 346. Bandage, arm sling roller, 103. double-headed roller, 106. four-tailed, 101. hardened, 106. method of rolling a, 103. roller, 101. square, 100. triangular, 93. turns and reverses, 104. Battle-field, emergencies of, 236. Bearer drill, 245. Bearers, company, 236. Belladonna poisoning, 229. Berries, poisoning by, 229. Bites, dog, 232. insect, 233. snake, 233. tarantula, 233. Bittersweet berries, poisoning by, 229. Black-heads, 4. Bladder, 78. Bleeding, 145. from arteries, treatment of, 149. 349 35° INDEX Bleeding, of body, 158. of elbow, 157. of foot, 161. of forearm, 157. of hand, 158. of head, 153. of knee, 160. of leg, 161. of lower extermity, 158. of neck, 154. of thigh, 160. of upper extremity, 155. from the nose, 166. from wounds of capillaries, 163. from wounds of veins, 162. internal, 167. secondary, 167. special susceptibility to, 168. Blood, 46. circulation of, 54. clotting, 48. corpuscles, 47. functions of, 49. spitting of, 164. Blood-vessels, 52, 57. Body, bleeding from arteries of. 158. Bones, 6, 10. ankle, 23. arm, 18. arm, broken, 183. back, 14. breast, 17. broken, 172. carpus, 20. cheek, 12. chest, 16. clavicle, 18. coccyx, 15. collar, 18. collar, broken, 182. femur, 22. fibula, 23. fingers, 20. fingers, broken, 186. foot, 24, foot, broken, 191. forearm, 19. forearm, broken, 184. hand, 20. hand, broken, 186. hip, 21. humerus, 18. Bones, hyoid, 16. innominate, 21. instep, 24. jaw, 12, 13. jaw, broken, 181. knee-cap, 23. knee-cap, broken, 190. lachrymal, 12. leg, 23. leg, broken, 190. malar, 12. malleolus, 23. maxillary, 12. nasal, 12. nose, broken, 181. occipital, 11. palate, 12. patella, 23. pelvic, 21. pelvic, broken, 188. radius, 19. ribs, 16. ribs, broken, 187. rump, 15. sacrum, 15. scapula, 17. sesamoid, 9. shoulder blade, 17. shoulder blade, broken, 183. skull, broken, 180. sphenoid, 11. spinal, 14. spinal, broken, 186. sternum, 17. teeth, 12. temporal, 11. thigh, 22. thigh, broken, 188. thorax, 16. tibia, 23. ulna, 19. wormian, 9. wrist, 20. wrist, broken, 185. Bowels, 73, 77. Brain, 36. compression of, 203. concussion of, 201. membranes, 43. structure, 41. Breath, 67. nourishment from, 69. poison in, 69. INDEX 351 Breathing, 67. and speaking apparatus, 64. indications of different kinds of, 124. restoring the, 215, 218. Broken bones, 172. Bronchial tubes, 66. Bruises, 125. Burning clothing, 130. Burns, 127. Callosities, 4. Calomel poisoning, 228. Capelline bandage, 106. Capillaries, 53. bleeding from, 148. bleeding from wounds of, 163. Carbonic acid in breath, 69. Cartilages, 16, 17, 28. Caustic poisoning, 227. Centipede sting, 233. Cerebellum, 37. Cerebrum, 37, Chafing, 343. Chest, 16, 66. triangular bandage for, 97. wounds of, 141. Chilblains, 132. Chloral poisoning, 228. Chloride of lime as a disinfectant, 3.4 1- Choking, 195. Circulation of blood, 54. Clavicle, fracture of, 182. Cleanliness, 342. Clothing, 343. Clove hitch, 92. Collar bone, broken, 182. Company bearers, 236. Compression of brain, 203. Concussion of the brain, 201. Contagious disease, disinfection in, 341. Contusions, 125. Convulsions, 211. Copper poisoning, 228. Copperas poisoning, 228. Corda dorsalis, 9. Corrosive sublimate as a disinfect- ant, 340. poisoning, 228. Coughing, 68. Cranium, 9. Cuts, see Wounds. Cyanide of potash, poisoning by, 229. Death, 234. proofs of, 235. Deodorization, 342. Dermis or true skin, 4. Digestion of food, 344. process of, 75. Digestive apparatus, 70. Disabled, carrying {see also Hos- pital corps drill), 244. Diseases, indications of , 123. Disinfection, 340. Dislocations, 169. Dizziness, 124. Dog bites, 232. Dressings, 107. Dressing packet, first, 109. Dressing station, first, 240. Drill ambulance, 316. bearer, 245. hospital corps, 244. litter, 279. Drowning, resuscitation from, 217. rescuing the, 221, 223. Drunkenness, 206. Dwellings, hygiene of, 339. Ears, 80. foreign body in, 193. Elbow, bleeding from arteries of, broken, 184. roller bandage for, 105. triangular bandage for, 98. Electric shock, 225. Emergencies, how to act in, 119. Emetics, 230. Endosteum, 8. Epidermis, or scarf-skin, 3. Epilepsy, 211. Esmarch's bandage, 93. Excretion, apparatus for, 76. Examination of an injured per- son, 122. Eye, 82. foreign body in, 192. Face, see Black-heads, bones of , 9. 35 2 INDEX Face, triangular bandage for, 97. Fainting, 196, 198. Falling sickness, 211. Fat, 5 . Femur, broken, 188. Fevers and infection, 344. Fibula, broken, 190. Fingers, broken, 186. Fingers, dislocations of, 170. roller bandage for, 105. First-dressing packet, 109. Fish-hooks and arrows, wounds by, 141. Fits, 211. children's, 213. epileptic, 211. Fomentations, 114, 115. Fontanelles, 9, n. Foods, digestion of, 70. hygiene of, 344. ration of the soldier, 344. Foot, bleeding from arteries of, 161. broken, 191. roller bandage for, 105, 106. triangular bandage for, 100. Foot-soreness, 309. Forearm, bleeding from arteries of, 157- broken, 184. roller bandage for, 105. triangular bandage for, 99. Foreign body in the ear, 193. in the eye, 192. in the nose, 194. in the throat, 195. Fowler's solution, poisoning by, 228. Fracture, 172. at elbow, 184 at wrist, 185. compound, 173. in the hand, 186. of arm, 183. of collar bone, 182. of fingers, 186. of foot, 191. of forearm, 184. of jaw, 181. of knee-cap, 190. of leg, 190. of nose, 181. of pelvis, 188. Fracture, of ribs, 187. of skull, 180. of spine, 186. of thigh, 188. simple, 173. Freezing, 131. insensibility from, 210. Frostbite, 131. Gases, smothering by, 223. Gauze for dressings, 107. Geneva Convention, provisions of, 239. Germicides, 89, 90. Germs, 87. Glands, salivary, 71. sebaceous, 4. sweat, 4. vascular, 64. Granulations, 144. Green coloring-matter, poisoning by, 228. Paris, poisoning by, 228. vitriol, poisoning by, 228. Gunshot wounds, 141. Gullet, 71. Guts, 73. Hair, nails and warts, 4. Hand, bleeding from arteries of, 158. broken, 186. roller bandage for, 105. triangular bandage for, 99. Hanging, smothering by, 225. Head, bleeding from arteries of, 153. bones of, 9. four-tailed bandage cap for, 101. roller bandage for, 106. square bandage for, 100. triangular bandage for, 96, 97. Healing in wounds, 144. Hearing, 80. Heart, 50. Heat as a disinfectant, 340. Heatstroke, 207. Hellebore poisoning, 229. Hemlock poisoning, 229. Hemorrhage, 145. from the lungs, 165. secondary, 168. INDEX 353 Hiccups, 68. Hip, roller bandage for, 105. triangular bandage for, 99. Hip-bones, 21. broken, 188. Hitch, clove, 92. Horse-chestnut poisoning, 229. Horseback, loading patient on, 310. Horse- litters, 312. Hospital corps, 236, 244: drill, 245. ambulance drill, 316. bugle call, 333. equipment, 258. horseback, placing on. 310. inspection, 321. litter, carrying without, 307. drill, 279. drill definitions, 245. drill, detachment, 265. drill, general principles, 246. drill with closed, 280. drill with improvised, 306. drill with loaded, 292. marchings, 254. with litter, 290. muster, 324. obstacles, carrying litter past, 297. travois drill with, 312. turnings, 269, 291. Hospital, field, 351. corporals, 237. sergeants, 237. Human machine, 1. Humerus, fracture of, 183. Hunchback, cause of, 15. Hygiene, 337. Hysterics, 212. Ice, breaking through, 223. Indian tobacco, poisoning by, 229. Inebriation, 206. Infection, 345. Injured, carrying the, 244. Insect infection, 346. Insolation, 207. Inspection of hospital corps, 297. Instep, 24. Intestines, 73. Intoxication, 206. Iron, poisoning by, 228. Ivy poisoning, 230. Jamestown weed, poisoning by, 229. Jaw, broken, 181. dislocation of lower, 171. Joints, see Sprains, 8, 25. dislocations of, 169. Kidneys, 77. Knee, bleeding from arteries of, 160. roller bandage for, 106. triangular bandage for, 100. Knee-cap, broken, 190. Knot, clove-hitch, 92. false, 91. granny, 91. reef, 91. square, 91. surgeon's, 92. Larynx, 65. Laudanum poisoning, 228. Laurel water poisoning, 229. Lead poisoning, 229. Leg, bleeding from arteries of, 161. broken, 190. roller bandages for, 106. triangular bandage for, 100. Lettuce, wild, poisoning by, 229. Ligaments, 26. Lime chloride as a disinfectant, 34i- Litter, U. S. army, 279. Litter- drill, 279. Litter, posture of disabled on, 138. Litters, carrying without, 307. improvised, 306. Liver, 74. Lunar caustic, poisoning by, 227. Lungs, 66. action in excretion, 77. hemorrhage from the, 165. Lye poisoning, 227. Matches, poisoning by, 229. Medical officers, 236. Medulla oblongata, 42. 354 INDEX Mercuric bichloride as a disinfect- ant, 340. Microbes, 87. Micro-organisms, 87. Morphine poisoning, 228. Mosquito infection, 346. Mouth, 65. action on food in, 71. Mumps, 71. Muscles, 29. description of, 35. involuntary, 31. movements of, 30. voluntary, 30, 31. Mushrooms, poisoning by, 229. Mustard plaster, 116. Muster of hospital corps, 324. Nails, warts, and callosities, 4. Neck, bleeding from arteries of, 154- Neck, triangular bandage for, 97. Nerves, 36. cells, 41. cranial, 39, 43. location of principal, 44, 45. motor, 40. sensory, 40. sympathetic, 45. Nightshade, deadly, poisoning by, 229. Nose, 80. broken, 181. foreign body in, 194. Nosebleed, 166. Nux vomica, poisoning by, 229. Odors, to overcome offensive, 342. (Esophagus, 71. Ointments, 112. Opium poisoning, 228. Oxygen in breath, 69. Packet, first-dressing, 109. Pancreas, 75. Paralytic stroke, 204. Paregoric poisoning, 228. Parsley, poisoning by wild, 229. Patella, broken, 190. Pelvis, 21. broken, 188. Perceptive apparatus, 79. Periosteum, 8. Pharynx, 65. Physiology of man, see Human machine. Phosphorus poisoning, 229. Plaster, court, 112. mustard, 116. sticking, 112. Poke berries, poisoning by, 229. Poisoned wounds, 231. Poisoning, treatment of, 226. acids, 227. aconite, 229. alkalies, 227. ammonia, 227. aqua fortis, 227. arsenic, 228. atropia, 229. belladonna, 229. berries, 229. bittersweet berries, 229. blue vitriol, 228. calomel, 228. caustic, 227. chloral, 228. copper, 228. copperas, 228. corrosive sublimate, 228. cyanide of pctash, 229. Fowler's solution, 228. green coloring-matter, 228. green, Paris, 228. green vitriol, 228. hellebore, 229. hemlock, 229. horse-chestnut, 229. Indian tobacco, 229. insensibility from, 209. iron, 228. ivy, 230. Jamestown weed, 229. laudanum, 228. laurel water, 229. lead, 229. lettuce, wild, 229. lye, 227. matches, 229. mercury, 228. morphine, 228. mountain ash berries, 229. mushrooms, 229. nux vomica, 229. oil of bitter almonds, 229. INDEX 355 Poisoning, opium, 228. paregoric, 228. parsley, wild, 229. poke berries, 229. phosphorus, 229. potash, 227. prussic acid, 229. rhubarb leaves, 229. rhus, 230. rough on rats, 228. Scheele's green, 228. sleeping mixture, 228. soda, 227. strychnia, 229. sumac, 230. toadstools, 229. tobacco, 229. verdigris, 228. vermilion, 228. vitriol, 227. Position of injured, best, 138. Potash poisoning, 227. Poultices, 113. Pressure on chest, smothering by, 225. Pronation, 19. Prussic acid poisoning, 229. Pulse, 56. indications of the, 124. Radius, fracture of, 184. Ration of the soldier, 344. Rectum, 76, 77. Respiration, 67. artificial, 215, 218. Rhubarb poisoning, 229. Rhus poisoning, 230. Ribs, 16. broken, 187. triangular bandage for, 98. Roller bandage, 101. double-headed, 106. Rough on rats, poisoning by, 228. Saber, Manual of, 262. Saliva, 71. Salves, 112. Sanitary soldiers, 237. suggestions, 339. Scapula, fracture of, 183. Scheele's green, poisoning by, 228. Scorpion sting, 233. Senses, 79. Sergeants, hospital, 237. Setting up exercises, 251. Shock, 199. Shoulder, dislocation of, 171. roller bandage for, 105. triangular bandage for, 98. Shoulder blade, broken, 183. Sighing, 68. Sight, 81. defective, 83. Singing, 68. Skeleton, see Bones. Skin, 3. action in excretion, 76. appendages of, 4. scarf, 3. true, 4. Skull, 9. broken, 180. Sleeping-mixture poisoning, 228. Slings for broken bones, 179. roller bandage arm, 103. triangular bandage for, 95. Smell, 80. Smells, to overcome offensive, 342. Smothering, 214. by electric shock, 225. by gases, 223. by hanging, 225. by pressure on chest, 225. by strangling, 225. Snake bites, 233. Sneezing, 68. Soldiers, sanitary, 237. Spanish windlass tourniquet, 151. Speaking, 68. and breathing apparatus, 64. Spica turn of bandage, 105. Spinal column, 14. cord, 43. Spine, broken, 186. Spiral turns of bandage, 104. Spitting of blood, 164. Splinters, 140. Splints, 176. Sprains, 168. Stings, insects, 233. Stomach, 71. Strangling, smothering by, 225. Stroke, paralytic, 204. sun, 207. Strychnine poisoning, 229. 356 INDEX Stunning, 201. Suffocation, 214. Sulphur as a disinfectant, 307. Sumac poisoning, 230. Sunburn, 130. Sunstroke, 207. Supination, 19. Surgeons, military, 236. Sweetbreads, 75. Swooning, 198. Symptoms, 123. Syncope, 198. Synovial membrane, 27. Tarantula bite, 233. Taste, 79. Teeth, 12. Tendons, ^3- Tents, hospital, 324. shelter, 321. Thigh, bleeding from arteries of, 160. broken, 188. roller bandage for, 106. triangular bandage for, 100. Thorax, 16. Throat, foreign body in, 195. Tibia, broken, 190. Toadstools, poisoning by, 229. Tobacco poisoning, 229. Tongue, 80. Touch, 79. Tourniquets, 151. Transportation of disabled, 244. without litters, 307. Travois, 312. Ulna, fracture of, 184. Unconsciousness, 196. Veins, 53. and arteries, tween, 57. difference be- Veins, bleeding from, 147. bleeding from wounds of, 162. principal, 62. pulmonary, 66. Ventilation, 339. necessity for, 70. Verdigris poisoning, 228. Vermilion poisoning, 228. Vitriol, blue, poisoning by, 228. green, poisoning, 228. poisoning, 227. Vocal cords, 65. Voice, production of, 65. Vomiting, methods of producing, 230. Warts, nails, hair, 4. Waste, apparatus for disposal of, 76. Wens, 4. Windpipe, 66. Wounded, carrying the, 244. posture of, 138. Wounds, 133. cleansing, 135. closing, 135. danger of, 143. dressing, 138. dressings for, 107. gunshot, 141. healing of, 144. of arteries, bleeding from,' 149. of capillaries, bleeding from, 163. of chest, 141. of veins, bleeding from, 162. pierced or punctured, 139. poisoned, 231. torn or lacerated, 139. triangular bandage for, 96. Wrist, broken, 185. roller bandage for, 105. triangular bandage for, 99. APR 3 - 1951 »-»/.. ; ^> -> A O0 x '0 'V- v x 'V- LIBRARY OF CONGRESS lllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllPI 021 607 857 3